Implementing BGP

Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) is an Exterior Gateway Protocol (EGP) that allows you to create loop-free interdomain routing between autonomous systems. An autonomous system is a set of routers under a single technical administration. Routers in an autonomous system can use multiple Interior Gateway Protocols (IGPs) to exchange routing information inside the autonomous system and an EGP to route packets outside the autonomous system.

This module provides the conceptual and configuration information for BGP on Cisco IOS XR software.


Note


For more information about BGP and complete descriptions of the BGP commands listed in this module, see Related Documents section of this module. To locate documentation for other commands that might appear while performing a configuration task, search online in the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router software master command index.


Feature History for Implementing BGP

Release

Modification

Release 3.7.2

This feature was introduced.

Release 3.9.0

The following features were supported:

  • BGP Prefix Independent Convergence Unipath Primary Backup

  • BGP Local Label Retention

  • Asplain notation for 4-byte Autonomous System Number

  • BGP Nonstop Routing

  • Command Line Interface (CLI) consistency for BGP commands

  • L2VPN Address Family Configuration Mode

Release 4.0.0

The following features were supported:

  • BGP Add Path Advertisement

  • Accumulated iGP (AiGP)

  • Pre-route

  • IPv4 BGP-Policy Accounting

  • IPv6 uRPF

Release 4.1.0

Support for 5000 BGP NSR sessions was added

Release 4.1.1

The following features were added:
  • BGP Accept Own

  • BGP DMZ Link Bandwidth for Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing

Release 4.2.0

The following features were supported:

  • Selective VRF Download

  • BGP Multi-Instance/Multi-AS

  • BFD Multihop Support for BGP

  • BGP Error Handling

Support for Distributed BGP (bgp distributed speaker) configuration was removed.

Release 4.2.1

The following features were supported:
  • BGP Prefix Independent Convergence for RIB and FIB

  • BGP Prefix Origin Validation Based on RPKI

Release 4.2.3

The BGP Attribute Filtering feature was added.

Release 4.3.0

The BGP-RIB Feedback Mechanism for Update Generation feature was added

Release 4.3.1

The following features were supported

  • BGP VRF Dynamic Route Leaking

The label-allocation-mode command is renamed the label mode command.

Release 4.3.2

The following features were supported:
  • Per-neighbor Link Bandwidth

Release 5.3.1

The following features were supported:
  • L3VPN iBGP-PE-CE configuration

  • Source-based flow tag

  • Discard extra paths

Release 5.3.2

The following features were supported:
  • Graceful Maintenance

  • Per Neighbor TCP MSS

  • BGP DMZ Aggregate Bandwidth

Release 6.0.1

The 64-ECMP for BGP feature is supported.

Release 7.4.1

The label-allocation-mode is deprecated, the function of this deprecated command can be carried out using label mode command under configured address-family.

Prerequisites for Implementing BGP

  • You must be in a user group associated with a task group that includes the proper task IDs. The command reference guides include the task IDs required for each command. If you suspect user group assignment is preventing you from using a command, contact your AAA administrator for assistance.

  • The current Internet BGP table contains approximately 1.1 million IPv4 routes and 200,000 IPv6 routes. With an average of two paths per route, the BGP process typically requires around 5.5 GB of RAM to manage the full Internet BGP table. As the IPv6 Internet table continues to expand, the memory requirements for the BGP process are expected to increase. Therefore, Cisco recommends using the Service Edge (SE) version of Route Processor (RP) or Route Switch Processor (RSP) cards, or fixed chassis, on routers that will maintain a full BGP table.

Information About Implementing BGP

To implement BGP, you need to understand the following concepts:

BGP Functional Overview

BGP uses TCP as its transport protocol. Two BGP routers form a TCP connection between one another (peer routers) and exchange messages to open and confirm the connection parameters.

BGP routers exchange network reachability information. This information is mainly an indication of the full paths (BGP autonomous system numbers) that a route should take to reach the destination network. This information helps construct a graph that shows which autonomous systems are loop free and where routing policies can be applied to enforce restrictions on routing behavior.

Any two routers forming a TCP connection to exchange BGP routing information are called peers or neighbors. BGP peers initially exchange their full BGP routing tables. After this exchange, incremental updates are sent as the routing table changes. BGP keeps a version number of the BGP table, which is the same for all of its BGP peers. The version number changes whenever BGP updates the table due to routing information changes. Keepalive packets are sent to ensure that the connection is alive between the BGP peers and notification packets are sent in response to error or special conditions.


Note


Other than enabling RTC (route target constraint) with address-family ipv4 rtfilter command, there is no separate configuration needed to enable RTC for BGP EVPN.



Note


For information on configuring BGP to distribute Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) Layer 3 virtual private network (VPN) information, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router MPLS Configuration Guide

For information on BGP support for Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD), see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Configuration Guide and the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Interface and Hardware Command Reference.


BGP Router Identifier

For BGP sessions between neighbors to be established, BGP must be assigned a router ID. The router ID is sent to BGP peers in the OPEN message when a BGP session is established.

BGP attempts to obtain a router ID in the following ways (in order of preference):

  • By means of the address configured using the bgp router-id command in router configuration mode.

  • By using the highest IPv4 address on a loopback interface in the system if the router is booted with saved loopback address configuration.

  • By using the primary IPv4 address of the first loopback address that gets configured if there are not any in the saved configuration.

If none of these methods for obtaining a router ID succeeds, BGP does not have a router ID and cannot establish any peering sessions with BGP neighbors. In such an instance, an error message is entered in the system log, and the show bgp summary command displays a router ID of 0.0.0.0.

After BGP has obtained a router ID, it continues to use it even if a better router ID becomes available. This usage avoids unnecessary flapping for all BGP sessions. However, if the router ID currently in use becomes invalid (because the interface goes down or its configuration is changed), BGP selects a new router ID (using the rules described) and all established peering sessions are reset.


Note


We strongly recommend that the bgp router-id command is configured to prevent unnecessary changes to the router ID (and consequent flapping of BGP sessions).


BGP Route Distinguisher

In network design solutions where customer equipment is dual-homed and Fast Reroute is required, such as in EVPN and BGP PIC Edge solutions, the Route Distinguisher (RD) associated with each VRF must be unique per Provider Edge (PE) router. In other design scenarios, while it isn’t mandatory for the RD to be unique per PE, it is highly recommended to make it unique. This practice facilitates easier transitions to dual-homed solutions in the future.

There are few available options to keep unique RD per device:

  • Manual configuration: You must manually assign a unique value per device in the network. For example, in this scenario:

    • Leaf (ToR) = RD 1

    • Edge DCI Gateway = RD 2

    • Remote PE = RD 3

  • Use rd auto command under VRF. To assign a unique route distinguisher for each router, you must ensure that each router has a unique BGP router-id. If so, the rd auto command assigns a Type 1 route distinguisher to the VRF using the following format: ip-address:number. The IP address is specified by the BGP router-id statement and the number (which is derived as an unused index in the 0 to 65535 range) is unique across the VRFs.


Note


In a DCI deployment, for route re-originate with stitching-rt for a particular VRF, using the same Route Distinguisher (RD) between edge DCI gateway and MPLS-VPN PE or same RD between edge DCI gateway and Leaf (ToR) is not supported.


BGP Maximum Prefix - Discard Extra Paths

IOS XR BGP maximum-prefix feature imposes a maximum limit on the number of prefixes that are received from a neighbor for a given address family. Whenever the number of prefixes received exceeds the maximum number configured, the BGP session is terminated after sending a cease notification to the neighbor. The session is down until a manual clear is performed by the user. The session can be resumed by using the clear bgp command. It is possible to configure a period after which the session can be automatically brought up by using the maximum-prefix command with the restart keyword.

Discard Extra Paths

An option to discard extra paths is added to the maximum-prefix configuration. Configuring the discard extra paths option drops all excess prefixes received from the neighbor when the prefixes exceed the configured maximum value. This drop does not, however, result in session flap.

The benefits of discard extra paths option are:

  • Limits the memory footstamp of BGP.

  • Stops the flapping of the peer if the paths exceed the set limit.

When the discard extra paths configuration is removed, BGP sends a route-refresh message to the neighbor if it supports the refresh capability; otherwise the session is flapped.

On the same lines, the following describes the actions when the maximum prefix value is changed:

  • If the maximum value alone is changed, a route-refresh message is sourced, if applicable.

  • If the new maximum value is greater than the current prefix count state, the new prefix states are saved.

  • If the new maximum value is less than the current prefix count state, then some existing prefixes are deleted to match the new configured state value.

There is currently no way to control which prefixes are deleted.

For detailed configuration steps, see Configuring Discard Extra Paths.


Note


When the system runs out of physical memory, bgp process exits and you must manually restart bpm. To manually restart, use the process restart bpm command.


Restrictions

These restrictions apply to the discard extra paths feature:

  • When the router drops prefixes, it is inconsistent with the rest of the network, resulting in possible routing loops.

  • If prefixes are dropped, the standby and active BGP sessions may drop different prefixes. Consequently, an NSR switchover results in inconsistent BGP tables.

  • The discard extra paths configuration cannot co-exist with the soft reconfig configuration.

BGP Enhanced Multipath Selection

Table 1. Feature History Table

Feature Name

Release Name

Description

BGP Enhanced Multipath Selection

Release 7.4.2

This feature gives you the flexibility to select unequal cost multipath (UCMP) load-balancing based on the interior gateway protocol (IGP) route metric. The IGP route metric is the sum of the metrics of all the links that belong to a path, and this feature selects the paths with lower IGP route metrics as multipath.

In earlier releases, you could select BGP UCMP only based on age order, where the older path took precedence over the newer path.

The BGP multipath selection algorithm functionality enables the multipath to prefer the older paths over the new paths. Here the age order is a vital criterion for selection of the UCMP. However, this method is less optimal and is nondeterministic in terms of forwarding traffic on the network. The BGP Enhanced Multipath Selection feature allows the multipath functionality to select IGP metric.

Restrictions

  • This feature is available in Internal Border Gateway Protocol.

  • This feature is configurable on the following address families:

    • IPv4 Unicast

    • IPv6 Unicast

    • IPv4 Multicast

    • IPv6 Multicast

  • VPNv4 does not support maximum-paths, so you cannot configure the deterministic aspect in the VPN address-family interfaces. However, you can configure the imported prefixes of VRFs with this feature.

Configuration Example

Router(config)# router bgp 100
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths ibgp 2 unequal-cost deterministic

Running Configuration


router bgp 100
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  maximum-paths ibgp 2 unequal-cost deterministic

Verification

The following example shows you can select paths with the lower metrics as multipaths.

Router# show bgp ipv4 unicast 10.10.0.0/28
Paths: (128 available, best #1)
  Not advertised to any peer
  Path #1: Received by speaker 0
  Not advertised to any peer
  Local
    22.0.1.6 (metric 20) from 198.51.100.1 (192.0.0.1)
      Origin IGP, localpref 0, valid, internal, best, group-best, multipath
      Received Path ID 1, Local Path ID 1, version 12611
      Originator: 192.0.0.1, Cluster list: 198.51.100.1
…

Path #64: Received by speaker 0
  Not advertised to any peer
  Local
    23.0.11.6 (metric 30) from 203.0.113.1 (210.0.0.10)
      Origin IGP, localpref 0, valid, internal, multipath
      Received Path ID 32, Local Path ID 0, version 0
      Originator: 210.0.0.10, Cluster list: 203.0.113.1, 200.0.0.10

Path #65: Received by speaker 0
  Not advertised to any peer
  Local
    24.0.1.6 (metric 40) from 192.0.2.254 (211.0.0.0)
      Origin IGP, localpref 0, valid, internal
      Received Path ID 1, Local Path ID 0, version 0
      Originator: 211.0.0.0, Cluster list: 192.0.2.254, 201.0.0.0, 202.0.0.0
…

  Path #128: Received by speaker 0
  Not advertised to any peer
  Local
    25.0.23.6 (metric 50) from 198.51.100.233 (195.0.0.23)
      Origin IGP, localpref 0, valid, internal
      Received Path ID 32, Local Path ID 0, version 0
      Originator: 195.0.0.23, Cluster list: 198.51.99.255

The following example displays the BGP multipaths installed in the RIB.

Router# show route ipv4 200.0.0.0/28
Routing entry for 200.0.0.0/28
 Known via "bgp 1", distance 200, metric 0, type internal
 Installed Oct 17 04:06:41.027 for 00:01:22
 outing Descriptor Blocks
    10.0.1.6, from 198.51.100.1, BGP multi path
      Route metric is 0
    10.0.2.6, from 198.51.100.1, BGP multi path
      Route metric is 0
    …    
    10.0.32.6, from 198.51.100.1, BGP multi path
      Route metric is 0
    198.51.100.253, from 203.0.113.1, BGP multi path
      Route metric is 0
    …
    198.51.100.252, from 203.0.113.1, BGP multi path
      Route metric is 0
  No advertising protos.

The following example displays the BGP multipaths installed in Cisco Express Forwarding.

Router# show cef ipv4 200.0.0.0/28 detail
Level 1 - Load distribution: 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
 [0] via 10.0.1.6/32, recursive
 [1] via 10.0.2.6/32, recursive

 [62] via 203.0.113.211/32, recursive
 [63] via 203.0.112.211/32, recursive

  via 10.0.1.6/32, 257 dependencies, recursive, bgp-multipath [flags 0x6080]
  path-idx 0 NHID 0x0 [0x7a6cdf90 0x0]
  next hop 22.0.1.6/32 via 22.0.0.0/8

  Load distribution: 0 (refcount 1)
  Hash  OK  Interface              Address
  0     Y   TenGigE0/1/0/0/7       remote

 via 203.0.113.211/32, 257 dependencies, recursive, bgp-multipath [flags 0x6080]
 path-idx 62 NHID 0x0 [0x7a6ce058 0x0]
  next hop 203.0.112.211/32 via 203.0.0.0/8

  Load distribution: 0 (refcount 1)

  Hash  OK  Interface                 Address
  2    Y   TenGigE0/1/0/0/4          remote

  via 203.0.32.6/32, 257 dependencies, recursive, bgp-multipath [flags 0x6080]
  path-idx 63 NHID 0x0 [0x7a6ce058 0x0]
  next hop 203.0.32.6/32 via 203.0.0.0/8

  Load distribution: 0 (refcount 1)

  Hash  OK  Interface                 Address
  63    Y   TenGigE0/1/0/0/4          remote

BGP Next Hop Tracking

BGP receives notifications from the Routing Information Base (RIB) when next-hop information changes (event-driven notifications). BGP obtains next-hop information from the RIB to:

  • Determine whether a next hop is reachable.

  • Find the fully recursed IGP metric to the next hop (used in the best-path calculation).

  • Validate the received next hops.

  • Calculate the outgoing next hops.

  • Verify the reachability and connectedness of neighbors.

BGP is notified when any of the following events occurs:

  • Next hop becomes unreachable

  • Next hop becomes reachable

  • Fully recursed IGP metric to the next hop changes

  • First hop IP address or first hop interface change

  • Next hop becomes connected

  • Next hop becomes unconnected

  • Next hop becomes a local address

  • Next hop becomes a nonlocal address


Note


Reachability and recursed metric events trigger a best-path recalculation.


Event notifications from the RIB are classified as critical and noncritical. Notifications for critical and noncritical events are sent in separate batches. However, a noncritical event is sent along with the critical events if the noncritical event is pending and there is a request to read the critical events.

  • Critical events are related to the reachability (reachable and unreachable), connectivity (connected and unconnected), and locality (local and nonlocal) of the next hops. Notifications for these events are not delayed.

  • Noncritical events include only the IGP metric changes. These events are sent at an interval of 3 seconds. A metric change event is batched and sent 3 seconds after the last one was sent.

The next-hop trigger delay for critical and noncritical events can be configured to specify a minimum batching interval for critical and noncritical events using the nexthop trigger-delay command. The trigger delay is address family dependent.

The BGP next-hop tracking feature allows you to specify that BGP routes are resolved using only next hops whose routes have the following characteristics:

  • To avoid the aggregate routes, the prefix length must be greater than a specified value.

  • The source protocol must be from a selected list, ensuring that BGP routes are not used to resolve next hops that could lead to oscillation.

This route policy filtering is possible because RIB identifies the source protocol of route that resolved a next hop as well as the mask length associated with the route. The nexthop route-policy command is used to specify the route-policy.

For information on route policy filtering for next hops using the next-hop attach point, see the Implementing Routing Policy Language on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide (this publication).

Scoped IPv4/VPNv4 Table Walk

To determine which address family to process, a next-hop notification is received by first de-referencing the gateway context associated with the next hop, then looking into the gateway context to determine which address families are using the gateway context. The IPv4 unicast and VPNv4 unicast address families share the same gateway context, because they are registered with the IPv4 unicast table in the RIB. As a result, both the global IPv4 unicast table and the VPNv4 table are is processed when an IPv4 unicast next-hop notification is received from the RIB. A mask is maintained in the next hop, indicating if whether the next hop belongs to IPv4 unicast or VPNv4 unicast, or both. This scoped table walk localizes the processing in the appropriate address family table.

Reordered Address Family Processing

The Cisco IOS XR software walks address family tables based on the numeric value of the address family. When a next-hop notification batch is received, the order of address family processing is reordered to the following order:

  • IPv4 tunnel

  • VPNv4 unicast

  • IPv4 labeled unicast

  • IPv4 unicast

  • IPv4 multicast

  • IPv6 unicast

New Thread for Next-Hop Processing

The critical-event thread in the spkr process handles only next-hop, Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD), and fast-external-failover (FEF) notifications. This critical-event thread ensures that BGP convergence is not adversely impacted by other events that may take a significant amount of time.

show, clear, and debug Commands

The show bgp nexthops command provides statistical information about next-hop notifications, the amount of time spent in processing those notifications, and details about each next hop registered with the RIB. The clear bgp nexthop performance-statistics command ensures that the cumulative statistics associated with the processing part of the next-hop show command can be cleared to help in monitoring. The clear bgp nexthop registration command performs an asynchronous registration of the next hop with the RIB. See the BGP Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Routing Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routersfor information on the next-hop show and clear commands.

The debug bgp nexthop command displays information on next-hop processing. The out keyword provides debug information only about BGP registration of next hops with RIB. The in keyword displays debug information about next-hop notifications received from RIB. The out keyword displays debug information about next-hop notifications sent to the RIB. See the BGP Debug Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Debug Command Reference.

Autonomous System Number Formats in BGP

Autonomous system numbers (ASNs) are globally unique identifiers used to identify autonomous systems (ASs) and enable ASs to exchange exterior routing information between neighboring ASs. A unique ASN is allocated to each AS for use in BGP routing. ASNs are encoded as 2-byte numbers and 4-byte numbers in BGP.


RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# as-format [asdot | asplain]
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# as-format asdot


Note


ASN change for BGP process is not currently supported via commit replace command.


2-byte Autonomous System Number Format

The 2-byte ASNs are represented in asplain notation. The 2-byte range is 1 to 65535.

4-byte Autonomous System Number Format

To prepare for the eventual exhaustion of 2-byte Autonomous System Numbers (ASNs), BGP has the capability to support 4-byte ASNs. The 4-byte ASNs are represented both in asplain and asdot notations.

The byte range for 4-byte ASNs in asplain notation is 1-4294967295. The AS is represented as a 4-byte decimal number. The 4-byte ASN asplain representation is defined in draft-ietf-idr-as-representation-01.txt.

For 4-byte ASNs in asdot format, the 4-byte range is 1.0 to 65535.65535 and the format is:

high-order-16-bit-value-in-decimal . low-order-16-bit-value-in-decimal

The BGP 4-byte ASN capability is used to propagate 4-byte-based AS path information across BGP speakers that do not support 4-byte AS numbers. See draft-ietf-idr-as4bytes-12.txt for information on increasing the size of an ASN from 2 bytes to 4 bytes. AS is represented as a 4-byte decimal number

as-format Command

The as-format command configures the ASN notation to asdot. The default value, if the as-format command is not configured, is asplain.

BGP Configuration

BGP in Cisco IOS XR software follows a neighbor-based configuration model that requires that all configurations for a particular neighbor be grouped in one place under the neighbor configuration. Peer groups are not supported for either sharing configuration between neighbors or for sharing update messages. The concept of peer group has been replaced by a set of configuration groups to be used as templates in BGP configuration and automatically generated update groups to share update messages between neighbors.

Configuration Modes

BGP configurations are grouped into modes. The following sections show how to enter some of the BGP configuration modes. From a mode, you can enter the ? command to display the commands available in that mode.

Router Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter router configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configuration
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# 
  
Router Address Family Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter router address family configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 112
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#
  
Neighbor Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter neighbor configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)#
  
Defining Source Address for Update-Source Interface
The following configuration defines the source address for Update-Source Interface.
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show run interface Bundle-Ether81
interface Bundle-Ether81
ipv6 address 2001:db8:19:200::1/48
ipv6 address 2001:db8:2:b0::d1/126
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 4230
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 2001:db8:4::5043:432b
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# local address 2001:db8:2:b0::d1
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# update-source Bundle-Ether81
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# commit

Running Configuration

interface Bundle-Ether81
ipv6 address 2001:db8:19:200::1/48
ipv6 address 2001:db8:2:b0::d1/126
!
router bgp 4230
neighbor 2001:db8:4::5043:432b
local address 2001:db8:2:b0::d1
update-source Bundle-Ether81
!
Neighbor Address Family Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter neighbor address family configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 112
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)#
  
VRF Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)#
  
VRF Address Family Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter VRF address family configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 112
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)#
  
Configuring Resilient Per-CE Label Mode Under VRF Address Family

Perform this task to configure resilient per-ce label mode under VRF address family.


Note


Resilient per-CE 6PE label allocation is not supported on CRS-1 and CRS-3 routers, but supported only on ASR 9000 routers.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgpas-number
  3. vrfvrf-instance
  4. address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast
  5. label mode per-ce
  6. Do one of the following:
    • end
    • commit

DETAILED STEPS


Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgpas-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 666
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

vrfvrf-instance

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf-pe
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)#

Configures a VRF instance.

Step 4

address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)#

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 5

label mode per-ce

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# label mode per-ce
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)#

Configures resilient per-ce label mode.

Step 6

Do one of the following:

  • end
  • commit
Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# end

or


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# commit

Saves configuration changes.

  • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes:

    
      Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]:
    • Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode.

    • Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes.

    • Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes.

  • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session.


Configuring Resilient Per-CE Label Mode Using a Route-Policy

Perform this task to configure resilient per-ce label mode using a route-policy.


Note


Resilient per-CE 6PE label allocation is not supported on CRS-1 and CRS-3 routers, but supported only on ASR 9000 routers.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. route-policypolicy-name
  3. set label mode per-ce
  4. Do one of the following:
    • end
    • commit

DETAILED STEPS


Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

route-policypolicy-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy route1
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#

Creates a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode.

Step 3

set label mode per-ce

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set label mode per-ce
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#

Configures resilient per-ce label mode.

Step 4

Do one of the following:

  • end
  • commit
Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end

or


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# commit

Saves configuration changes.

  • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes:

    
      Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]:
    • Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode.

    • Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes.

    • Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes.

  • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session.


VRF Neighbor Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter VRF neighbor configuration mode:


  Router(config)# router bgp 140
  Router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A
  Router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 11.0.1.2
  Router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# 
  
VRF Neighbor Address Family Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter VRF neighbor address family configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 112
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 11.0.1.2 
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)#
  
VPNv4 Address Family Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter VPNv4 address family configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 152
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# 
  
L2VPN Address Family Configuration Mode

The following example shows how to enter L2VPN address family configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family l2vpn vpls-vpws
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#
  

Neighbor Submode 

Cisco IOS XR BGP uses a neighbor submode to make it possible to enter configurations without having to prefix every configuration with the neighbor keyword and the neighbor address:

  • Cisco IOS XR software has a submode available for neighbors in which it is not necessary for every command to have a “neighbor x.x.x.x” prefix:

    In Cisco IOS XR software, the configuration is as follows:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.23.1.2
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  • An address family configuration submode inside the neighbor configuration submode is available for entering address family-specific neighbor configurations. In Cisco IOS XR software, the configuration is as follows:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 2002::2
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2023
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv6 unicast
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# next-hop-self
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy one in
  • You must enter neighbor-specific IPv4, IPv6, VPNv4, or VPNv6 commands in neighbor address-family configuration submode. In Cisco IOS XR software, the configuration is as follows:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 109
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.40.24
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# maximum-prefix 1000
                
  • You must enter neighbor-specific IPv4 and IPv6 commands in VRF neighbor address-family configuration submode. In Cisco IOS XR software, the configuration is as follows:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 110
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_A 
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 11.0.1.2
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy pass all in
      
                

Configuration Templates

The af-group, session-group, and neighbor-group configuration commands provide template support for the neighbor configuration in Cisco IOS XR software.

The af-group command is used to group address family-specific neighbor commands within an IPv4, IPv6, or VPNv4, address family. Neighbors that have the same address family configuration are able to use the address family group (af-group) name for their address family-specific configuration. A neighbor inherits the configuration from an address family group by way of the use command. If a neighbor is configured to use an address family group, the neighbor (by default) inherits the entire configuration from the address family group. However, a neighbor does not inherit all of the configuration from the address family group if items are explicitly configured for the neighbor. The address family group configuration is entered under the BGP router configuration mode. The following example shows how to enter address family group configuration mode.


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group afmcast1 address-family ipv4 unicast
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)#
    

The session-group command allows you to create a session group from which neighbors can inherit address family-independent configuration. A neighbor inherits the configuration from a session group by way of the use command. If a neighbor is configured to use a session group, the neighbor (by default) inherits the entire configuration of the session group. A neighbor does not inherit all of the configuration from a session group if a configuration is done directly on that neighbor. The following example shows how to enter session group configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# router bgp 140
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group session1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# 
   

The neighbor-group command helps you apply the same configuration to one or more neighbors. Neighbor groups can include session groups and address family groups and can comprise the complete configuration for a neighbor. After a neighbor group is configured, a neighbor can inherit the configuration of the group using the use command. If a neighbor is configured to use a neighbor group, the neighbor inherits the entire BGP configuration of the neighbor group.

The following example shows how to enter neighbor group configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 123
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group nbrgroup1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)#
    

The following example shows how to enter neighbor group address family configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group nbrgroup1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)#
    
  • However, a neighbor does not inherit all of the configuration from the neighbor group if items are explicitly configured for the neighbor. In addition, some part of the configuration of the neighbor group could be hidden if a session group or address family group was also being used.

Configuration grouping has the following effects in Cisco IOS XR software:

  • Commands entered at the session group level define address family-independent commands (the same commands as in the neighbor submode).

  • Commands entered at the address family group level define address family-dependent commands for a specified address family (the same commands as in the neighbor-address family configuration submode).

  • Commands entered at the neighbor group level define address family-independent commands and address family-dependent commands for each address family (the same as all available neighbor commands), and define the use command for the address family group and session group commands.

Template Inheritance Rules

In Cisco IOS XR software, BGP neighbors or groups inherit configuration from other configuration groups.

For address family-independent configurations:

  • Neighbors can inherit from session groups and neighbor groups.

  • Neighbor groups can inherit from session groups and other neighbor groups.

  • Session groups can inherit from other session groups.

  • If a neighbor uses a session group and a neighbor group, the configurations in the session group are preferred over the global address family configurations in the neighbor group.

For address family-dependent configurations:

  • Address family groups can inherit from other address family groups.

  • Neighbor groups can inherit from address family groups and other neighbor groups.

  • Neighbors can inherit from address family groups and neighbor groups.

Configuration group inheritance rules are numbered in order of precedence as follows:

  1. If the item is configured directly on the neighbor, that value is used. In the example that follows, the advertisement interval is configured both on the neighbor group and neighbor configuration and the advertisement interval being used is from the neighbor configuration:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 15
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.1.1.1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group AS_1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# advertisement-interval 20
    
    

    The show bgp neighbor output shows the cumulative number for the Prefix advertised count if the same prefixes are withdrawn and re-advertised.

    The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 20 seconds:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbors 10.1.1.1
      
      BGP neighbor is 10.1.1.1, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link
       Remote router ID 0.0.0.0
        BGP state = Idle
        Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
        Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Minimum time between advertisement runs is 20 seconds
      
       For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
        BGP neighbor version 0
        Update group: 0.1
        eBGP neighbor with no inbound or outbound policy; defaults to 'drop'
        Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0
        0 accepted prefixes
        Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288
        Threshold for warning message 75%
      
        Connections established 0; dropped 0
        Last reset 00:00:14, due to BGP neighbor initialized
        External BGP neighbor not directly connected.
      
  2. Otherwise, if an item is configured to be inherited from a session-group or neighbor-group and on the neighbor directly, then the configuration on the neighbor is used. If a neighbor is configured to be inherited from session-group or af-group, but no directly configured value, then the value in the session-group or af-group is used. In the example that follows, the advertisement interval is configured on a neighbor group and a session group and the advertisement interval value being used is from the session group:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group AS_2
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# advertisement-interval 15
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 20
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.0.1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use session-group AS_2
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group AS_1
    
    The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 15 seconds:
    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbors 192.168.0.1
      
      BGP neighbor is 192.168.0.1, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link
       Remote router ID 0.0.0.0
        BGP state = Idle
        Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
        Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Minimum time between advertisement runs is 15 seconds
      
       For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
        BGP neighbor version 0
        Update group: 0.1
        eBGP neighbor with no inbound or outbound policy; defaults to 'drop'
        Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0
        0 accepted prefixes
        Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288
        Threshold for warning message 75%
      
        Connections established 0; dropped 0
        Last reset 00:03:23, due to BGP neighbor initialized
        External BGP neighbor not directly connected.
      
  3. Otherwise, if the neighbor uses a neighbor group and does not use a session group or address family group, the configuration value can be obtained from the neighbor group either directly or through inheritance. In the example that follows, the advertisement interval from the neighbor group is used because it is not configured directly on the neighbor and no session group is used:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 150
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group AS_2
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# advertisement-interval 20
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 15
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.1.1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group AS_1
       
    The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 15 seconds:
    
       RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbors 192.168.1.1
      
      BGP neighbor is 192.168.2.2, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link
       Remote router ID 0.0.0.0
        BGP state = Idle
        Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
        Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Minimum time between advertisement runs is 15 seconds
      
       For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
        BGP neighbor version 0
        Update group: 0.1
        eBGP neighbor with no outbound policy; defaults to 'drop'
        Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0
        Inbound path policy configured
        Policy for incoming advertisements is POLICY_1
        0 accepted prefixes
        Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288
        Threshold for warning message 75%
      
        Connections established 0; dropped 0
        Last reset 00:01:14, due to BGP neighbor initialized
        External BGP neighbor not directly connected.
      
    To illustrate the same rule, the following example shows how to set the advertisement interval to 15 (from the session group) and 25 (from the neighbor group). The advertisement interval set in the session group overrides the one set in the neighbor group. The inbound policy is set to POLICY_1 from the neighbor group.
    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerconfig)# router bgp 140
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group ADV
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# advertisement-interval 15
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group ADV_2
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 25
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# route-policy POLICY_1 in
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.2.2
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use session-group ADV
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group ADV_2
      
    The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 15 seconds:
    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbors 192.168.2.2
      
      BGP neighbor is 192.168.2.2, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link
       Remote router ID 0.0.0.0
        BGP state = Idle
        Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
        Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Minimum time between advertisement runs is 15 seconds
      
       For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
        BGP neighbor version 0
        Update group: 0.1
        eBGP neighbor with no inbound or outbound policy; defaults to 'drop'
        Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0
        0 accepted prefixes
        Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288
        Threshold for warning message 75%
      
        Connections established 0; dropped 0
        Last reset 00:02:03, due to BGP neighbor initialized
        External BGP neighbor not directly connected.
      
  4. Otherwise, the default value is used. In the example that follows, neighbor 10.0.101.5 has the minimum time between advertisement runs set to 30 seconds (default) because the neighbor is not configured to use the neighbor configuration or the neighbor group configuration:

    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# remote-as 1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group adv_15
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# remote-as 10
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# advertisement-interval 15
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.101.5
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group AS_1
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# exit
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.101.10
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group adv_15
      
    The following output from the show bgp neighbors command shows that the advertisement interval used is 30 seconds:
    
      RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbors 10.0.101.5
      
      BGP neighbor is 10.0.101.5, remote AS 1, local AS 140, external link
       Remote router ID 0.0.0.0
        BGP state = Idle
        Last read 00:00:00, hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
        Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
        Minimum time between advertisement runs is 30 seconds
      
       For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
        BGP neighbor version 0
        Update group: 0.2
        eBGP neighbor with no inbound or outbound policy; defaults to 'drop'
        Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0
        0 accepted prefixes
        Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0, maximum limit 524288
        Threshold for warning message 75%
      Connections established 0; dropped 0
        Last reset 00:00:25, due to BGP neighbor initialized
        External BGP neighbor not directly connected.
      

The inheritance rules used when groups are inheriting configuration from other groups are the same as the rules given for neighbors inheriting from groups.

Viewing Inherited Configurations

You can use the following show commands to view BGP inherited configurations:

show bgp neighbors

Use the show bgp neighbors command to display information about the BGP configuration for neighbors.

  • Use the configuration keyword to display the effective configuration for the neighbor, including any settings that have been inherited from session groups, neighbor groups, or address family groups used by this neighbor.

  • Use the inheritance keyword to display the session groups, neighbor groups, and address family groups from which this neighbor is capable of inheriting configuration.

The show bgp neighbors command examples that follow are based on this sample configuration:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 142
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_3 address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# next-hop-self
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# route-policy POLICY_1 in
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# advertisement-interval 15
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group GROUP_1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# use session-group GROUP_2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# ebgp-multihop 3
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# weight 100
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# send-community-ebgp
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit
  
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.0.1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group GROUP_1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# use af-group GROUP_3
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# weight 200
  
The following example displays sample output from the show bgp neighbors command using the inheritance keyword. The example shows that the neighbor inherits session parameters from neighbor group GROUP_1, which in turn inherits from session group GROUP_2. The neighbor inherits IPv4 unicast parameters from address family group GROUP_3 and IPv4 multicast parameters from neighbor group GROUP_1:

  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbors 192.168.0.1 inheritance 
  
    Session:        n:GROUP_1 s:GROUP_2
    IPv4 Unicast:   a:GROUP_3
    IPv4 Multicast: n:GROUP_1
    
The following example displays sample output from the show bgp neighbors command using the configuration keyword. The example shows from where each item of configuration was inherited, or if it was configured directly on the neighbor (indicated by [ ]). For example, the ebgp-multihop 3 command was inherited from neighbor group GROUP_1 and the next-hop-self command was inherited from the address family group GROUP_3:

  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbors 192.168.0.1 configuration 
  
  neighbor 192.168.0.1
   remote-as 2                   []
   advertisement-interval 15     [n:GROUP_1 s:GROUP_2]
   ebgp-multihop 3               [n:GROUP_1]
   address-family ipv4 unicast   []
    next-hop-self                [a:GROUP_3]
    route-policy POLICY_1    in  [a:GROUP_3]
    weight 200                   []
   address-family ipv4 multicast [n:GROUP_1]
    default-originate            [n:GROUP_1]
  
show bgp af-group

Use the show bgp af-group command to display address family groups:

  • Use the configuration keyword to display the effective configuration for the address family group, including any settings that have been inherited from address family groups used by this address family group.

  • Use the inheritance keyword to display the address family groups from which this address family group is capable of inheriting configuration.

  • Use the users keyword to display the neighbors, neighbor groups, and address family groups that inherit configuration from this address family group.

The show bgp af-group sample commands that follow are based on this sample configuration:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_3 address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# remove-private-as
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# route-policy POLICY_1 in
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_1 address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# use af-group GROUP_2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# maximum-prefix 2500 75 warning-only
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# default-originate
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_2 address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# use af-group GROUP_3
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# send-community-ebgp
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# send-extended-community-ebgp
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# capability orf prefix both
      

The following example displays sample output from the show bgp af-group command using the configuration keyword. This example shows from where each configuration item was inherited. The default-originate command was configured directly on this address family group (indicated by [ ]). The remove-private-as command was inherited from address family group GROUP_2, which in turn inherited from address family group GROUP_3:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp af-group GROUP_1 configuration 
  
  af-group GROUP_1 address-family ipv4 unicast
    capability orf prefix-list both           [a:GROUP_2]
    default-originate                         []
    maximum-prefix 2500 75 warning-only       []
    route-policy POLICY_1 in                  [a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3]
    remove-private-AS                         [a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3]
    send-community-ebgp                       [a:GROUP_2]
    send-extended-community-ebgp              [a:GROUP_2]
  
  

The following example displays sample output from the show bgp af-group command using the users keyword:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp af-group GROUP_2 users
  
  IPv4 Unicast: a:GROUP_1
  
  

The following example displays sample output from the show bgp af-group command using the inheritance keyword. This shows that the specified address family group GROUP_1 directly uses the GROUP_2 address family group, which in turn uses the GROUP_3 address family group:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp af-group GROUP_1 inheritance 
  
  IPv4 Unicast: a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3
  
show bgp session-group

Use the show bgp session-group command to display session groups:

  • Use the configuration keyword to display the effective configuration for the session group, including any settings that have been inherited from session groups used by this session group.

  • Use the inheritance keyword to display the session groups from which this session group is capable of inheriting configuration.

  • Use the users keyword to display the session groups, neighbor groups, and neighbors that inherit configuration from this session group.

The output from the show bgp session-group command is based on the following session group configuration:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 113
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# use session-group GROUP_2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# update-source Loopback 0
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# use session-group GROUP_3
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# ebgp-multihop 2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_3
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# dmz-link-bandwidth
  

The following is sample output from the show bgp session-group command with the configuration keyword in EXEC configuration mode:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp session-group GROUP_1 configuration 
  
  session-group GROUP_1
   ebgp-multihop 2         [s:GROUP_2]
   update-source Loopback0 []
   dmz-link-bandwidth      [s:GROUP_2 s:GROUP_3]
  

The following is sample output from the show bgp session-group command with the inheritance keyword showing that the GROUP_1 session group inherits session parameters from the GROUP_3 and GROUP_2 session groups:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp session-group GROUP_1 inheritance 
  
  Session: s:GROUP_2 s:GROUP_3
  

The following is sample output from the show bgp session-group command with the users keyword showing that both the GROUP_1 and GROUP_2 session groups inherit session parameters from the GROUP_3 session group:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp session-group GROUP_3 users 
  
  Session: s:GROUP_1 s:GROUP_2
  
show bgp neighbor-group

Use the show bgp neighbor-group command to display neighbor groups:

  • Use the configuration keyword to display the effective configuration for the neighbor group, including any settings that have been inherited from neighbor groups used by this neighbor group.

  • Use the inheritance keyword to display the address family groups, session groups, and neighbor groups from which this neighbor group is capable of inheriting configuration.

  • Use the users keyword to display the neighbors and neighbor groups that inherit configuration from this neighbor group.

The examples are based on the following group configuration:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 140
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_3 address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# remove-private-as
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# soft-reconfiguration inbound
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# af-group GROUP_2 address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# use af-group GROUP_3
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# send-community-ebgp
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# send-extended-community-ebgp
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# capability orf prefix both
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-afgrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# session-group GROUP_3
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# timers 30 90
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-sngrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group GROUP_1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# remote-as 1982
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# use neighbor-group GROUP_2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-nbrgrp)# exit
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group GROUP_2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# use session-group GROUP_3
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerconfig-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# use af-group GROUP_2
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# weight 100
   

The following is sample output from the show bgp neighbor-group command with the configuration keyword. The configuration setting source is shown to the right of each command. In the output shown previously, the remote autonomous system is configured directly on neighbor group GROUP_1, and the send community setting is inherited from neighbor group GROUP_2, which in turn inherits the setting from address family group GROUP_3:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbor-group GROUP_1 configuration 
  
     neighbor-group GROUP_1
      remote-as 1982                   []
      timers 30 90                     [n:GROUP_2 s:GROUP_3]
      address-family ipv4 unicast      []
       capability orf prefix-list both [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2]
       remove-private-AS               [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3]
       send-community-ebgp             [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2]
       send-extended-community-ebgp    [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2]
       soft-reconfiguration inbound    [n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3]
       weight 100                      [n:GROUP_2]
  
  

The following is sample output from the show bgp neighbor-group command with the inheritance keyword. This output shows that the specified neighbor group GROUP_1 inherits session (address family-independent) configuration parameters from neighbor group GROUP_2. Neighbor group GROUP_2 inherits its session parameters from session group GROUP_3. It also shows that the GROUP_1 neighbor group inherits IPv4 unicast configuration parameters from the GROUP_2 neighbor group, which in turn inherits them from the GROUP_2 address family group, which itself inherits them from the GROUP_3 address family group:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbor-group GROUP_1 inheritance 
  
      Session:      n:GROUP-2 s:GROUP_3
      IPv4 Unicast: n:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_2 a:GROUP_3
  
  

The following is sample output from the show bgp neighbor-group command with the users keyword. This output shows that the GROUP_1 neighbor group inherits session (address family-independent) configuration parameters from the GROUP_2 neighbor group. The GROUP_1 neighbor group also inherits IPv4 unicast configuration parameters from the GROUP_2 neighbor group:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp neighbor-group GROUP_2 users 
  
  Session:      n:GROUP_1
  IPv4 Unicast: n:GROUP_1
  

No Default Address Family

BGP does not support the concept of a default address family. An address family must be explicitly configured under the BGP router configuration for the address family to be activated in BGP. Similarly, an address family must be explicitly configured under a neighbor for the BGP session to be activated under that address family. It is not required to have any address family configured under the BGP router configuration level for a neighbor to be configured. However, it is a requirement to have an address family configured at the BGP router configuration level for the address family to be configured under a neighbor.

Neighbor Address Family Combinations

For default VRF, starting from Cisco IOS XR Software Release 6.2.x, both IPv4 Unicast and IPv4 Labeled-unicast address families are supported under the same neighbor.

For non-default VRF, both IPv4 Unicast and IPv4 Labeled-unicast address families are not supported under the same neighbor. However, the configuration is accepted on the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router with the following error:

bgp[1051]: %ROUTING-BGP-4-INCOMPATIBLE_AFI : IPv4 Unicast and IPv4 Labeled-unicast Address families together are not supported under the same neighbor.

When one BGP session has both IPv4 unicast and IPv4 labeled-unicast AFI/SAF, then the routing behavior is nondeterministic. Therefore, the prefixes may not be correctly advertised. Incorrect prefix advertisement results in reachability issues. In order to avoid such reachability issues, you must explicitly configure a route policy to advertise prefixes either through IPv4 unicast or through IPv4 labeled-unicast address families.

Routing Policy Enforcement

External BGP (eBGP) neighbors must have an inbound and outbound policy configured. If no policy is configured, no routes are accepted from the neighbor, nor are any routes advertised to it. This added security measure ensures that routes cannot accidentally be accepted or advertised in the case of a configuration omission error.


Note


This enforcement affects only eBGP neighbors (neighbors in a different autonomous system than this router). For internal BGP (iBGP) neighbors (neighbors in the same autonomous system), all routes are accepted or advertised if there is no policy.


In the following example, for an eBGP neighbor, if all routes should be accepted and advertised with no modifications, a simple pass-all policy is configured:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy pass-all
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# pass
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# commit
  

Use the route-policy (BGP) command in the neighbor address-family configuration mode to apply the pass-all policy to a neighbor. The following example shows how to allow all IPv4 unicast routes to be received from neighbor 192.168.40.42 and advertise all IPv4 unicast routes back to it:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 1
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 192.168.40.24
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 21
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all out
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit
 

Use the show bgp summary command to display eBGP neighbors that do not have both an inbound and outbound policy for every active address family. In the following example, such eBGP neighbors are indicated in the output with an exclamation (!) mark:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp all all summary
  
  Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
  ============================
  
  BGP router identifier 10.0.0.1, local AS number 1
  BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
  BGP main routing table version 41
  BGP scan interval 60 secs
  BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode.
  
  Process         RecvTblVer    bRIB/RIB  SendTblVer
  Speaker                 41          41          41
  
  Neighbor        Spk    AS MsgRcvd MsgSent   TblVer  InQ OutQ Up/Down  St/PfxRcd
  10.0.101.1        0     1     919     925       41    0    0 15:15:08       10
  10.0.101.2        0     2       0       0        0    0    0 00:00:00 Idle
  

  Address Family: IPv4 Multicast
  ==============================
  
  BGP router identifier 10.0.0.1, local AS number 1
  BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
  BGP main routing table version 1
  BGP scan interval 60 secs
  BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode.
  
  Process         RecvTblVer    bRIB/RIB  SendTblVer
  Speaker                  1           1           1
  
  Some configured eBGP neighbors do not have both inbound and
  outbound policies configured for IPv4 Multicast address family.
  These neighbors will default to sending and/or receiving no
  routes and are marked with ’!’ in the output below. Use the
  ’show bgp neighbor <nbr_address>’ command for details.
  
  Neighbor        Spk    AS MsgRcvd MsgSent   TblVer  InQ OutQ Up/Down  St/PfxRcd
  10.0.101.2        0     2       0       0        0    0    0 00:00:00 Idle!
  
  
  Address Family: IPv6 Unicast
  ============================
  
  BGP router identifier 10.0.0.1, local AS number 1
  BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
  BGP main routing table version 2
  BGP scan interval 60 secs
  BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode.
  
  Process         RecvTblVer    bRIB/RIB  SendTblVer
  Speaker                  2           2           2
  
  Neighbor        Spk    AS MsgRcvd MsgSent   TblVer  InQ OutQ Up/Down  St/PfxRcd
  2222::2           0     2     920     918        2    0    0 15:15:11        1
  2222::4           0     3       0       0        0    0    0 00:00:00 Idle
  
  
  Address Family: IPv6 Multicast
  ==============================
  
  BGP router identifier 10.0.0.1, local AS number 1
  BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
  BGP main routing table version 1
  BGP scan interval 60 secs
  BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode.
  
  Process         RecvTblVer    bRIB/RIB  SendTblVer
  Speaker                  1           1           1
  
  Some configured eBGP neighbors do not have both inbound and
  outbound policies configured for IPv6 Multicast address family.
  These neighbors will default to sending and/or receiving no
  routes and are marked with ’!’ in the output below. Use the
  ’show bgp neighbor <nbr_address>’ command for details.
  
  Neighbor        Spk    AS MsgRcvd MsgSent   TblVer  InQ OutQ Up/Down  St/PfxRcd
  2222::2           0     2     920     918        0    0    0 15:15:11        0
  2222::4           0     3       0       0        0    0    0 00:00:00 Idle!  

  

Table Policy

The table policy feature in BGP allows you to configure traffic index values on routes as they are installed in the global routing table. This feature is enabled using the table-policy command and supports the BGP policy accounting feature.

BGP policy accounting uses traffic indices that are set on BGP routes to track various counters. See the Implementing Routing Policy on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in the Routing Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers for details on table policy use. See the Cisco Express Forwarding Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in the IP Addresses and Services Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers for details on BGP policy accounting.

Table policy also provides the ability to drop routes from the RIB based on match criteria. This feature can be useful in certain applications and should be used with caution as it can easily create a routing ‘black hole’ where BGP advertises routes to neighbors that BGP does not install in its global routing table and forwarding table.

Update Groups

The BGP Update Groups feature contains an algorithm that dynamically calculates and optimizes update groups of neighbors that share outbound policies and can share the update messages. The BGP Update Groups feature separates update group replication from peer group configuration, improving convergence time and flexibility of neighbor configuration.

To use this feature, you must understand the following concepts:

BGP Update Generation and Update Groups

The BGP Update Groups feature separates BGP update generation from neighbor configuration. The BGP Update Groups feature introduces an algorithm that dynamically calculates BGP update group membership based on outbound routing policies. This feature does not require any configuration by the network operator. Update group-based message generation occurs automatically and independently.

BGP Update Group

When a change to the configuration occurs, the router automatically recalculates update group memberships and applies the changes.

For the best optimization of BGP update group generation, we recommend that the network operator keeps outbound routing policy the same for neighbors that have similar outbound policies. This feature contains commands for monitoring BGP update groups.

BGP Slow Peer Detection

A slow peer is a peer that cannot keep up with the rate at which update messages are generated over a prolonged period of time. A peer can experience this problem because of the following:

  • There is packet loss or high traffic on the link to the peer and the throughput of the BGP TCP connection, which is very low.

  • The peer is heavily loaded in terms of CPU and cannot service the TCP connection at the required frequency.

When a slow peer is present in an update group, the number of formatted updates pending transmission builds up. When the cache limit is reached, the group does not have any more quotas to format new messages. In order for new messages to be formatted, some of the existing messages must be transmitted by the slow peer and then removed from the cache. The rest of the members of the group that are faster than the slow peer and have completed the transmission of the formatted messages will not have anything new to send even though there might be newly modified BGP nets waiting to be advertised or withdrawn.

The BGP Slow Peer Detection feature detects slow peers when the oldest message in a peer queue is delayed for more than the slow peer time threshold of 300 seconds. Slow Peer detection is enabled by default.

When a slow peer is detected, a syslog message is displayed. The following are examples of the syslog messages.

%ROUTING-BGP-5-AF_SLOW_PEER : BGP neighbor 11.11.11.21 of afi 0 is detected asslow-peer
%ROUTING-BGP-5-AF_SLOW_PEER_RECOVERED : Slow BGP peer 11.11.11.21 of afi 0 hasrecovered

To disable slow peer detection, use the slow-peer detection disable command in router BGP configuration mode. To reenable slow peer detection, use the no slow-peer detection disable command in router BGP configuration mode.

BGP Cost Community

The BGP cost community is a nontransitive extended community attribute that is passed to internal BGP (iBGP) and confederation peers but not to external BGP (eBGP) peers. The cost community feature allows you to customize the local route preference and influence the best-path selection process by assigning cost values to specific routes. The extended community format defines generic points of insertion (POI) that influence the best-path decision at different points in the best-path algorithm.

The cost community attribute is applied to internal routes by configuring the set extcommunity cost command in a route policy. See the Routing Policy Language Commands on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference for information on the set extcommunity cost command. The cost community set clause is configured with a cost community ID number (0–255) and cost community number (0–4294967295). The cost community number determines the preference for the path. The path with the lowest cost community number is preferred. Paths that are not specifically configured with the cost community number are assigned a default cost community number of 2147483647 (the midpoint between 0 and 4294967295) and evaluated by the best-path selection process accordingly. When two paths have been configured with the same cost community number, the path selection process prefers the path with the lowest cost community ID. The cost-extended community attribute is propagated to iBGP peers when extended community exchange is enabled.

The following commands include the route-policy keyword, which you can use to apply a route policy that is configured with the cost community set clause:

  • aggregate-address

  • redistribute

  • network

How BGP Cost Community Influences the Best Path Selection Process

The cost community attribute influences the BGP best-path selection process at the point of insertion (POI). By default, the POI follows the Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) metric comparison. When BGP receives multiple paths to the same destination, it uses the best-path selection process to determine which path is the best path. BGP automatically makes the decision and installs the best path in the routing table. The POI allows you to assign a preference to a specific path when multiple equal cost paths are available. If the POI is not valid for local best-path selection, the cost community attribute is silently ignored.

Cost communities are sorted first by POI then by community ID. Multiple paths can be configured with the cost community attribute for the same POI. The path with the lowest cost community ID is considered first. In other words, all cost community paths for a specific POI are considered, starting with the one with the lowest cost community. Paths that do not contain the cost community cost (for the POI and community ID being evaluated) are assigned the default community cost value (2147483647). If the cost community values are equal, then cost community comparison proceeds to the next lowest community ID for this POI.

To select the path with the lower cost community, simultaneously walk through the cost communities of both paths. This is done by maintaining two pointers to the cost community chain, one for each path, and advancing both pointers to the next applicable cost community at each step of the walk for the given POI, in order of community ID, and stop when a best path is chosen or the comparison is a tie. At each step of the walk, the following checks are done:


  If neither pointer refers to a cost community,
       Declare a tie;
  
    Elseif a cost community is found for one path but not for the other,
       Choose the path with cost community as best path;
    Elseif the Community ID from one path is less than the other,
       Choose the path with the lesser Community ID as best path;
    Elseif the Cost from one path is less than the other,
       Choose the path with the lesser Cost as best path;
    Else Continue.
  

Note


Paths that are not configured with the cost community attribute are considered by the best-path selection process to have the default cost value (half of the maximum value [4294967295] or 2147483647).


Applying the cost community attribute at the POI allows you to assign a value to a path originated or learned by a peer in any part of the local autonomous system or confederation. The cost community can be used as a “tie breaker” during the best-path selection process. Multiple instances of the cost community can be configured for separate equal cost paths within the same autonomous system or confederation. For example, a lower cost community value can be applied to a specific exit path in a network with multiple equal cost exit points, and the specific exit path is preferred by the BGP best-path selection process. See the scenario described inInfluencing Route Preference in a Multiexit IGP Network.


Note


The cost community comparison in BGP is enabled by default. Use the bgp bestpath cost-community ignore command to disable the comparison.


SeeBGP Best Path Algorithm for information on the BGP best-path selection process.

Cost Community Support for Aggregate Routes and Multipaths

The BGP cost community feature supports aggregate routes and multipaths. The cost community attribute can be applied to either type of route. The cost community attribute is passed to the aggregate or multipath route from component routes that carry the cost community attribute. Only unique IDs are passed, and only the highest cost of any individual component route is applied to the aggregate for each ID. If multiple component routes contain the same ID, the highest configured cost is applied to the route. For example, the following two component routes are configured with the cost community attribute using an inbound route policy:

  • 10.0.0.1
    • POI=IGP

    • cost community ID=1

    • cost number=100

  • 192.168.0.1
    • POI=IGP

    • cost community ID=1

    • cost number=200

    If these component routes are aggregated or configured as a multipath, the cost value 200 is advertised, because it has the highest cost.

    If one or more component routes do not carry the cost community attribute or the component routes are configured with different IDs, then the default value (2147483647) is advertised for the aggregate or multipath route. For example, the following three component routes are configured with the cost community attribute using an inbound route policy. However, the component routes are configured with two different IDs.

  • 10.0.0.1
    • POI=IGP

    • cost community ID=1

    • cost number=100

  • 172.16.0.1
    • POI=IGP

    • cost community ID=2

    • cost number=100

  • 192.168.0.1
    • POI=IGP

    • cost community ID=1

    • cost number=200

    The single advertised path includes the aggregate cost communities as follows:

    {POI=IGP, ID=1, Cost=2147483647} {POI-IGP, ID=2, Cost=2147483647}

Influencing Route Preference in a Multiexit IGP Network

This figure shows an IGP network with two autonomous system boundary routers (ASBRs) on the edge. Each ASBR has an equal cost path to network 10.8/16.

Figure 1. Multiexit Point IGP Network

Both paths are considered to be equal by BGP. If multipath loadsharing is configured, both paths to the routing table are installed and are used to balance the load of traffic. If multipath load balancing is not configured, the BGP selects the path that was learned first as the best path and installs this path to the routing table. This behavior may not be desirable under some conditions. For example, the path is learned from ISP1 PE2 first, but the link between ISP1 PE2 and ASBR1 is a low-speed link.

The configuration of the cost community attribute can be used to influence the BGP best-path selection process by applying a lower-cost community value to the path learned by ASBR2. For example, the following configuration is applied to ASBR2:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy ISP2_PE1
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set extcommunity cost (1:1)

The preceding route policy applies a cost community number of 1 to the 10.8.0.0 route. By default, the path learned from ASBR1 is assigned a cost community number of 2147483647. Because the path learned from ASBR2 has a lower-cost community number, the path is preferred.

BGP Cost Community Support for EIGRP MPLS VPN PE-CE with Back-door Links

Back-door links in an EIGRP MPLS VPN topology is preferred by BGP if the back-door link is learned first. (A back-door link, or route, is a connection that is configured outside of the VPN between a remote and main site; for example, a WAN leased line that connects a remote site to the corporate network.)

The “prebest path” point of insertion (POI) in the BGP cost community feature supports mixed EIGRP VPN network topologies that contain VPN and back-door links. This POI is applied automatically to EIGRP routes that are redistributed into BGP. The “prebest path” POI carries the EIGRP route type and metric. This POI influences the best-path calculation process by influencing BGP to consider the POI before any other comparison step. No configuration is required. This feature is enabled automatically for EIGRP VPN sites when Cisco IOS XR software is installed on a PE, CE, or back-door router.

For information about configuring EIGRP MPLS VPNs, see the MPLS Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers.

Figure 2. Network Showing How Cost Community Can be Used to Support Backdoor Links.

This figure shows how cost community can be used to support backdoor links in a network.

The following sequence of events happens in PE1:

  1. PE1 learns IPv4 prefix 10.1.1.0/24 from CE1 through EIGRP running a virtual routing and forwarding (VRF) instance. EIGRP selects and installs the best path in the RIB. It also encodes the cost-extended community and adds the information to the RIB.

  2. The route is redistributed into BGP (assuming that IGP-to-BGP redistribution is configured). BGP also receives the cost-extended community from the route through the redistribution process.

  3. After BGP has determined the best path for the newly redistributed prefix, the path is advertised to PE peers (PE2).

  4. PE2 receives the BGP VPNv4 prefix route_distinguisher:10.1.1.0/24 along with the cost community. It is likely that CE2 advertises the same prefix (because of the back-door link between CE1 and CE2) to PE2 through EIGRP. PE2 BGP would have already learned the CE route through the redistribution process along with the cost community value

  5. PE2 has two paths within BGP: one with cost community cost1 through multipath BGP (PE1) and another with cost community cost2 through the EIGRP neighbor (CE2).

  6. PE2 runs the enhanced BGP best-path calculation.

  7. PE2 installs the best path in the RIB passing the appropriate cost community value.

  8. PE2 RIB has two paths for 10.1.1.0/24: one with cost community cost2 added by EIGRP and another with the cost community cost1 added by BGP. Because both the route paths have cost community, RIB compares the costs first. The BGP path has the lower cost community, so it is selected and downloaded to the RIB.

  9. PE2 RIB redistributes the BGP path into EIGRP with VRF. EIGRP runs a diffusing update algorithm (DUAL) because there are two paths, and selects the BGP-redistributed path.

  10. PE2 EIGRP advertises the path to CE2 making the path the next hop for the prefix to send the traffic over the MPLS network.

Adding Routes to the Routing Information Base

If a nonsourced path becomes the best path after the best-path calculation, BGP adds the route to the Routing Information Base (RIB) and passes the cost communities along with the other IGP extended communities.

When a route with paths is added to the RIB by a protocol, RIB checks the current best paths for the route and the added paths for cost extended communities. If cost-extended communities are found, the RIB compares the set of cost communities. If the comparison does not result in a tie, the appropriate best path is chosen. If the comparison results in a tie, the RIB proceeds with the remaining steps of the best-path algorithm. If a cost community is not present in either the current best paths or added paths, then the RIB continues with the remaining steps of the best-path algorithm. See BGP Best Path Algorithm for information on the BGP best-path algorithm.

BGP DMZ Aggregate Bandwidth

BGP supports aggregating dmz-link bandwidth values of external BGP (eBGP) multipaths when advertising the route to interior BGP (iBGP) peer.

There is no explicit command to aggregate bandwidth. The bandwidth is aggregated if following conditions are met:
  • The network has multipaths and all the multipaths have link-bandwidth values.

  • The next-hop attribute set to next-hop-self. The next-hop attribute for all routes advertised to the specified neighbor to the address of the local router.

  • There is no out-bound policy configured that might change the dmz-link bandwidth value.


Note


  • If the dmz-link bandwidth value is not known for any one of the multipaths (eBGP or iBGP), the dmz-link value for all multipaths including the best path is not downloaded to routing information base (RIB).

  • The dmz-link bandwidth value of iBGP multipath is not considered during aggregation.

  • The route that is advertised with aggregate value can be best path or add-path.

  • Add-path does not qualify for DMZ link bandwidth aggregation as next hop is preserved. Configuring next-hop-self for add-path is not supported.

  • For VPNv4 and VPNv6 afi, if dmz link-bandwidth value is configured using outbound route-policy, specify the route table or use the additive keyword. Else, this will lead to routes not imported on the receiving end of the peer.
    extcommunity-set bandwidth dmz_ext
       1:8000
     end-set
     !
     route-policy dmz_rp_vpn
       set extcommunity bandwidth dmz_ext additive     <<< 'additive' keyword.
       pass
     end-policy
    

Example

Consider two routers Router 1 and Router 2 that are connected to internal routers in a network. Router 1 advertises a bandwidth of 50 and 20 from two different ISPs. Router 2 advertises a bandwidth of 60 and 30 from two different ISPs. With the best-path algorithm, Router 1 advertises a bandwidth of 50 and Router 2 advertises a bandwidth of 60 to the internal routers. This reduces traffic flow. But by aggregating the bandwidth, Router 1 advertises a bandwidth of 70 (50 + 20) and Router 2 advertises a bandwidth of 90 (60 + 30). This increases the traffic flow.

Configuring BGP DMZ Aggregate Bandwidth: Example

This is a sample configuration for Border Gateway Protocol Demilitarized Zone (BGP DMZ) link bandwidth. Consider the topology, R1---(iBGP)---R2---(iBGP)---R3:

  1. On R1:
    bgp: prefix p/n has:
    path 1(bestpath)       with LB value 100
    path 2(ebgp multipath) with LB value 30
    path 3(ebgp multipath) with LB value 50
    
    When best path is advertised to R2, send aggregated dmz-link bandwidth value of 180; aggregated value of paths 1, 2 and 3.
  2. On R2:
    bgp: prefix p/n has:
    path 1(bestpath)       with LB value 60
    path 2(ebgp multipath) with LB value 200
    path 3(ebgp multipath) with LB value 50
    
    When best path is advertised to R3, send aggregated dmz-link bandwidth value of 310; aggregated value of paths 1, 2 and 3.
  3. On R3:
    bgp: prefix p/n has:
    path 1(bestpath)       with LB 180 {learned from R1}
    path 2(ibgp multipath) with LB 310 {learned from R2}
    

Configuring Policy-based Link Bandwidth: Example

This is a sample configuration for policy-based DMZ link bandwidth. The link-bandwidth ext-community can be set on a per-path basis either at the neighbor-in or neighbor-out policy attach-points. The dmz-link-bandwidth knob is configured under eBGP neighbor configuration mode. All paths received from that particular neighbor will be marked with the link-bandwidth extended community when sent to iBGP peers.

  1. Configure inbound or outbound route-policy.
    extcommunity-set bandwidth dmz_ext
      1:1290400000
    end-set
    !
    route-policy dmz_rp
      set extcommunity bandwidth dmz_ext
      pass
    end-policy
    !
    
     neighbor 10.0.101.1
      remote-as 1001
      address-family ipv4 unicast
       route-policy dmz_rp in          <<< Inbound route-policy.
       route-policy pass out
      !
    
  2. Configure dmz-link-bandwidth under BGP neighbor.
    neighbor 10.0.101.2
      remote-as 1001
      dmz-link-bandwidth               <<< Under neighbor.
      address-family ipv4 unicast
       route-policy pass in
       route-policy pass out
      !
    

For more information on policy-based extended community set, see the Implementing Routing Policy chapter in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide .

64-ECMP Support for BGP

IOS XR supports configuration of up to 64 equal cost multipath (ECMP) next hops for BGP. 64-ECMP is required in networks, where overloaded routers can load balance the traffic over as many as 64 LSPs.

More than 32 ECMP and UCMP paths are not supported for these features:

  • LI

  • GRE

  • BVI

  • NetFlow

  • Satellite

  • MCAST

  • SPAN

  • PWHE

  • ABF

  • P2MP

  • MVPN

  • VPLS

  • L2TPv3

  • LISP

  • VIDMON

  • PBR

BGP Best Path Algorithm

BGP routers typically receive multiple paths to the same destination. The BGP best-path algorithm determines the best path to install in the IP routing table and to use for forwarding traffic. This section describes the Cisco IOS XR software implementation of BGP best-path algorithm, as specified in Section 9.1 of the Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF) Network Working Group draft-ietf-idr-bgp4-24.txt document.

The BGP best-path algorithm implementation is in three parts:

  • Part 1—Compares two paths to determine which is better.

  • Part 2—Iterates over all paths and determines which order to compare the paths to select the overall best path.

  • Part 3—Determines whether the old and new best paths differ enough so that the new best path should be used.


Note


The order of comparison determined by Part 2 is important because the comparison operation is not transitive; that is, if three paths, A, B, and C exist, such that when A and B are compared, A is better, and when B and C are compared, B is better, it is not necessarily the case that when A and C are compared, A is better. This nontransitivity arises because the multi exit discriminator (MED) is compared only among paths from the same neighboring autonomous system (AS) and not among all paths.


Comparing Pairs of Paths

Perform the following steps to compare two paths and determine the better path:

  1. If either path is invalid (for example, a path has the maximum possible MED value or it has an unreachable next hop), then the other path is chosen (provided that the path is valid).

  2. If the paths have unequal pre-bestpath cost communities, the path with the lower pre-bestpath cost community is selected as the best path.

  3. If the paths have unequal weights, the path with the highest weight is chosen.

    Note


    The weight is entirely local to the router, and can be set with the weight command or using a routing policy.


  4. If the paths have unequal local preferences, the path with the higher local preference is chosen.


    Note


    If a local preference attribute was received with the path or was set by a routing policy, then that value is used in this comparison. Otherwise, the default local preference value of 100 is used. The default value can be changed using the bgp default local-preference command.


  5. If one of the paths is a redistributed path, which results from a redistribute or network command, then it is chosen. Otherwise, if one of the paths is a locally generated aggregate, which results from an aggregate-address command, it is chosen.


    Note


    Step 1 through Step 4 implement the “Path Selection with BGP”of RFC 1268.


  6. If the paths have unequal AS path lengths, the path with the shorter AS path is chosen. This step is skipped if bgp bestpath as-path ignore command is configured.


    Note


    When calculating the length of the AS path, confederation segments are ignored, and AS sets count as 1.



    Note


    eiBGP specifies internal and external BGP multipath peers. eiBGP allows simultaneous use of internal and external paths.


  7. If the paths have different origins, the path with the lower origin is selected. Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) is considered lower than EGP, which is considered lower than INCOMPLETE.

  8. If appropriate, the MED of the paths is compared. If they are unequal, the path with the lower MED is chosen.

    A number of configuration options exist that affect whether or not this step is performed. In general, the MED is compared if both paths were received from neighbors in the same AS; otherwise the MED comparison is skipped. However, this behavior is modified by certain configuration options, and there are also some corner cases to consider.

    If the bgp bestpath med always command is configured, then the MED comparison is always performed, regardless of neighbor AS in the paths. Otherwise, MED comparison depends on the AS paths of the two paths being compared, as follows:

    • If a path has no AS path or the AS path starts with an AS_SET, then the path is considered to be internal, and the MED is compared with other internal paths.

    • If the AS path starts with an AS_SEQUENCE, then the neighbor AS is the first AS number in the sequence, and the MED is compared with other paths that have the same neighbor AS.

    • If the AS path contains only confederation segments or starts with confederation segments followed by an AS_SET, then the MED is not compared with any other path unless the bgp bestpath med confed command is configured. In that case, the path is considered internal and the MED is compared with other internal paths.

    • If the AS path starts with confederation segments followed by an AS_SEQUENCE, then the neighbor AS is the first AS number in the AS_SEQUENCE, and the MED is compared with other paths that have the same neighbor AS.


    Note


    If no MED attribute was received with the path, then the MED is considered to be 0 unless the bgp bestpath med missing-as-worst command is configured. In that case, if no MED attribute was received, the MED is considered to be the highest possible value.


  9. If one path is received from an external peer and the other is received from an internal (or confederation) peer, the path from the external peer is chosen.

  10. If the paths have different IGP metrics to their next hops, the path with the lower IGP metric is chosen.

  11. If the paths have unequal IP cost communities, the path with the lower IP cost community is selected as the best path.

  12. If all path parameters in Step 1 through Step 10 are the same, then the router IDs are compared. If the path was received with an originator attribute, then that is used as the router ID to compare; otherwise, the router ID of the neighbor from which the path was received is used. If the paths have different router IDs, the path with the lower router ID is chosen.


    Note


    Where the originator is used as the router ID, it is possible to have two paths with the same router ID. It is also possible to have two BGP sessions with the same peer router, and therefore receive two paths with the same router ID.


  13. If the paths have different cluster lengths, the path with the shorter cluster length is selected. If a path was not received with a cluster list attribute, it is considered to have a cluster length of 0.

  14. Finally, the path received from the neighbor with the lower IP address is chosen. Locally generated paths (for example, redistributed paths) are considered to have a neighbor IP address of 0.

Order of Comparisons

The second part of the BGP best-path algorithm implementation determines the order in which the paths should be compared. The order of comparison is determined as follows:

  1. The paths are partitioned into groups such that within each group the MED can be compared among all paths. The same rules as in are used to determine whether MED can be compared between any two paths. Normally, this comparison results in one group for each neighbor AS. If the bgp bestpath med always command is configured, then there is just one group containing all the paths.

  2. The best path in each group is determined. Determining the best path is achieved by iterating through all paths in the group and keeping track of the best one seen so far. Each path is compared with the best-so-far, and if it is better, it becomes the new best-so-far and is compared with the next path in the group.

  3. A set of paths is formed containing the best path selected from each group in Step 2. The overall best path is selected from this set of paths, by iterating through them as in Step 2.

Best Path Change Suppression

The third part of the implementation is to determine whether the best-path change can be suppressed or not—whether the new best path should be used, or continue using the existing best path. The existing best path can continue to be used if the new one is identical to the point at which the best-path selection algorithm becomes arbitrary (if the router-id is the same). Continuing to use the existing best path can avoid churn in the network.


Note


This suppression behavior does not comply with the IETF Networking Working Group draft-ietf-idr-bgp4-24.txt document, but is specified in the IETF Networking Working Group draft-ietf-idr-avoid-transition-00.txt document.


The suppression behavior can be turned off by configuring the bgp bestpath compare-routerid command. If this command is configured, the new best path is always preferred to the existing one.

Otherwise, the following steps are used to determine whether the best-path change can be suppressed:

  1. If the existing best path is no longer valid, the change cannot be suppressed.

  2. If either the existing or new best paths were received from internal (or confederation) peers or were locally generated (for example, by redistribution), then the change cannot be suppressed. That is, suppression is possible only if both paths were received from external peers.

  3. If the paths were received from the same peer (the paths would have the same router-id), the change cannot be suppressed. The router ID is calculated using rules in .

  4. If the paths have different weights, local preferences, origins, or IGP metrics to their next hops, then the change cannot be suppressed. Note that all these values are calculated using the rules in .

  5. If the paths have different-length AS paths and the bgp bestpath as-path ignore command is not configured, then the change cannot be suppressed. Again, the AS path length is calculated using the rules in .

  6. If the MED of the paths can be compared and the MEDs are different, then the change cannot be suppressed. The decision as to whether the MEDs can be compared is exactly the same as the rules in , as is the calculation of the MED value.

  7. If all path parameters in Step 1 through Step 6 do not apply, the change can be suppressed.

Administrative Distance

An administrative distance is a rating of the trustworthiness of a routing information source. In general, the higher the value, the lower the trust rating. For information on specifying the administrative distance for BGP, see the BGP Commands module of the Routing Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers

Normally, a route can be learned through more than one protocol. Administrative distance is used to discriminate between routes learned from more than one protocol. The route with the lowest administrative distance is installed in the IP routing table. By default, BGP uses the administrative distances shown in Table 1.

Table 2. BGP Default Administrative Distances

Distance

Default Value

Function

External

20

Applied to routes learned from eBGP.

Internal

200

Applied to routes learned from iBGP.

Local

200

Applied to routes originated by the router.


Note


Distance does not influence the BGP path selection algorithm, but it does influence whether BGP-learned routes are installed in the IP routing table.


In most cases, when a route is learned through eBGP, it is installed in the IP routing table because of its distance (20). Sometimes, however, two ASs have an IGP-learned back-door route and an eBGP-learned route. Their policy might be to use the IGP-learned path as the preferred path and to use the eBGP-learned path when the IGP path is down. See Back Door Example .

Figure 3. Back Door Example

In Back Door Example , Routers A and C and Routers B and C are running eBGP. Routers A and B are running an IGP (such as Routing Information Protocol [RIP], Interior Gateway Routing Protocol [IGRP], Enhanced IGRP, or Open Shortest Path First [OSPF]). The default distances for RIP, IGRP, Enhanced IGRP, and OSPF are 120, 100, 90, and 110, respectively. All these distances are higher than the default distance of eBGP, which is 20. Usually, the route with the lowest distance is preferred.

Router A receives updates about 160.10.0.0 from two routing protocols: eBGP and IGP. Because the default distance for eBGP is lower than the default distance of the IGP, Router A chooses the eBGP-learned route from Router C. If you want Router A to learn about 160.10.0.0 from Router B (IGP), establish a BGP back door. See .

In the following example, a network back-door is configured:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# network 160.10.0.0/16 backdoor

Router A treats the eBGP-learned route as local and installs it in the IP routing table with a distance of 200. The network is also learned through Enhanced IGRP (with a distance of 90), so the Enhanced IGRP route is successfully installed in the IP routing table and is used to forward traffic. If the Enhanced IGRP-learned route goes down, the eBGP-learned route is installed in the IP routing table and is used to forward traffic.

Although BGP treats network 160.10.0.0 as a local entry, it does not advertise network 160.10.0.0 as it normally would advertise a local entry.

Multiprotocol BGP

Multiprotocol BGP is an enhanced BGP that carries routing information for multiple network layer protocols and IP multicast routes. BGP carries two sets of routes, one set for unicast routing and one set for multicast routing. The routes associated with multicast routing are used by the Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) feature to build data distribution trees.

Multiprotocol BGP is useful when you want a link dedicated to multicast traffic, perhaps to limit which resources are used for which traffic. Multiprotocol BGP allows you to have a unicast routing topology different from a multicast routing topology providing more control over your network and resources.

In BGP, the only way to perform interdomain multicast routing was to use the BGP infrastructure that was in place for unicast routing. Perhaps you want all multicast traffic exchanged at one network access point (NAP). If those routers were not multicast capable, or there were differing policies for which you wanted multicast traffic to flow, multicast routing could not be supported without multiprotocol BGP.


Note


It is possible to configure BGP peers that exchange both unicast and multicast network layer reachability information (NLRI), but you cannot connect multiprotocol BGP clouds with a BGP cloud. That is, you cannot redistribute multiprotocol BGP routes into BGP.


Noncongruent Unicast and Multicast Routes illustrates simple unicast and multicast topologies that are incongruent, and therefore are not possible without multiprotocol BGP.

Autonomous systems 100, 200, and 300 are each connected to two NAPs that are FDDI rings. One is used for unicast peering (and therefore the exchange of unicast traffic). The Multicast Friendly Interconnect (MFI) ring is used for multicast peering (and therefore the exchange of multicast traffic). Each router is unicast and multicast capable.

Figure 4. Noncongruent Unicast and Multicast Routes

Multicast BGP Environment is a topology of unicast-only routers and multicast-only routers. The two routers on the left are unicast-only routers (that is, they do not support or are not configured to perform multicast routing). The two routers on the right are multicast-only routers. Routers A and B support both unicast and multicast routing. The unicast-only and multicast-only routers are connected to a single NAP.

In Multicast BGP Environment, only unicast traffic can travel from Router A to the unicast routers to Router B and back. Multicast traffic could not flow on that path, so another routing table is required. Multicast traffic uses the path from Router A to the multicast routers to Router B and back.

Multicast BGP Environment illustrates a multiprotocol BGP environment with a separate unicast route and multicast route from Router A to Router B. Multiprotocol BGP allows these routes to be incongruent. Both of the autonomous systems must be configured for internal multiprotocol BGP (IMBGP) in the figure.

A multicast routing protocol, such as PIM, uses the multicast BGP database to perform Reverse Path Forwarding (RPF) lookups for multicast-capable sources. Thus, packets can be sent and accepted on the multicast topology but not on the unicast topology.

Figure 5. Multicast BGP Environment

Route Dampening

Route dampening is a BGP feature that minimizes the propagation of flapping routes across an internetwork. A route is considered to be flapping when it is repeatedly available, then unavailable, then available, then unavailable, and so on.

For example, consider a network with three BGP autonomous systems: autonomous system 1, autonomous system 2, and autonomous system 3. Suppose the route to network A in autonomous system 1 flaps (it becomes unavailable). Under circumstances without route dampening, the eBGP neighbor of autonomous system 1 to autonomous system 2 sends a withdraw message to autonomous system 2. The border router in autonomous system 2, in turn, propagates the withdrawal message to autonomous system 3. When the route to network A reappears, autonomous system 1 sends an advertisement message to autonomous system 2, which sends it to autonomous system 3. If the route to network A repeatedly becomes unavailable, then available, many withdrawal and advertisement messages are sent. Route flapping is a problem in an internetwork connected to the Internet, because a route flap in the Internet backbone usually involves many routes.

Minimizing Flapping

The route dampening feature minimizes the flapping problem as follows. Suppose again that the route to network A flaps. The router in autonomous system 2 (in which route dampening is enabled) assigns network A a penalty of 1000 and moves it to history state. The router in autonomous system 2 continues to advertise the status of the route to neighbors. The penalties are cumulative. When the route flaps so often that the penalty exceeds a configurable suppression limit, the router stops advertising the route to network A, regardless of how many times it flaps. Thus, the route is dampened.

The penalty placed on network A is decayed until the reuse limit is reached, upon which the route is once again advertised. At half of the reuse limit, the dampening information for the route to network A is removed.


Note


No penalty is applied to a BGP peer reset when route dampening is enabled, even though the reset withdraws the route.


BGP Routing Domain Confederation

One way to reduce the iBGP mesh is to divide an autonomous system into multiple subautonomous systems and group them into a single confederation. To the outside world, the confederation looks like a single autonomous system. Each autonomous system is fully meshed within itself and has a few connections to other autonomous systems in the same confederation. Although the peers in different autonomous systems have eBGP sessions, they exchange routing information as if they were iBGP peers. Specifically, the next hop, MED, and local preference information is preserved. This feature allows you to retain a single IGP for all of the autonomous systems.

BGP Route Reflectors

BGP requires that all iBGP speakers be fully meshed. However, this requirement does not scale well when there are many iBGP speakers. Instead of configuring a confederation, you can reduce the iBGP mesh by using a route reflector configuration.

Three Fully Meshed iBGP Speakers illustrates a simple iBGP configuration with three iBGP speakers (routers A, B, and C). Without route reflectors, when Router A receives a route from an external neighbor, it must advertise it to both routers B and C. Routers B and C do not readvertise the iBGP learned route to other iBGP speakers because the routers do not pass on routes learned from internal neighbors to other internal neighbors, thus preventing a routing information loop.

Figure 6. Three Fully Meshed iBGP Speakers

With route reflectors, all iBGP speakers need not be fully meshed because there is a method to pass learned routes to neighbors. In this model, an iBGP peer is configured to be a route reflector responsible for passing iBGP learned routes to a set of iBGP neighbors. In Simple BGP Model with a Route Reflector , Router B is configured as a route reflector. When the route reflector receives routes advertised from Router A, it advertises them to Router C, and vice versa. This scheme eliminates the need for the iBGP session between routers A and C.

Figure 7. Simple BGP Model with a Route Reflector

The internal peers of the route reflector are divided into two groups: client peers and all other routers in the autonomous system (nonclient peers). A route reflector reflects routes between these two groups. The route reflector and its client peers form a cluster. The nonclient peers must be fully meshed with each other, but the client peers need not be fully meshed. The clients in the cluster do not communicate with iBGP speakers outside their cluster.

Figure 8. More Complex BGP Route Reflector Model

More Complex BGP Route Reflector Model illustrates a more complex route reflector scheme. Router A is the route reflector in a cluster with routers B, C, and D. Routers E, F, and G are fully meshed, nonclient routers.

When the route reflector receives an advertised route, depending on the neighbor, it takes the following actions:

  • A route from an external BGP speaker is advertised to all clients and nonclient peers.

  • A route from a nonclient peer is advertised to all clients.

  • A route from a client is advertised to all clients and nonclient peers. Hence, the clients need not be fully meshed.

Along with route reflector-aware BGP speakers, it is possible to have BGP speakers that do not understand the concept of route reflectors. They can be members of either client or nonclient groups, allowing an easy and gradual migration from the old BGP model to the route reflector model. Initially, you could create a single cluster with a route reflector and a few clients. All other iBGP speakers could be nonclient peers to the route reflector and then more clusters could be created gradually.

An autonomous system can have multiple route reflectors. A route reflector treats other route reflectors just like other iBGP speakers. A route reflector can be configured to have other route reflectors in a client group or nonclient group. In a simple configuration, the backbone could be divided into many clusters. Each route reflector would be configured with other route reflectors as nonclient peers (thus, all route reflectors are fully meshed). The clients are configured to maintain iBGP sessions with only the route reflector in their cluster.

Usually, a cluster of clients has a single route reflector. In that case, the cluster is identified by the router ID of the route reflector. To increase redundancy and avoid a single point of failure, a cluster might have more than one route reflector. In this case, all route reflectors in the cluster must be configured with the cluster ID so that a route reflector can recognize updates from route reflectors in the same cluster. All route reflectors serving a cluster should be fully meshed and all of them should have identical sets of client and nonclient peers.

By default, the clients of a route reflector are not required to be fully meshed and the routes from a client are reflected to other clients. However, if the clients are fully meshed, the route reflector need not reflect routes to clients.

As the iBGP learned routes are reflected, routing information may loop. The route reflector model has the following mechanisms to avoid routing loops:

  • Originator ID is an optional, nontransitive BGP attribute. It is a 4-byte attributed created by a route reflector. The attribute carries the router ID of the originator of the route in the local autonomous system. Therefore, if a misconfiguration causes routing information to come back to the originator, the information is ignored.

  • Cluster-list is an optional, nontransitive BGP attribute. It is a sequence of cluster IDs that the route has passed. When a route reflector reflects a route from its clients to nonclient peers, and vice versa, it appends the local cluster ID to the cluster-list. If the cluster-list is empty, a new cluster-list is created. Using this attribute, a route reflector can identify if routing information is looped back to the same cluster due to misconfiguration. If the local cluster ID is found in the cluster-list, the advertisement is ignored.

BGP Optimal Route Reflector

BGP-ORR (optimal route reflector) enables virtual route reflector (vRR) to calculate the best path from a route reflector (RR) client's point of view.

BGP ORR calculates the best path by:

  1. Running SPF multiple times in the context of its RR clients or RR clusters (set of RR clients)

  2. Saving the result of different SPF runs in separate databases

  3. Using these databases to manipulate BGP best path decision and thereby allowing BGP to use and announce best path that is optimal from the client’s point of view


Note


Enabling the ORR feature increases the memory footprint of BGP and RIB. With increased number of vRR configured in the network, ORR adversely impacts convergence for BGP.


In an autonomous system, a BGP route reflector acts as a focal point and advertises routes to its peers (RR clients) along with the RR's computed best path. Since the best path advertised by the RR is computed from the RR's point of view, the RR's placement becomes an important deployment consideration.

With network function virtualization (NFV) becoming a dominant technology, service providers (SPs) are hosting virtual RR functionality in a cloud using servers. A vRR can run on a control plane device and can be placed anywhere in the topology or in a SP data center. Cisco IOS XRv 9000 Router can be implemented as vRR over a NFV platform in a SP data center. vRR allows SPs to scale memory and CPU usage of RR deployments significantly. Moving a RR out of its optimal placement requires vRRs to implement ORR functionality that calculates the best path from a RR client's point of view.

BGP ORR offers these benefits:

  • calculates the bestpath from the point of view of a RR client.

  • enables vRR to be placed anywhere in the topology or in a SP data center.

  • allows SPs to scale memory and CPU usage of RR deployments.

Use Case

Consider a BGP Route Reflector topology where:

  • Router R1, R2, R3, R4, R5 and R6 are route reflector clients

  • Router R1 and R4 advertise 6/8 prefix to vRR

Figure 9. BGP-ORR Topology


vRR receives prefix 6/8 from R1 and R4. Without BGP ORR configured in the network, the vRR selects R4 as the closest exit point for RR clients R2, R3, R5, and R6, and reflects the 6/8 prefix learned from R4 to these RR clients R2, R3, R5, and R6. From the topology, it is evident that for R2 the best path is R1 and not R4. This is because the vRR calculates best path from the RR's point of view.

When the BGP ORR is configured in the network, the vRR calculates the shortest exit point in the network from R2’s point of view (ORR Root: R2) and determines that R1 is the closest exit point to R2. vRR then reflects the 6/8 prefix learned from R1 to R2.

Configuring BGP ORR includes:

  • enabling ORR on the RR for the client whose shortest exit point is to be determined

  • applying the ORR configuration to the neighbor

Enabling ORR on vRR for R2 (RR client)
For example to determine shortest exit point for R2; configure ORR on vRR with an IP address of R2 that is 192.0.2.2. Use 6500 as AS number and g1 as orr (root) policy name:

router bgp 6500
 address-family ipv4 unicast
   optimal-route-reflection g1 192.0.2.2 
commit

Applying the ORR configuration to the neighbor
Next, apply the ORR policy to BGP neighbor R2 (this enables RR to advertise best path calculated using the root IP address, 192.0.2.2, configured in orr (root) policy g1 to R2):

router bgp 6500
 neighbor 192.0.2.2
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   optimal-route-reflection g1  
commit

Verification

To verify whether R2 received the best exit, execute the show bgp <prefix> command (from R2) in EXEC mode. In the above example, R1 and R4 advertise the 6/8 prefix; run the show bgp 6.0.0.0/8 command:

R2# show bgp 6.0.0.0/8
Tue Apr  5 20:21:58.509 UTC
BGP routing table entry for 6.0.0.0/8
Versions:
  Process           bRIB/RIB  SendTblVer
  Speaker                  8           8
Last Modified: Apr  5 20:00:44.022 for 00:21:14
Paths: (1 available, best #1)
  Not advertised to any peer
  Path #1: Received by speaker 0
  Not advertised to any peer
  Local
    192.0.2.1 (metric 20) from 203.0.113.1 (192.0.2.1)
      Origin incomplete, metric 0, localpref 100, valid, internal, best, group-best
      Received Path ID 0, Local Path ID 1, version 8
      Originator: 192.0.2.1, Cluster list: 203.0.113.1

The above show output states that the best path for R2 is through R1, whose IP address is 192.0.2.1 and the metric of the path is 20.

Execute the show bgp command from the vRR to determine the best path calculated for R2 by ORR. R2 has its own update-group because it has a different best path (or different policy configured) than those of other peers:

VRR#show bgp 6.0.0.0/8
Thu Apr 28 13:36:42.744 UTC
BGP routing table entry for 6.0.0.0/8
Versions:
Process bRIB/RIB SendTblVer
Speaker 13 13
Last Modified: Apr 28 13:36:26.909 for 00:00:15
Paths: (2 available, best #2)
Advertised to update-groups (with more than one peer):
0.2
Path #1: Received by speaker 0
ORR bestpath for update-groups (with more than one peer):
0.1
Local, (Received from a RR-client)
192.0.2.1 (metric 30) from 192.0.2.1 (192.0.2.1)
Origin incomplete, metric 0, localpref 100, valid, internal, add-path
Received Path ID 0, Local Path ID 2, version 13
Path #2: Received by speaker 0
Advertised to update-groups (with more than one peer):
0.2
ORR addpath for update-groups (with more than one peer):
0.1
Local, (Received from a RR-client)
192.0.2.4 (metric 20) from 192.0.2.4 (192.0.2.4)
Origin incomplete, metric 0, localpref 100, valid, internal, best, group-best
Received Path ID 0, Local Path ID 1, version 13


Note


Path #1 is advertised to update-group 0.1. R2 is in update-group 0.1.


Execute the show bgp command for update-group 0.1 verify whether R2 is in update-group 0.1.

VRR#show bgp update-group 0.1
Thu Apr 28 13:38:18.517 UTC

Update group for IPv4 Unicast, index 0.1:
Attributes:
Neighbor sessions are IPv4
Internal
Common admin
First neighbor AS: 65000
Send communities
Send GSHUT community if originated
Send extended communities
Route Reflector Client
ORR root (configured): g1; Index: 0
4-byte AS capable
Non-labeled address-family capable
Send AIGP
Send multicast attributes
Minimum advertisement interval: 0 secs
Update group desynchronized: 0
Sub-groups merged: 0
Number of refresh subgroups: 0
Messages formatted: 5, replicated: 5
All neighbors are assigned to sub-group(s)
Neighbors in sub-group: 0.2, Filter-Groups num:1
Neighbors in filter-group: 0.2(RT num: 0)
192.0.2.2

For further verification, check the contents of the table created on vRR as a result of configuring the g1 policy. From R2’s point of view, the cost of reaching R1 is 20 and the cost of reaching R4 is 30. Therefore, the closest and best exit for R2 is through R1:

VRR#show orrspf database g1
Thu Apr 28 13:39:20.333 UTC

ORR policy: g1, IPv4, RIB tableid: 0xe0000011
Configured root: primary: 192.0.2.2, secondary: NULL, tertiary: NULL
Actual Root: 192.0.2.2, Root node: 2000.0100.1002.0000

Prefix Cost
203.0.113.1 30
192.0.2.1 20
192.0.2.2 0
192.0.2.3 30
192.0.2.4 30
192.0.2.5 10
192.0.2.6 20

Number of mapping entries: 8

RPL - if prefix is-best-path/is-best-multipath

Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) routers receive multiple paths to the same destination. As a standard, by default the BGP best path algorithm decides the best path to install in IP routing table. This is used for traffic forwarding.

BGP assigns the first valid path as the current best path. It then compares the best path with the next path in the list. This process continues, until BGP reaches the end of the list of valid paths. This contains all rules used to determine the best path. When there are multiple paths for a given address prefix, BGP:
  • Selects one of the paths as the best path as per the best-path selection rules.

  • Installs the best path in its forwarding table. Each BGP speaker advertises only the best-path to its peers.


Note


The advertisement rule of sending only the best path does not convey the full routing state of a destination, present on a BGP speaker to its peers.

After the BGP speaker receives a path from one of its peers; the path is used by the peer for forwarding packets. All other peers receive the same path from this peer. This leads to a consistent routing in a BGP network. To improve the link bandwidth utilization, most BGP implementations choose additional paths satisfy certain conditions, as multi-path, and install them in the forwarding table. Incoming packets for such are load-balanced across the best-path and the multi-path(s). You can install the paths in the forwarding table that are not advertised to the peers. The RR route reflector finds out the best-path and multi-path. This way the route reflector uses different communities for best-path and multi-path. This feature allows BGP to signal the local decision done by RR or Border Router. With this new feature, selected by RR using community-string (if is-best-path then community 100:100). The controller checks which best path is sent to all R's. Border Gateway Protocol routers receive multiple paths to the same destination. While carrying out best path computation there will be one best path, sometimes equal and few non-equal paths. Thus, the requirement for abest-path and is-equal-best-path.

The BGP best path algorithm decides the best path in the IP routing table and used for forwarding traffic. This enhancement within the RPL allows creating policy to take decisions. Adding community-string for local selection of best path. With introduction of BGP Additional Path (Add Path), BGP now signals more than the best Path. BGP can signal the best path and the entire path equivalent to the best path. This is in accordance to the BGP multi-path rules and all backup paths.

Route Reflect Add-Path Control Per Neighbor

Table 3. Feature History Table

Feature Name

Release Information

Feature Description

Route Reflect Add-Path Control Per- Neighbor

Release 7.3.1

This feature allows you to configure multipath protection. Multipath protection functionality allows you to install and advertise multipath protection along with multipath. This gives additional flexibility if the backup path selection is not preferred or chosen.

The multipath-protect-advertise keyword is added to the set path-selection command.

The multipath-protect-advertise command allows you to install and advertise the multipath protection along the multipath. You can use this option when you do not prefer the backup path selection.

Prior to this release, the device advertised only the bestpath and backup path when backup path selection is selected with the advertise option. Multipath protection was installed and was not advertised.

Remotely Triggered Null Route Filtering with RPL Next-hop Discard Configuration

Remotely triggered black hole (RTBH) filtering is a technique that provides the ability to drop undesirable traffic before it enters a protected network. RTBH filtering provides a method for quickly dropping undesirable traffic at the edge of the network, based on either source addresses or destination addresses by forwarding it to a null0 interface. RTBH filtering based on a destination address is commonly known as Destination-based RTBH filtering. Whereas, RTBH filtering based on a source address is known as Source-based RTBH filtering.

RTBH filtering is one of the many techniques in the security toolkit that can be used together to enhance network security in the following ways:

  • Effectively mitigate DDoS and worm attacks

  • Quarantine all traffic destined for the target under attack

  • Enforce blocklist filtering


Note


RTBH is not supported in cases such as L3VPN iBGP route over NULL0.


Configuring Destination-based RTBH Filtering

RTBH is implemented by defining a route policy (RPL) to discard undesirable traffic at next-hop using set next-hop discard command.

RTBH filtering sets the next-hop of the victim's prefix to the null interface. The traffic destined to the victim is dropped at the ingress.

The set next-hop discard configuration is used in the neighbor inbound policy. When this config is applied to a path, though the primary next-hop is associated with the actual path but the RIB is updated with next-hop set to Null0. Even if the primary received next-hop is unreachable, the RTBH path is considered reachable and will be a candidate in the bestpath selection process. The RTBH path is readvertised to other peers with either the received next-hop or nexthop-self based on normal BGP advertisement rules.

A typical deployment scenario for RTBH filtering would require running internal Border Gateway Protocol (iBGP) at the access and aggregation points and configuring a separate device in the network operations center (NOC) to act as a trigger. The triggering device sends iBGP updates to the edge, that cause undesirable traffic to be forwarded to a null0 interface and dropped.

Consider below topology, where a rogue router is sending traffic to a border router.

Figure 10. Topology to Implement RTBH Filtering

Configurations applied on the Trigger Router

Configure a static route redistribution policy that sets a community on static routes marked with a special tag, and apply it in BGP:

route-policy RTBH-trigger
  if tag is 777 then
    set community (1234:4321, no-export) additive
    pass
  else
    pass
  endif
  end-policy

router bgp 65001
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  redistribute static route-policy RTBH-trigger
 !
 neighbor 192.168.102.1 
  remote-as 65001
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy bgp_all in
   route-policy bgp_all out

Configure a static route with the special tag for the source prefix that has to be block-holed:

router static
 address-family ipv4 unicast
 10.7.7.7/32 Null0 tag 777

Configurations applied on the Border Router

Configure a route policy that matches the community set on the trigger router and configure set next-hop discard:

route-policy RTBH
  if community matches-any (1234:4321) then
    set next-hop discard
  else
    pass
  endif
end-policy

Apply the route policy on the iBGP peers:

router bgp 65001
 address-family ipv4 unicast
 !
 neighbor 192.168.102.2 
  remote-as 65001
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy RTBH in
   route-policy bgp_all out

Verification

On the border router, the prefix 10.7.7.7/32 is flagged as Nexthop-discard:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show bgp
BGP router identifier 10.210.0.5, local AS number 65001
BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
BGP table state: Active
Table ID: 0xe0000000   RD version: 12
BGP main routing table version 12
BGP scan interval 60 secs

Status codes: s suppressed, d damped, h history, * valid, > best
              i - internal, r RIB-failure, S stale, N Nexthop-discard
Origin codes: i - IGP, e - EGP, ? - incomplete
   Network            Next Hop            Metric LocPrf Weight Path
N>i10.7.7.7/32        192.168.102.2            0    100      0 ?
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show bgp 10.7.7.7/32
BGP routing table entry for 10.7.7.7/32
Versions:
  Process           bRIB/RIB  SendTblVer
  Speaker                 12          12
Last Modified: Jul  4 14:37:29.048 for 00:20:52
Paths: (1 available, best #1, not advertised to EBGP peer)
  Not advertised to any peer
  Path #1: Received by speaker 0
  Not advertised to any peer
  Local
    192.168.102.2 (discarded) from 192.168.102.2 (10.210.0.2)
      Origin incomplete, metric 0, localpref 100, valid, internal best, group-best
      Received Path ID 0, Local Path ID 1, version 12
      Community: 1234:4321 no-export
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show route 10.7.7.7/32

Routing entry for 10.7.7.7/32
  Known via "bgp 65001", distance 200, metric 0, type internal
  Installed Jul 4 14:37:29.394 for 01:47:02
  Routing Descriptor Blocks
    directly connected, via Null0
      Route metric is 0
  No advertising protos.

Default Address Family for show Commands

Most of the show commands provide address family (AFI) and subaddress family (SAFI) arguments (see RFC 1700 and RFC 2858 for information on AFI and SAFI). The Cisco IOS XR software parser provides the ability to set the afi and safi so that it is not necessary to specify them while running a show command. The parser commands are:

  • set default-afi { ipv4 | ipv6 | all }

  • set default-safi { unicast | multicast | all }

The parser automatically sets the default afi value to ipv4 and default safi value to unicast . It is necessary to use only the parser commands to change the default afi value from ipv4 or default safi value from unicast . Any afi or safi keyword specified in a show command overrides the values set using the parser commands. Use the following show default-afi-safi-vrf command to check the currently set value of the afi and safi.

TCP Maximum Segment Size

Maximum Segment Size (MSS) is the largest amount of data that a computer or a communication device can receive in a single, unfragmented TCP segment. All TCP sessions are bounded by a limit on the number of bytes that can be transported in a single packet; this limit is MSS. TCP breaks up packets into chunks in a transmit queue before passing packets down to the IP layer.

The TCP MSS value is dependent on the maximum transmission unit (MTU) of an interface, which is the maximum length of data that can be transmitted by a protocol at one instance. The maximum TCP packet length is determined by both the MTU of the outbound interface on the source device and the MSS announced by the destination device during the TCP setup process. The closer the MSS is to the MTU, the more efficient is the transfer of BGP messages. Each direction of data flow can use a different MSS value.

Per Neighbor TCP MSS

The per neighbor TCP MSS feature allows you to create unique TCP MSS profiles for each neighbor. Per neighbor TCP MSS is supported in two modes: neighbor group and session group. Before, TCP MSS configuration was available only at the global level in the BGP configuration.

The per neighbor TCP MSS feature allows you to:

  • Enable per neighbor TCP MSS configuration.

  • Disable TCP MSS for a particular neighbor in the neighbor group or session group using the inheritance-disable command.

  • Unconfigure TCP MSS value. On unconfiguration, TCP MSS value in the protocol control block (PCB) is set to the default value.


    Note


    The default TCP MSS value is 536 (in octets) or 1460 (in bytes). The MSS default of 1460 means that TCP segments the data in the transmit queue into 1460-byte chunks before passing the packets to the IP layer.


To configure per neighbor TCP MSS, use the tcp mss command under per neighbor, neighbor group or session group configuration.

For detailed configuration steps, see Configuring Per Neighbor TCP MSS.

For detailed steps to disable per neighbor TCP MSS, see Disabling Per Neighbor TCP MSS.

MPLS VPN Carrier Supporting Carrier

Carrier supporting carrier (CSC) is a term used to describe a situation in which one service provider allows another service provider to use a segment of its backbone network. The service provider that provides the segment of the backbone network to the other provider is called the backbone carrier. The service provider that uses the segment of the backbone network is called the customer carrier.

A backbone carrier offers Border Gateway Protocol and Multiprotocol Label Switching (BGP/MPLS) VPN services. The customer carrier can be either:

  • An Internet service provider (ISP) (By definition, an ISP does not provide VPN service.)

  • A BGP/MPLS VPN service provider

You can configure a CSC network to enable BGP to transport routes and MPLS labels between the backbone carrier provider edge (PE) routers and the customer carrier customer edge (CE) routers using multiple paths. The benefits of using BGP to distribute IPv4 routes and MPLS label routes are:

  • BGP takes the place of an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) and Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) in a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) table. You can use BGP to distribute routes and MPLS labels. Using a single protocol instead of two simplifies the configuration and troubleshooting.

  • BGP is the preferred routing protocol for connecting two ISPs, mainly because of its routing policies and ability to scale. ISPs commonly use BGP between two providers. This feature enables those ISPs to use BGP.

For detailed information on configuring MPLS VPN CSC with BGP, see the Implementing MPLS Layer 3 VPNs on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of the MPLS Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers.

BGP Keychains

BGP keychains enable keychain authentication between two BGP peers. The BGP endpoints must both comply with draft-bonica-tcp-auth-05.txt and a keychain on one endpoint and a password on the other endpoint does not work.

See the System Security Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers for information on keychain management.

BGP is able to use the keychain to implement hitless key rollover for authentication. Key rollover specification is time based, and in the event of clock skew between the peers, the rollover process is impacted. The configurable tolerance specification allows for the accept window to be extended (before and after) by that margin. This accept window facilitates a hitless key rollover for applications (for example, routing and management protocols).

The key rollover does not impact the BGP session, unless there is a keychain configuration mismatch at the endpoints resulting in no common keys for the session traffic (send or accept).

BGP Session Authentication and Integrity using TCP Authentication Option Overview

BGP Session Authentication and Integrity using TCP Authentication Option feature enables you to use stronger Message Authentication Codes that protect against replays, even for long-lived TCP connections. This feature also provides more details on the association of security with TCP connections than TCP MD5 Signature option (TCP MD5).

This feature supports the following functionalities of TCP MD5:

  • Protection of long-lived connections such as BGP and LDP.

  • Support for larger set of MACs with minimal changes to the system and operations

BGP Session Authentication and Integrity using TCP Authentication Option feature supports IPv6. It supports these two cryptographic algorithms: HMAC-SHA-1-96 and AES-128-CMAC-96.

You can use two sets of keys, namely Master Key Tuples and traffic keys to authenticate incoming and outgoing segments.

This feature applies different option identifier than TCP MD5. This feature cannot be used simultaneously with TCP MD5.

Master Key Tuples

Traffic keys are the keying material used to compute the message authentication codes of individual TCP segments.

The BGP Session Authentication and Integrity using TCP Authentication Option (AO) feature uses the existing keychain fucntionality to define the key string, message authentication codes algorithm, and key lifetimes.

Master Key Tuples (MKTs) enable you to derive unique traffic keys, and to include the keying material required to generate those traffic keys. MKTs indicate the parameters under which the traffic keys are configured. The parameters include whether TCP options are authenticated, and indicators of the algorithms used for traffic key derivation and MAC calculation.

Each MKT has two identifiers, namely SendID and a RecvID . The SendID identifier is inserted as the KeyID identifier of the TCP AO option of the outgoing segments.The RecvID is matched against the TCP AO KeyID of the incoming segments.

Configure BGP Session Authentication and Integrity using TCP Authentication Option

This section describes how you can configure BGP Session Authentication and Integrity using TCP Authentication Option (TCP AO) feature :

  • Configure Keychain


    Note


    Configure send-life and accept-lifetime keywords with identical values in the keychain configuration, otherwise the values become invalid.


  • Configure TCP


    Note


    The Send ID and Receive ID you configured on the device must match the Receive ID and Send ID configured on the peer respectively.


  • Configure BGP

Configuration Example

Configure a keychain.


Router# configure
Router#(config)# key chain tcpao1
Router#(config-tcpao1)# key 1
Router#(config-tcpao1-1)# cryptographic-algorithm HMAC-SHA-1-96 
Router#(config-tcpao1-1)# key-string keys1
Router#(config-tcpao1-1)# send-lifetime 16:00:00 march 3 2018 infinite 
Router#(config-tcpao1-1)# accept-lifetime 16:00:00 march 3 2018 infinite 

Configure TCP

 
Router# tcp ao 	
Router(config-tcp-ao)# keychain tcpao1
Router(config-tcp-ao-tpcao1)# key 1 sendID 5 receiveID 5

Configure BGP


Router#(config-bgp)# router bgp 1
Router(config-bgp)# bgp router-id 10.101.101.1
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-af)# exit
Router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.51.51.1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# ao tcpao1 include-tcp-options disable accept-ao-mismatch-connection

Verification

Verify the keychain information configured for BGP Session Authentication and Integrity using TCP Authentication Option feature.

show key chain tcpao1
Mon Sep  2 08:32:14.383 UTC

Key-chain: tcpao1 -

  timezone -- local
  Key 1 -- text "025756085F535976141759485744465E5A"
    Cryptographic-Algorithm -- AES_128_CMAC_96
    Send lifetime --  16:00:00, 03 Mar 2018 - Always valid  [Valid now]
    Accept lifetime -- 16:00:00, 03 Mar 2018 - Always valid [Valid now]

The following output displays the state of the BGP neighbors.


Router# show bgp ipv4 unicast summary
Mon Sep  2 08:33:27.759 UTC
BGP router identifier 10.101.101.1, local AS number 1
BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
Non-stop routing is enabled
BGP table state: Active
Table ID: 0xe0000000   RD version: 4
BGP table nexthop route policy:
BGP main routing table version 4
BGP NSR Initial initsync version 3 (Reached)
BGP NSR/ISSU Sync-Group versions 0/0
BGP scan interval 60 secs

BGP is operating in STANDALONE mode.


Process       RcvTblVer   bRIB/RIB   LabelVer  ImportVer  SendTblVer  StandbyVer
Speaker               4          4          4          4           4           0

Neighbor        Spk    AS MsgRcvd MsgSent   TblVer  InQ OutQ  Up/Down  St/PfxRcd
10.51.51.1           0     1      13      13        4    0    0 00:09:11          1
Wed Mar 21 12:55:57.812 UTC
10.51.51.1  default  1     1     0     0    Established  None

The following output displays the state of a particular BGP neighbor.


Router# show bgp neighbor 10.51.51.1 detail
BGP neighbor is 10.51.51.1
 Remote AS 1, local AS 1, internal link
 Remote router ID 10.51.51.1
  BGP state = Established, up for 00:11:19
  Previous State: Active
  Last Received Message: KeepAlive
  NSR State: None
  Last read 00:00:14, Last read before reset 00:00:00
  Hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
  Configured hold time: 180, keepalive: 60, min acceptable hold time: 3
  Last write 00:00:14, attempted 19, written 19
  Second last write 00:01:14, attempted 19, written 19
  Last write before reset 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
  Second last write before reset 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
  Last write pulse rcvd  Sep  2 08:35:21.713 last full not set pulse count 28
  Last write pulse rcvd before reset 00:00:00
  Socket not armed for io, armed for read, armed for write
  Last write thread event before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
  Last KA expiry before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
  Last KA error before reset 00:00:00, KA not sent 00:00:00
  Last KA start before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
  Precedence: internet
  Non-stop routing is enabled
  Multi-protocol capability received
  Neighbor capabilities:
    Route refresh: advertised (old + new) and received (old + new)
    4-byte AS: advertised and received
    Address family IPv4 Unicast: advertised and received
  Received 15 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
  Sent 15 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
  Minimum time between advertisement runs is 0 secs
  Inbound message logging enabled, 3 messages buffered
  Outbound message logging enabled, 3 messages buffered

The following output displays brief information of the protocol control block (PCB) of the neighbor.

 
Router# show tcp brief | i 10.51.51.1
Mon Sep  2 08:29:19.442 UTC
0x00007f9dc0009bb0 0x60000000      0      0  10.101.101.1:179     10.51.51.1:42377    ESTAB

The following output displays authentication details of the PCB:


Router# show tcp detail pcb 0x143df858 location 0/rsp0/CPU0 | begin Authen
Wed Mar 21 12:56:46.129 UTC
Authentication peer details:
    Peer: 10.51.51.1/32, OBJ_ID: 0x40002fd8
    Port: BGP, vrf_id: 0x60000000, type: AO, debug_on:0
    Keychain_name: tcpao1, options: 0x00000000, linked peer: 0x143e00  Keychain name
    Send_SNE: 0, Receive_SNE: 0, Send_SNE_flag: 0
    Recv_SNE_flag: 0, Prev_send_seq: 4120835405, Prev_receive_seq: 2461932863
    ISS: 4120797604, IRS: 2461857361
    Current key: 2
    Traffic keys: send_non_SYN: 006a2975, recv_non_SYN: 00000000
    RNext key: 2 
    Traffic keys: send_non_SYN: 00000000, recv_non_SYN: 00000000
    Last 1 keys used: 
        key: 2, time: Mar 20 03:52:35.969.151, reason: No current key set

BGP Nonstop Routing

The Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) Nonstop Routing (NSR) with Stateful Switchover (SSO) feature enables all bgp peerings to maintain the BGP state and ensure continuous packet forwarding during events that could interrupt service. Under NSR, events that might potentially interrupt service are not visible to peer routers. Protocol sessions are not interrupted and routing states are maintained across process restarts and switchovers.

BGP NSR provides nonstop routing during the following events:

  • Route processor switchover

  • Process crash or process failure of BGP or TCP

    Note


    BGP NSR is enabled by default. Use the nsr disable command to turn off BGP NSR. The no nsr disable command can also be used to turn BGP NSR back on if it has been disabled.

    In case of process crash or process failure, NSR will be maintained only if nsr process-failures switchover command is configured. In the event of process failures of active instances, the nsr process-failures switchover configures failover as a recovery action and switches over to a standby route processor (RP) or a standby distributed route processor (DRP) thereby maintaining NSR. An example of the configuration command is RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config) # nsr process-failures switchover

    The nsr process-failures switchover command maintains both the NSR and BGP sessions in the event of a BGP or TCP process crash. Without this configuration, BGP neighbor sessions flap in case of a BGP or TCP process crash. This configuration does not help if the BGP or TCP process is restarted in which case the BGP neighbors are expected to flap.

    When the l2vpn_mgr process is restarted, the NSR client (te-control) flaps between the Ready and Not Ready state. This is the expected behavior and there is no traffic loss.


During route processor switchover and In-Service System Upgrade (ISSU), NSR is achieved by stateful switchover (SSO) of both TCP and BGP.

NSR does not force any software upgrades on other routers in the network, and peer routers are not required to support NSR.

When a route processor switchover occurs due to a fault, the TCP connections and the BGP sessions are migrated transparently to the standby route processor, and the standby route processor becomes active. The existing protocol state is maintained on the standby route processor when it becomes active, and the protocol state does not need to be refreshed by peers.

Events such as soft reconfiguration and policy modifications can trigger the BGP internal state to change. To ensure state consistency between active and standby BGP processes during such events, the concept of post-it is introduced that act as synchronization points.

BGP NSR provides the following features:

  • NSR-related alarms and notifications

  • Configured and operational NSR states are tracked separately

  • NSR statistics collection

  • NSR statistics display using show commands

  • XML schema support

  • Auditing mechanisms to verify state synchronization between active and standby instances

  • CLI commands to enable and disable NSR

  • Support for 5000 NSR sessions

BGP Local Label Retention

When a primary PE-CE link fails, BGP withdraws the route corresponding to the primary path along with its local label and programs the backup path in the Routing Information Base (RIB) and the Forwarding Information Base (FIB), by default.

However, until all the internal peers of the primary PE reconverge to use the backup path as the new bestpath, the traffic continues to be forwarded to the primary PE with the local label that was allocated for the primary path. Hence the previously allocated local label for the primary path must be retained on the primary PE for some configurable time after the reconvergence. BGP Local Label Retention feature enables the retention of the local label for a specified period. If no time is specified, the local lable is retained for a default value of five minutes.

The retain local-label command enables the retention of the local label until the network is converged.

Command Line Interface (CLI) Consistency for BGP Commands

From Cisco IOS XR Release 3.9.0 onwards, the Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) commands use disable keyword to disable a feature. The keyword inheritance-disable disables the inheritance of the feature properties from the parent level.

BGP Additional Paths

The Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) Additional Paths feature modifies the BGP protocol machinery for a BGP speaker to be able to send multiple paths for a prefix. This gives 'path diversity' in the network. The add path enables BGP prefix independent convergence (PIC) at the edge routers.

BGP add path enables add path advertisement in an iBGP network and advertises the following types of paths for a prefix:

  • Backup paths—to enable fast convergence and connectivity restoration.

  • Group-best paths—to resolve route oscillation.

  • All paths—to emulate an iBGP full-mesh.


Note


Add path is not supported with MDT, IPv4 tunnel, IPv4/IPv6 Multicast, VPLS, and RT constraint.

iBGP Multipath Load Sharing

When a Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) speaking router that has no local policy configured, receives multiple network layer reachability information (NLRI) from the internal BGP (iBGP) for the same destination, the router will choose one iBGP path as the best path. The best path is then installed in the IP routing table of the router.

The iBGP Multipath Load Sharing feature enables the BGP speaking router to select multiple iBGP paths as the best paths to a destination. The best paths or multipaths are then installed in the IP routing table of the router.

When there are multiple border BGP routers having reachability information heard over eBGP, if no local policy is applied, the border routers will choose their eBGP paths as best. They advertise that bestpath inside the ISP network. For a core router, there can be multiple paths to the same destination, but it will select only one path as best and use that path for forwarding. iBGP multipath load sharing adds the ability to enable load sharing among multiple equi-distant paths.

Configuring multiple iBGP best paths enables a router to evenly share the traffic destined for a particular site.

The iBGP Multipath Load Sharing feature functions similarly in a Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) Virtual Private Network (VPN) with a service provider backbone.

For multiple paths to the same destination to be considered as multipaths, the following criteria must be met:

  • All attributes must be the same. The attributes include weight, local preference, autonomous system path (entire attribute and not just length), origin code, Multi Exit Discriminator (MED), and Interior Gateway Protocol (iGP) distance.

  • The next hop router for each multipath must be different.

Even if the criteria are met and multiple paths are considered multipaths, the BGP speaking router will still designate one of the multipaths as the best path and advertise this best path to its neighbors.


Note


After a change in multipath, IGP metrics are not considered while evaluating eiBGP multipath candidates and a sub-optimal path can be used.


Per-vrf label mode is not supported for Carrier Supporting Carrier (CSC) network with internal and external BGP multipath setup

Per VRF label mode cannot be used for BGP PIC edge with eiBGP multipath as that might cause loops. Only per prefix label supports per VRF label mode.

Persistent Loadbalancing

Traditional ECMP or equal cost multipath loadbalances traffic over a number of available paths towards a destination. When one path fails, the traffic gets re-shuffled over the available number of paths. This flow distribution can be a problem in data center loadbalancing.

Persistent Loadbalancing or Sticky ECMP defines a prefix in such a way that it do not rehash flows on existing paths and only replace those bucket assignments of the failed server. The advantage is that the established sessions to servers will not get rehashed.

The following section describes how you can configure persistent load balancing:

/*Configure persistent load balancing. */

Router(config)# router bgp 7500 
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast 
Router(config-bgp-af)# table-policy sticky-ecmp 
Router(config-bgp-af)# bgp attribute-download 
Router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths ebgp 64
Router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths ibgp 32
Router(config-bgp-af)# exit
Router(config-bgp)# exit
Router(config)# route-policy sticky-ecmp 
Router(config-rpl)# if destination in (192.1.1.1/24) then
Router(config-rpl-if)# set load-balance ecmp-consistent
Router(config-rpl-if)# else
Router(config-rpl-else)# pass
Router(config-rpl-else)# endif
RP/0/0/CPU0:ios(config-rpl)# end-policy
RP/0/0/CPU0:ios(config)#

/* Enable autocovery and hence recover the original hashing state 
after failed paths become active. */
Router(config)# cef consistent-hashing auto-recovery

/* Recover to the original hashing state after failed paths come up 
and avoid affecting newly formed flows after path failure.  */
Router(config)# clear route 192.0.2.0/24 

Running Configuration

/* Configure persistent loadbalancing. */
router bgp 7500 
 address-family ipv4 unicast 
  table-policy sticky-ecmp 
  bgp attribute-download 
  maximum-paths ebgp 64
  maximum-paths ibgp 32


cef consistent-hashing auto-recovery

clear route 192.0.2.0/24 

Verification

Verify that the path distribution with persistent loadbalancing is configured.

The following show output displays the status of path distribution before a link fails. In this output, three paths are identified with three next hops (10.1/2/3.0.1) through three different GigabitEthernet interfaces.

 
show cef 192.0.2.0/24 
 LDI Update time Sep  5 11:22:38.201
   via 10.1.0.1/32, 3 dependencies, recursive, bgp-multipath [flags 0x6080]
    path-idx 0 NHID 0x0 [0x57ac4e74 0x0]
    next hop 10.1.0.1/32 via 10.1.0.1/32
   via 10.2.0.1/32, 3 dependencies, recursive, bgp-multipath [flags 0x6080]
    path-idx 1 NHID 0x0 [0x57ac4a74 0x0]
    next hop 10.2.0.1/32 via 10.2.0.1/32
   via 10.3.0.1/32, 3 dependencies, recursive, bgp-multipath [flags 0x6080]
    path-idx 2 NHID 0x0 [0x57ac4f74 0x0]
    next hop 10.3.0.1/32 via 10.3.0.1/32


    Load distribution (consistent): 0 1 2 (refcount 1)

    Hash  OK  Interface                 Address
    0     Y   GigabitEthernet0/0/0/0    10.1.0.1       
    1     Y   GigabitEthernet0/0/0/1    10.2.0.1       
    2     Y   GigabitEthernet0/0/0/2    10.3.0.1    

The following show output displays the status of the path distribution after a link fails. The replacement of bucket 1 with GigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 and the "*" symbol denotes that this path is a replacement for a failed path.



show cef 192.0.2.0/24 
 LDI Update time Sep  5 11:23:13.434
   via 10.1.0.1/32, 3 dependencies, recursive, bgp-multipath [flags 0x6080]
    path-idx 0 NHID 0x0 [0x57ac4e74 0x0]
    next hop 10.1.0.1/32 via 10.1.0.1/32
   via 10.3.0.1/32, 3 dependencies, recursive, bgp-multipath [flags 0x6080]
    path-idx 1 NHID 0x0 [0x57ac4f74 0x0]
    next hop 10.3.0.1/32 via 10.3.0.1/32

    Load distribution (consistent) : 0 1 2 (refcount 1)
    Hash  OK  Interface                 Address
    0     Y   GigabitEthernet0/0/0/0    10.1.0.1       
 1*    Y   GigabitEthernet0/0/0/0    10.1.0.1       
    2     Y   GigabitEthernet0/0/0/2    10.3.0.1     

BGP Selective Multipath

Traditional BGP multipath feature allows a router receiving parallel paths to the same destination to install the multiple paths in the routing table. By default, this multipath feature is applied to all configured peers. BGP selective multipath allows application of the multipath feature only to selected peers.

The BGP router receiving multiple paths is configured with the maximum-paths ... selective option. The iBGP/eBGP neighbors sharing multiple paths are configured with the multipath option, while being added as neighbors on the BGP router.


Note


Use next-hop-unchanged multipath command to avoid overwriting next-hop information before advertising multipaths.


The following behavior is to be noted while using BGP selective multipath:

  • BGP selective multipath does not impact best path calculations. A best path is always included in the set of multipaths.

  • For VPN prefixes, the PE paths are always eligible to be multipaths.

For information on the maximum-paths and multipath commands, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Command Reference.

Topology

A sample topology to illustrate the configuration used in this section is shown in the following figure.

Figure 11. BGP Selective Multipath


Router R4 receives parallel paths from Routers R1, R2 and R3 to the same destination. If Routers R1 and R2 are configured as selective multipath neighbors on Router R4, only the parallel paths from these routers are installed in the routing table of Router R4.

Configuration


Note


Configure your network topology with iBGP/eBGP running on your routers, before configuring this feature.


To configure BGP selective multipath on Router R4, use the following steps.

  1. Configure Router R4 to accept selective multiple paths in your topology.

    
    /* To configure selective multipath for iBGP/eBGP
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 1
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths ibgp 4 selective 
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths ebgp 5 selective 
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit
    
    /* To configure selective multipath for eiBGP
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 1
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths eibgp 6 selective
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# commit
    
  2. Configure neighbors for Router R4.

    Routers R1 (1.1.1.1) and R2 (2.2.2.2) are configured as neighbors with the multipath option.

    Router R3 (3.3.3.3) is configured as a neighbor without the multipath option, and hence the routes from this router are not eligible to be chosen as multipaths.

    
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 1.1.1.1
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# multipath     
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit
    
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# neighbor 2.2.2.2
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# multipath
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit
    
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# neighbor 3.3.3.3
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
    RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit
    
    

You have successfully configured the BGP selective multipath feature.

Accumulated Interior Gateway Protocol Attribute

The Accumulated Interior Gateway Protocol (AiGP)Attribute is an optional non-transitive BGP Path Attribute. The attribute type code for the AiGP Attribute is to be assigned by IANA. The value field of the AiGP Attribute is defined as a set of Type/Length/Value elements (TLVs). The AiGP TLV contains the Accumulated IGP Metric.

The AiGP feature is required in the 3107 network to simulate the current OSPF behavior of computing the distance associated with a path. OSPF/LDP carries the prefix/label information only in the local area. Then, BGP carries the prefix/lable to all the remote areas by redistributing the routes into BGP at area boundaries. The routes/labels are then advertised using LSPs. The next hop for the route is changed at each ABR to local router which removes the need to leak OSPF routes across area boundaries. The bandwidth available on each of the core links is mapped to OSPF cost, hence it is imperative that BGP carries this cost correctly between each of the PEs. This functionality is achieved by using the AiGP.

Per VRF and Per CE Label for IPv6 Provider Edge

The per VRF and per CE label for IPv6 feature makes it possible to save label space by allocating labels per default VRF or per CE nexthop.

All IPv6 Provider Edge (6PE) labels are allocated per prefix by default. Each prefix that belongs to a VRF instance is advertised with a single label, causing an additional lookup to be performed in the VRF forwarding table to determine the customer edge (CE) next hop for the packet.

However, use the label mode command with the per-ce keyword or the per-vrf keyword to avoid the additional lookup on the PE router and conserve label space.

Use per-ce keyword to specify that the same label be used for all the routes advertised from a unique customer edge (CE) peer router. Use the per-vrf keyword to specify that the same label is to be used for all the routes advertised from a unique VRF. In 6PE, the label is IPV6 explicit null label.

IPv4 BGP-Policy Accounting on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700

Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) policy accounting measures and classifies IP traffic that is sent to, or received from, different peers. Policy accounting is enabled on an individual input or output interface basis. Counters based on parameters such as community list, autonomous system number, or autonomous system path are assigned to identify the IP traffic.

Using BGP policy accounting, you can account for traffic according to the route it traverses. Service providers can identify and account for all traffic by customer and bill accordingly.

For more information on BGP policy accounting and how to configure BGP policy accounting, refer the Implementing Cisco Express Forwarding module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide.

IPv6 Unicast Routing on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700

Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700 provides complete Internet Protocol Version 6 (IPv6) unicast capability.

An IPv6 unicast address is an identifier for a single interface, on a single node. A packet that is sent to a unicast address is delivered to the interface identified by that address. Cisco IOS XR software supports the following IPv6 unicast address types:

  • Global aggregatable address

  • Site-local address

  • Link-local address

  • IPv4-compatible IPv6 address

For more information on IPv6 unicase addressing, refer the Implementing Network Stack IPv4 and IPv6 module in Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router IP Addresses and Services Configuration Guide.

IPv6 uRPF Support on Cisco ASR 9000's A9K-SIP-700

Unicast IPv6 Reverse Path Forwarding (uRPF) mitigates problems caused by the introduction of malformed or spoofed IP source addresses into a network by discarding IP packets that lack a verifiable IP source address. Unicast RPF does this by doing a reverse lookup in the Cisco Express Forwarding (CEF) table. Therefore, uRPF is possible only if CEF is enabled on the router.

Use the ipv6 verify unicast source reachable-via {any | rx} [allow-default] [allow-self-ping] command in interface configuration mode to enable IPV6 uRPF.

For more information on IPv6 uRPF, refer Implementing Cisco Express Forwarding module in IP Addresses and Services Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers

Remove and Replace Private AS Numbers from AS Path in BGP

Private autonomous system numbers (ASNs) are used by Internet Service Providers (ISPs) and customer networks to conserve globally unique AS numbers. Private AS numbers cannot be used to access the global Internet because they are not unique. AS numbers appear in eBGP AS paths in routing updates. Removing private ASNs from the AS path is necessary if you have been using private ASNs and you want to access the global Internet.

Public AS numbers are assigned by InterNIC and are globally unique. They range from 1 to 64511. Private AS numbers are used to conserve globally unique AS numbers, and they range from 64512 to 65535. Private AS numbers cannot be leaked to a global BGP routing table because they are not unique, and BGP best path calculations require unique AS numbers. Therefore, it might be necessary to remove private AS numbers from an AS path before the routes are propagated to a BGP peer.

External BGP (eBGP) requires that globally unique AS numbers be used when routing to the global Internet. Using private AS numbers (which are not unique) would prevent access to the global Internet. The remove and replace private AS Numbers from AS Path in BGP feature allows routers that belong to a private AS to access the global Internet. A network administrator configures the routers to remove private AS numbers from the AS path contained in outgoing update messages and optionally, to replace those numbers with the ASN of the local router, so that the AS Path length remains unchanged.

The ability to remove and replace private AS numbers from the AS Path is implemented in the following ways:

  • The remove-private-as command:

    • Removes private AS numbers from the AS path even if the path contains both public and private ASNs.

    • Removes private AS numbers even if the AS path contains only private AS numbers. There is no likelihood of a 0-length AS path because this command can be applied to eBGP peers only, in which case the AS number of the local router is appended to the AS path.

    • Removes private AS numbers even if the private ASNs appear before the confederation segments in the AS path.

  • The replace-as command replaces the private AS numbers being removed from the path with the local AS number, thereby retaining the same AS path length.

The feature can be applied to a neighbor in the address family configuration mode. Therefore, if you apply the feature for a neighbor in an address family, only the outbound update messages are impacted.

Use show bgp neighbors and show bgp update-group commands to verify that the that private AS numbers were removed or replaced.

Replace BGP AS Path with Custom Values

Table 4. Feature History Table

Feature Name

Release Information

Feature Description

Replace BGP AS Path with Custom Values

Release 7.5.2

You can now configure route policies to replace the Autonomous System (AS) Path in BGP with custom values to control the best path selection process.

This feature introduces the replace as-path all command.

BGP routers typically receive multiple paths to the same destination. The BGP best-path algorithm determines the best path to install in the IP routing table and to use for forwarding traffic. The overall best path is selected based on various attributes. .

AS path is one of the attributes used for best path selection. By default, BGP always prefers the route with shortest AS path as the best path. The best path selected by BGP might have traffic engineering issues, like heavy traffic that leads to congestion. In such cases, you can alter the best path by replacing the AS path with custom values.

The following are the custom values you can use to replace the AS path:

  • None: Use this option to modify an AS path as the shortest path in the network. When you choose this option, the AS path is replaced with a null or empty value. Use the replace as-path all none command to replace with none.

  • Auto: Use this option to advertise the local AS number or the neigbor's AS number as the AS path. When you choose this option, AS path is replaced based on the route policy:

    • For inbound route policy, AS path is replaced with AS path of BGP neighbor from where the prefix is received.

    • For outbound route policy, AS path is replaced with the local AS number.

    Use the replace as-path all auto command to replace with auto.

  • 'x': Use this option to replace AS path with any specified value. Use the replace as-path all 'x' command to replace with this option, where 'x' can be a single AS number or a sequence of AS numbers separated by space.

  • Optionally, you can repeat replacing the AS path for a specified number of times. This option is supported only for the auto and 'x' parameters. Use the replace as-path all {auto | 'x'} [n] command to enable the repeat option.

  • Optionally, you can use a parameter name along with the repeat option. The parameter name must be preceded with a “$.” You can attach the route policy with the parameter to a neighbor and specify the number of times the AS path replacement should be repeated. This opton allows you to apply the same route policy to different neighbors with different AS path values.

    Use the replace as-path all {auto | 'x'} [n] [parameter] command to enable the parameter along with repeat option.

You can replace the AS path for inbound eBGP, outbound eBGP, and outbound iBGP paths.


Note


For outbound eBGP paths, the AS number of the local router is always prepended to the replaced AS path.


Interoperability with BGP Confederation

BGP confederation is a group of multiple autonomous systems that looks like a single autonomous system to the outside world. When confederation is configured on BGP peers, the AS path is replaced as follows:

  • When you replace the AS path in an outbound BGP router, which receives prefix from a BGP neighbor configured with confederation, the specified AS path value is appended to the confederation sequence.

  • When you replace the AS path in an inbound BGP router configured with confederation, the confederation sequence is replaced with the specified AS path value.

Deployment Scenario

Consider a BGP network configured with AS paths. By default, BGP selects the route with shortest AS path to reach the destination. You can alter the default route by using the replace BGP AS path feature.

In the following figure, the network consists of BGP routers configured with AS Path values. To reach Server B, Server A typically selects Path B (via S1_1, S0), as the AS path value of S0 is shorter.

You may want to use Path A to reach the destination (via S1_1, S2_1, S1_2, S0), for traffic engineering purpose. For example, Path A may be less congested and is better than Path B. To use Path A, you can replace the AS path values with one of the following options:

  • Replace AS path of Router S2_1 with a shorter value.

  • Replace AS path of Router S0 with a longer value.

Restrictions

  • The replace as-path all command isn't supported on inbound iBGP paths.

  • The replace as-path all command isn't supported on a route policy that is already configured with remove-private-as or replace as commands.

  • You can apply the route policy configured with replace as-path all only on neighbor-in or neighbor-out attach points.

Configuration Example

To replace BGP AS path with custom values, perform the following tasks on a BGP router:

This example shows how to replace AS path with null value.

/*Configure route policy to replace AS path with none*/
Router(config)#hw-module profile stats ?
Router(config)# route-policy aspath-none
Router(config-rpl)# replace as-path all none
Router(config-rpl)# end-policy

/* Apply route policy to BGP neighbor */
Router(config)# router bgp 65530
Router(config-bgp)# neighbor 111.0.0.1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy aspath-none in

This example shows how to replace AS path with auto option.


/*Configure route policy to replace AS path with auto*/
Router(config)#route-policy aspath-auto
Router(config-rpl)# replace as-path all auto
Router(config-rpl)# end-policy


/* Apply route policy to BGP neighbor */
Router(config)# router bgp 65530
Router(config-bgp)# neighbor 111.0.0.1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy aspath-auto out

This example shows how to replace AS path with a specified sequence of AS numbers. In this example, sequence '10 100 200 300' is used.


/*Configure route policy to replace AS path with 'x'*/
Router(config)# route-policy aspath-str
Router(config-rpl)# replace as-path all '10 100 200 300'
Router(config-rpl)# end-policy


/* Apply route policy to BGP neighbor */
Router(config)# router bgp 1
Router(config-bgp)# neighbor 111.0.0.1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy aspath-str in

This example shows how to use replace as-path all command along with parameter to replace the AS path with specified sequence of values, repeated for specified number of times. In this example, AS path is replaced with sequence '45 55', repeated for 6 times.



/*Configure route policy to replace AS path with parameter ($n)*/
Router(config)# route-policy aspath-par($n)
Router(config-rpl)# replace as-path all '45 55' $n
Router(config-rpl)# end-policy


/* Apply route policy to BGP neighbor */
Router(config)# router bgp 1
Router(config-bgp)# neighbor 111.0.0.1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy aspath-par(6) in

Verification

In the following output, AS path is replaced with null value.


Router# show bgp
Network               Next Hop            Metric LocPrf Weight Path
*> 192.168.3.0/24     192.168.3.1                     0      0    i

In the following output, AS path is replaced with auto for an outbound path, where the AS path of local router is [40].


Router# show bgp
Network            Next Hop            Metric LocPrf Weight Path
*> 111.0.0.2/32    200.0.0.5                       0         40 i    

In the following output, AS path is replaced with the sequence '10 100 200 300'.


Router# show bgp
Network            Next Hop            Metric LocPrf Weight Path
*>111.0.0.2/32      200.0.0.5                      0 10 100 200 300 i

In the following output, AS path is replaced with the sequence '45 55', repeated for 6 times.


Router# show bgp
Network            Next Hop            Metric LocPrf Weight Path
*>111.0.0.8/32      200.0.0.5                      0        45 55 45 55 45 55 45 55 45 55 45 55 i

Configure Replace BGP AS Path with Custom Values

Perform the following steps to replace BGP AS path with custom values.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. route-policy route-policy-name
  3. replace as-path all { none | auto | x } [n ] [parameter ]
  4. Use the show bgp command to verify the replaced AS path.

DETAILED STEPS


Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

route-policy route-policy-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy test-match-all

Defines the route policy and enters route-policy configuration mode.

Step 3

replace as-path all { none | auto | x } [n ] [parameter ]

Replaces the entire AS path with specified values.

  • none – Replaces AS path with null or empty value.

  • auto – For Inbound route policy, replaces AS path with AS path of neighbor from where the prefix is received. For Outbound route policy, replaces AS path with the configured local AS path.

  • x – Replaces AS path with specified value, where x can be a single AS number or a sequence of AS numbers separated by space.

  • [n ] – (Optional) Repeats the AS path replacement for specified number of times. Range is from 2 to 64. This option is supported only for the parameters auto and x .

  • [parameter ] – (Optional) Parameter name used along with repeat option. The parameter name must be preceded with a “$.” You can attach the route policy with the parameter to a neighbor and specify the number of times the AS path replacement should be repeated.

Note

 
You can apply the route policy configured with replace as-path all only to neighbor-in or neighbor-out attach points.
Example:
In this example, AS path is replaced with null value.

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# replace as-path all none
In this example, AS path is replaced with auto , repeated for 2 times.

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# replace as-path all auto 2
In this example, AS path is replaced with '77' for 3 times.

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# replace as-path all '77' 3
The following example uses parameter $n to replace the AS path with auto , repeated for 2 times.

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy replace-auto($n)
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# replace as-path all auto $n
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 65530
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.101.1
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy replace-auto(2) in

Step 4

Use the show bgp command to verify the replaced AS path.

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp
Network               Next Hop            Metric LocPrf Weight Path
*>i1.1.1.0/24         192.168.1.1              0    100      0 i
*> 2.2.2.0/24         0.0.0.0                  0         32768 i
*>i3.3.3.0/24         192.168.2.2              0    100      0 i
*> 4.4.4.0/24         192.168.3.1              0             0 35 35 1000 2000 i
*>i5.5.5.0/24         192.168.2.2              0    100      0 300 i
*> 192.168.3.0/24     192.168.3.1              0             0 35 35 1000 2000 i
*>i192.168.4.0/24     192.168.2.2              0    100      0 300 i

Selective VRF Download

Selective VRF Download (SVD) feature enables the downloading of only those prefixes and labels to a line card that are actively required to forward traffic through the line card.

To meet the demand for a consolidated edge MSE platform, the number of VRFs, VRF interfaces, and the prefix capacity increase. Convergence timings differ in different line card engines. One of the major factors that determine convergence timing is the time taken to process and program a prefix and its associated data structures. A lesser number of prefixes and labels ensure better convergence timing. By enabling selective download of VRF routes, SVD increases scalability and reduces convergence problems in Layer 3 VPNs (L3VPNs).

Line Card Roles and Filters in Selective VRF Download

In a selective VRF download (SVD) context, line cards have these roles:

  • Core LC: a line card that has only core facing interfaces (interfaces that connect to other P/PEs)

  • Customer LC: a line card that has one or more customer facing interfaces (interfaces that connect to CEs in different VRFs)

The line cards handle these prefixes:

  • Local Prefix: a prefix that is received from a CE connected to the router in a configured VRF context

  • Remote Prefix: a prefix received from another PE and is imported to a configured VRF

These filters are applicable to each line card type:

  • A core LC needs all te local prefixes and VRF labels so that the label or IP forwarding, or both is set up correctly.

  • A customer LC needs both local and remote prefixes for all the VRFs to which it is connected, and for other VRFs which some connected VRFs have dependency. This is based on the import/export RT configuration; VRF ‘A’ may have imported routes from VRF ‘B’, so the imported route in VRF ‘A’ points to a next-hop that is in VRF ‘B’. For route resolution, VRF ‘B’ routes need to be downloaded to each line card that has a VRF ‘A’ interface.

  • If a line card is hosts both core facing and customer facing interfaces, then it does not need to do any filtering. All tables and all routes are present on such line cards. These line cards have a role called “standard”. All RPs and DRPs have the standard role.

  • To correctly resolve L3VPN routes, the IPv4 default table needs to be present an all nodes. However, if the line card does not have any IPv6 interface, it can filter out all IPv6 tables and routes. In such a case, the line card can be deemed “not interested” in the IPv6 AFI. Then it behaves as if IPv6 is not supported by it.

Selective VRF Download Disable

Selective VRF Download (SVD) functionality is disabled, by default. To enable SVD, configure the svd platform enable command in administrative configuration mode and reload the chassis using the reload location all command. To disable SVD that is already enabled, use the no svd platform enable command and reload the chassis using the reload location all command.

Calculating Routes Downloaded to Line Card with or without SVD

The number of routes that will be downloaded to the line card with or without selective VRF download option can be calculated by following the Total Tables and Routes Downloaded by Line Card Type table below.

This table summarizes the total routes and tables downloaded on the line cards of each SVD card type. Savings can be calculated by the difference between the numbers in the Without SVD row.

Table 5. Total Tables and Routes Downloaded by Line Card Type
Card Type Tables Downloaded Routes Downloaded
Customer (o+Y) (o+Y)R
Core n nxR
Without SVD n nR
  • n is the total number of VRFs present

  • o is the number of VRF directly provisioned/configured on the card, (n is greater than or equal to o)

  • R is routes per VRF

  • x is the ratio of SVD local: total routes

  • Y is the number of VRFs dependant on directly provisioned VRFs (o), (Y is greater than or equal to 0)

Here is an example calculation:

A customer has 100 VRFs configured on the system, with five line cards. For the IPv4 address family, four line cards are working as customer facing with equal VRF distribution, while one is core facing. Inter-table dependencies do not exist. In this example, n = 100, o = 25, x = 3/10, Y = 0, and R = 1000.

Number of routes downloaded:
  • Without SVD: (nR) = 100,000

  • On customer-facing card: (o+Y)R = 25,000

  • On core-facing card: (nxR) = 30,000

In this example, the SVD feature brings close to 70 per cent savings.

The total number of VRFs present (n) can be found by using the show cef tables summary location node-id command on the RSP card.

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show cef tables summary location 0/rsp0/cpu0

Role change timestamp     : Apr  3 07:21:46.759
Current Role              : Core
No. of times Eod received : 2
Eod received              : Apr  3 07:21:46.980

No. of Tables                 :       106
No. of Converged Tables       :       106
No. of Deleted Tables         :         0
No. of Bcdl Subscribed Tables :       106
No. of Marked Tables          :         0

The number of VRFs provisioned on the line card (o) is derived from the "No. Of Tables" field in the show cef tables summary location 0/0/cpu0 . This provides the tables specific to the Linecard 0/0/cpu0.

The routes per VRF (R) can be found using the show cef tables location node-id command.

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show cef tables location 0/1/CPU0
Sat Apr  6 01:22:32.471 UTC

Codes:   L - SVD Local Routes, R - SVD Remote Routes
         T - Total Routes
         C - Table Converged,  D - Table Deleted
         M - Table Marked,     S - Table Subscribed

Table           Table ID             L          R           T C D M S
default         0xe0000000           9          3          23 Y N N Y
**nVSatellite   0xe0000010           1          0           6 Y N N Y
cdn             0xe0000011           0          0           5 Y N N Y
oir             0xe0000012           0          0           5 Y N N Y
vrf1            0xe0000013           3          1          11 Y N N Y

For the vrf "vrf1" the total routes is in the "T" column which is 11. So if the number of routes per VRF are not the same for all vrfs then total of "routes in all non-default" vrfs will have to be calculated and divided by the number of VRFs, to arrive at the Average Routes per VRF.

The ratio of SVD local: total routes (x) can be found using the number of SVD Local Routes and the number of Total Routes for a given VRF. For example, in the above sample output of show cef tables location 0/1/CPU0 , in the L column, the number represents the Local Routes, and in the T column number represents Total routes in that Vrf. So ratio of L column to T column number will give the ratio for a given vrf. Again if the ratio is not same for all vrfs, it will have to be averaged out over all vrfs.

The number of VRFs dependant on directly provisioned VRFs (Y) will have to manually calculated because it depends on the router configuration. For example, if route import targets in Dependant VRF import from routes exported by other VRFs. A VRF is dependant if it depends on a nexthops being in some other VRF which is directly provisioned. There is no show command to automatically calculate Y, since it depends completely on the way router is configured to import routes in various VRFs.

BGP Accept Own

The BGP Accept Own feature enables handling of self-originated VPN routes, which a BGP speaker receives from a route-reflector (RR). A "self-originated" route is one which was originally advertized by the speaker itself. As per BGP protocol [RFC4271], a BGP speaker rejects advertisements that were originated by the speaker itself. However, the BGP Accept Own mechanism enables a router to accept the prefixes it has advertised, when reflected from a route-reflector that modifies certain attributes of the prefix. A special community called ACCEPT-OWN is attached to the prefix by the route-reflector, which is a signal to the receiving router to bypass the ORIGINATOR_ID and NEXTHOP/MP_REACH_NLRI check. Generally, the BGP speaker detects prefixes that are self-originated through the self-origination check (ORIGINATOR_ID, NEXTHOP/MP_REACH_NLRI) and drops the received updates. However, with the Accept Own community present in the update, the BGP speaker handles the route.

One of the applications of BGP Accept Own is auto-configuration of extranets within MPLS VPN networks. In an extranet configuration, routes present in one VRF is imported into another VRF on the same PE. Normally, the extranet mechanism requires that either the import-rt or the import policy of the extranet VRFs be modified to control import of the prefixes from another VRF. However, with Accept Own feature, the route-reflector can assert that control without the need for any configuration change on the PE. This way, the Accept Own feature provides a centralized mechanism for administering control of route imports between different VRFs.

BGP Accept Own is supported only for VPNv4 and VPNv6 address families in neighbor configuration mode.

Route-Reflector Handling Accept Own Community and RTs

The ACCEPT_OWN community is originated by the InterAS route-reflector (InterAS-RR) using an outbound route-policy. To minimize the propagation of prefixes with the ACCEPT_OWN community attribute, the attribute will be attached on the InterAS-RR using an outbound route-policy towards the originating PE. The InterAs-RR adds the ACCEPT-OWN community and modifies the set of RTs before sending the new Accept Own route to the attached PEs, including the originator, through intervening RRs. The route is modified via route-policy.

Accept Own Configuration Example

In this configuration example:
  • PE11 is configured with Customer VRF and Service VRF.

  • OSPF is used as the IGP.

  • VPNv4 unicast and VPNv6 unicast address families are enabled between the PE and RR neighbors and IPv4 and IPv6 are enabled between PE and CE neighbors.

The Accept Own configuration works as follows:
  1. CE1 originates prefix X.

  2. Prefix X is installed in customer VRF as (RD1:X).

  3. Prefix X is advertised to IntraAS-RR11 as (RD1:X, RT1).

  4. IntraAS-RR11 advertises X to InterAS-RR1 as (RD1:X, RT1).

  5. InterAS-RR1 attaches RT2 to prefix X on the inbound and ACCEPT_OWN community on the outbound and advertises prefix X to IntraAS-RR31.

  6. IntraAS-RR31 advertises X to PE11.

  7. PE11 installs X in Service VRF as (RD2:X,RT1, RT2, ACCEPT_OWN).

Remote PE: Handling of Accept Own Routes

Remote PEs (PEs other than the originator PE), performs bestpath calculation among all the comparable routes. The bestpath algorithm has been modified to prefer an Accept Own path over non-Accept Own path. The bestpath comparison occurs immediately before the IGP metric comparison. If the remote PE receives an Accept Own path from route-reflector 1 and a non-Accept Own path from route-reflector 2, and if the paths are otherwise identical, the Accept Own path is preferred. The import operates on the Accept Own path.

BGP DMZ Link Bandwidth for Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing

Border Gateway Protocol demilitarized zone (BGP DMZ) Link Bandwidth for Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing provides support for unequal cost load balancing for recursive prefixes on local node using BGP DMZ Link Bandwidth. The unequal load balance is achieved by using the dmz-link-bandwidth command in BGP Neighbor configuration mode and the bandwidth command in Interface configuration mode.

BFD Multihop Support for BGP

Bi-directional Forwarding Detection Multihop (BFD-MH) support is enabled for BGP. BFD Multihop establishes a BFD session between two addresses that may span multiple network hops. Cisco IOS XR Software BFD Multihop is based on RFC 5883. For more information on BFD Multihop, refer Interface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers and Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers.

BGP Multi-Instance and Multi-AS

Multiple BGP instances are supported on the router corresponding to a Autonomous System (AS). Each BGP instance is a separate process running on the same or on a different RP/DRP node. The BGP instances do not share any prefix table between them. No need for a common adj-rib-in (bRIB) as is the case with distributed BGP. The BGP instances do not communicate with each other and do not set up peering with each other. Each individual instance can set up peering with another router independently.

Multi-AS BGP enables configuring each instance of a multi-instance BGP with a different AS number.

Multi-Instance and Multi-AS BGP provides these capabilities:

  • Mechanism to consolidate the services provided by multiple routers using a common routing infrastructure into a single IOS-XR router.

  • Mechanism to achieve AF isolation by configuring the different AFs in different BGP instances.

  • Means to achieve higher session scale by distributing the overall peering sessions between multiple instances.

  • Mechanism to achieve higher prefix scale (especially on a RR) by having different instances carrying different BGP tables.

  • Improved BGP convergence under certain scenarios.

  • All BGP functionalities including NSR are supported for all the instances.

  • The load and commit router-level operations can be performed on previously verified or applied configurations.

Restrictions

  • The router supports maximum of 4 BGP instances.

  • Each BGP instance needs a unique router-id.

  • Only one Address Family can be configured under each BGP instance (VPNv4, VPNv6 and RT-Constrain can be configured under multiple BGP instances).

  • IPv4/IPv6 Unicast should be within the same BGP instance in which IPv4/IPv6 Labeled-Unicast is configured.

  • IPv4/IPv6 Multicast should be within the same BGP instance in which IPv4/IPv6 Unicast is configured.

  • All configuration changes for a single BGP instance can be committed together. However, configuration changes for multiple instances cannot be committed together.

  • Cisco recommends that BGP update-source should be unique in the default VRF over all instances while peering with the same remote router.

BGP Prefix Origin Validation Based on RPKI

A BGP route associates an address prefix with a set of autonomous systems (AS) that identify the interdomain path the prefix has traversed in the form of BGP announcements. This set is represented as the AS_PATH attribute in BGP and starts with the AS that originated the prefix.

To help reduce well-known threats against BGP including prefix mis-announcing and monkey-in-the-middle attacks, one of the security requirements is the ability to validate the origination AS of BGP routes. The AS number claiming to originate an address prefix (as derived from the AS_PATH attribute of the BGP route) needs to be verified and authorized by the prefix holder.

The Resource Public Key Infrastructure (RPKI) is an approach to build a formally verifiable database of IP addresses and AS numbers as resources. The RPKI is a globally distributed database containing, among other things, information mapping BGP (internet) prefixes to their authorized origin-AS numbers. Routers running BGP can connect to the RPKI to validate the origin-AS of BGP paths.

The BGP RPKI Bind Source feature allows you to specify the source IP address and interface used for the RPKI server connection. This feature enables you to have RPKI session that source from loopback interface, for example.

BGP origin-as validation is enabled by default.

Configuring RPKI Cache-server

Perform this task to configure Resource Public Key Infrastructure (RPKI) cache-server parameters.

Configure the RPKI cache-server parameters in rpki-server configuration mode. Use the rpki server command in router BGP configuration mode to enter into the rpki-server configuration mode

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. rpki server {host-name | ip-address }
  4. bind-source interface name
  5. Use one of these commands:
    • transport ssh port port_number
    • transport tcp port port_number
  6. (Optional) username user_name
  7. (Optional) password password
  8. preference preference_value
  9. purge-time time
  10. Use one of these commands.
    • refresh-time time
    • refresh-time off
  11. Use one these commands.
    • response-time time
    • response-time off
  12. Use the commit or end command.
  13. (Optional) shutdown

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router bgp 100

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

rpki server {host-name | ip-address }

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#rpki server 10.2.3.4 

Enters rpki-server configuration mode and enables configuration of RPKI cache parameters.

Step 4

bind-source interface name

Example:
Router#(config-bgp)# bind-source interface Loopback2

Specifies a Loopback interface as the source interface used for the RPKI server connection.

Step 5

Use one of these commands:

  • transport ssh port port_number
  • transport tcp port port_number
Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#transport ssh port 22

Or

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#transport tcp port 2

Specifies a transport method for the RPKI cache.

  • ssh —Select ssh to connect to the RPKI cache using SSH.

  • tcp —Select tcp to connect to the RPKI cache using TCP (unencrypted).

  • port port_number —Specify the port number for the RPKI cache transport over TCP and SSH protocols. The port number ranges from 1 to 65535.

    Note

     
    SSH supports custom ports in addition to the default port number 22.

Note

 
You can set the transport to either TCP or SSH. Change of transport causes the cache session to flap.

Step 6

(Optional) username user_name

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#username ssh_rpki_uname
(Optional)

Specifies a (SSH) username for the RPKI cache-server.

Step 7

(Optional) password password

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#password ssh_rpki_pass
(Optional)

Specifies a (SSH) password for the RPKI cache-server.

Note

 
The “username” and “password” configurations only apply if the SSH method of transport is active.

Step 8

preference preference_value

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#preference 1

Specifies a preference value for the RPKI cache. Range for the preference value is 1 to 10. Setting a lower preference value is better.

Step 9

purge-time time

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#purge-time 30

Configures the time BGP waits to keep routes from a cache after the cache session drops. Set purge time in seconds. Range for the purge time is 30 to 360 seconds.

Step 10

Use one of these commands.

  • refresh-time time
  • refresh-time off
Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#refresh-time 20

Or

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#refresh-time off

Configures the time BGP waits in between sending periodic serial queries to the cache. Set refresh-time in seconds. Range for the refresh time is 15 to 3600 seconds.

Configure the off option to specify not to send serial-queries periodically.

Step 11

Use one these commands.

  • response-time time
  • response-time off
Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#response-time 30

Or

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#response-time off

Configures the time BGP waits for a response after sending a serial or reset query. Set response-time in seconds. Range for the response time is 15 to 3600 seconds.

Configure the off option to wait indefinitely for a response.

Step 12

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 13

(Optional) shutdown

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-rpki-server)#shutdown
(Optional)

Configures shut down of the RPKI cache.

Configure BGP Prefix Validation

Starting from Release 6.5.1, origin-as validation is disabled by default, you must enable it per address family. From Release 6.5.1, use the following task to configure RPKI Prefix Validation.

Origin-as validation is enabled by default.

Router(config)# router bgp 100
/* The bgp origin-as validation time and bgp origin-as validity signal ibgp commands are optional. */. 
Router(config-bgp)# bgp origin-as validation time 50
Router(config-bgp)# bgp origin-as validation time off
Router(config-bgp)# bgp origin-as validation signal ibgp
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

!
Router# bgp 65000
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-af)# bgp origin-as validation enable
Router(config-bgp-af)# exit
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv6 unicast
Router(config-bgp-af)# bgp origin-as validation enable

Use the following commands to verify the origin-as validation configuration:

Router# show bgp origin-as validity

Thu Mar 14 04:18:09.656 PDT
BGP router identifier 10.1.1.1, local AS number 1
BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
Non-stop routing is enabled
BGP table state: Active
Table ID: 0xe0000000   RD version: 514
BGP main routing table version 514
BGP NSR Initial initsync version 2 (Reached)
BGP NSR/ISSU Sync-Group versions 0/0
BGP scan interval 60 secs
Status codes: s suppressed, d damped, h history, * valid, > best
              i - internal, r RIB-failure, S stale, N Nexthop-discard
Origin codes: i - IGP, e - EGP, ? - incomplete
Origin-AS validation codes: V valid, I invalid, N not-found, D disabled
    Network                  Next Hop            Metric LocPrf Weight Path
 *> 209.165.200.223/27       0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

 *> 209.165.200.225/27       0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

 *> 19.1.2.0/24              0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

 *> 19.1.3.0/24              0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

 *> 10.1.2.0/24              0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

 *> 10.1.3.0/24              0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

 *> 10.1.4.0/24              0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

 *> 198.51.100.1/24          0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

 *> 203.0.113.235/24         0.0.0.0                  0         32768 ?

V*> 209.165.201.0/27        10.1.2.1                  0         4002 i

N*> 198.51.100.2/24         10.1.2.1                  0         4002 i

I*> 198.51.100.1/24         10.1.2.1                  0          4002 i

 *> 192.0.2.1.0/24          0.0.0.0                    0         32768 ?
Router# show bgp process                  
Mon Jul  9 16:47:39.428 PDT

BGP Process Information: 
...
Use origin-AS validity in bestpath decisions
Allow (origin-AS) INVALID paths
Signal origin-AS validity state to neighbors

Address family: IPv4 Unicast
...
Origin-AS validation is enabled for this address-family
Use origin-AS validity in bestpath decisions for this address-family
Allow (origin-AS) INVALID paths for this address-family
Signal origin-AS validity state to neighbors with this address-family

Configuring RPKI Bestpath Computation

Perform this task to configure RPKI bestpath computation options.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. bgp bestpath origin-as use validity
  4. bgp bestpath origin-as allow invalid
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router bgp 100

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

bgp bestpath origin-as use validity

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#bgp bestpath origin-as use validity

Enables the validity states of BGP paths to affect the path's preference in the BGP best path process. This configuration can also be done in router BGP address family submode.

Step 4

bgp bestpath origin-as allow invalid

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#bgp bestpath origin-as allow invalid
Allows all "invalid" paths to be considered for BGP bestpath computation.

Note

 

This configuration can also be done at global address family, neighbor, and neighbor address family submodes. Configuring bgp bestpath origin-as allow invalid in router BGP and address family submodes allow all "invalid" paths to be considered for BGP bestpath computation. By default, all such paths are not bestpath candidates. Configuring bgp bestpath origin-as allow invalid in neighbor and neighbor address family submodes allow all "invalid" paths from that specific neighbor or neighbor address family to be considered as bestpath candidates. The neighbor must be an eBGP neighbor.

This configuration takes effect only when the bgp bestpath origin-as use validity configuration is enabled.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

BGP Prefix Independent Convergence for RIB and FIB

BGP PIC for RIB and FIB adds support for static recursive as PE-CE and faster backup activation by using fast re-route trigger.

The BGP PIC for RIB and FIB feature supports:

  • FRR-like trigger for faster PE-CE link down detection, to further reduce the convergence time (Fast PIC-edge activation).

  • PIC-edge for static recursive routes.

  • BFD single-hop trigger for PIC-Edge without any explicit /32 static route configuration.

  • Recursive PIC activation at third level and beyond, on failure trigger at the first (IGP) level.

  • BGP path recursion constraints in FIB to ensure that FIB is in sync with BGP with respect to BGP next-hop resolution.

When BGP PIC Edge is configured, configuring the neighbor shutdown command does not trigger CEF to switch to the backup path. Instead, BGP starts to feed CEF again one by one from the top prefix of the routing table to the end thus causing a time delay.


Caution


The time delay causes a traffic outage in the network. As a workaround, you must route the traffic to the backup path manually before configuring the neighbor shutdown command.


Delay BGP Route Advertisements

Table 6. Feature History Table

Feature Name

Release Information

Feature Description

Delay BGP Route Advertisements

Release 7.5.3

You can now prevent traffic loss due to premature advertising of BGP routes and subsequent packet loss in a network. You can achieve this by setting the delay time of the BGP start-up in the router until the Routing Information Base (RIB) is synchronized with the Forward Information Base (FIB) in the routing table. This delays the BGP update generation and prevents traffic loss in a network.

You can configure a minimum delay of 1 second and a maximum delay of 600 seconds.

This feature introduces the update wait-install delay startup command.

When BGP forwards traffic, it waits for feedback from the RIB until the RIB is ready to forward traffic. Once the RIB is ready, BGP sends the route updates to the BGP neighbors and peer-groups. Advertising routes before the RIB is synchronized in the FIB results in traffic loss. To avoid this problem, the router must delay the BGP start-up process to delay the BGP update generation so that no traffic loss happens.

To accomplish this, you must configure the update wait-install delay startup command to delay the generation of BGP updates. The show bgp process command displays the delay of the BGP process update since the last router reload.

This feature allows you to configure the minimum and maximum delay periods. The range of the delay is from 1 second to 600 seconds. As a result, network traffic loss is avoided.

Restrictions

This feature is applicable for the following Address Family Indicators (AFIs):

  • IPv4 unicast

  • IPv6 unicast

  • VPNv4 unicast

  • VPNv6 unicast

Configuration
  1. Enter the IOS XR configuration mode.

    Router# configure
  2. Specify the BGP Autonomous System Number (AS Number).

    Router(config)# router bgp 1
  3. Specify the IP address from the address-family (Pv4, IPv6, VPNv4, or VPNv6) options.

    Router(config-bgp)# address-family {ipv4| ipv6| vpnv4| vpn6} unicast
    For example,
    Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
  4. Schedule the delay of the BGP process to prevent routes from being advertised to peers until RIB is synchronized.

    Router(config-bgp-af)# update wait-install delay startup (time in seconds) 
    For example,
    Router(config-bgp-af)# update wait-install delay startup 10
  5. Commit the changes.

    Router(config-bgp-af)#commit

Note


The delay time ranges from 1 second to 600 seconds.


Running Configuration

configure
router bgp 1
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  update wait-install delay startup 10
!

Verification Example

The following command displays the delay of the BGP process update:

Router# show running-config router bgp 1
router bgp 1
address-family ipv4 unicast
update wait-install delay startup 10


Disable the BGP Fast Reroute Reset Timer

For BGP PIC-edge scenarios where dual-home CE and BFD or BGP are running between PE and CE routers, a BGP Fast Reroute (FRR) reset timer ensures that in case the best path isn't available, traffic is forwarded for four minutes on the backup path to prevent traffic loss. However, when an interface or BFD flap occurs, the BGP FRR may continue forwarding traffic on the backup path even though the primary path is restored. Such a scenario may cause prolonged traffic outages. To prevent such potential outages, run the cef fast-reroute follow bgp-pic command to turn off the BGP FRR reset timer.

Note that:

BGP Update Message Error Handling

The BGP UPDATE message error handling changes BGP behavior in handling error UPDATE messages to avoid session reset. Based on the approach described in IETF IDR I-D:draft-ietf-idr-error-handling, the Cisco IOS XR BGP UPDATE Message Error handling implementation classifies BGP update errors into various categories based on factors such as, severity, likelihood of occurrence of UPDATE errors, or type of attributes. Errors encountered in each category are handled according to the draft. Session reset will be avoided as much as possible during the error handling process. Error handling for some of the categories are controlled by configuration commands to enable or disable the default behavior.

According to the base BGP specification, a BGP speaker that receives an UPDATE message containing a malformed attribute is required to reset the session over which the offending attribute was received. This behavior is undesirable as a session reset would impact not only routes with the offending attribute, but also other valid routes exchanged over the session.

BGP Attribute Filtering

The BGP Attribute Filter feature checks integrity of BGP updates in BGP update messages and optimizes reaction when detecting invalid attributes. BGP Update message contains a list of mandatory and optional attributes. These attributes in the update message include MED, LOCAL_PREF, COMMUNITY etc. In some cases, if the attributes are malformed, there is a need to filter these attributes at the receiving end of the router. The BGP Attribute Filter functionality filters the attributes received in the incoming update message. The attribute filter can also be used to filter any attributes that may potentially cause undesirable behavior on the receiving router.

Some of the BGP updates are malformed due to wrong formatting of attributes such as the network layer reachability information (NLRI) or other fields in the update message. These malformed updates, when received, causes undesirable behavior on the receiving routers. Such undesirable behavior may be encountered during update message parsing or during re-advertisement of received NLRIs. In such scenarios, its better to filter these corrupted attributes at the receiving end.

BGP Attribute Filter Actions

The Attribute-filtering is configured by specifying a single or a range of attribute codes and an associated action. The allowed actions are:

  • " Treat-as-withdraw"— The associated IPv4-unicast or MP_REACH NLRIs, if present, are withdrawn from the neighbor's Adj-RIB-In.

  • "Discard Attribute"—The matching attributes alone are discarded and the rest of the Update message is processed normally.

When a received Update message contains one or more filtered attributes, the configured action is applied on the message. Optionally, the Update message is also stored to facilitate further debugging and a syslog message is generated on the console.

When an attribute matches the filter, further processing of the attribute is stopped and the corresponding action is taken.

Use the attribute-filter group command to enter Attribute-filter group command mode. Use the attribute command in attribute-filter group command mode to either discard an attribute or treat the update message as a "Withdraw" action.

BGP Error Handling and Attribute Filtering Syslog Messages

When a router receives a malformed update packet, an ios_msg of type ROUTING-BGP-3-MALFORM_UPDATE is printed on the console. This is rate limited to 1 message per minute across all neighbors. For malformed packets that result in actions "Discard Attribute" (A5) or "Local Repair" (A6), the ios_msg is printed only once per neighbor per action. This is irrespective of the number of malformed updates received since the neighbor last reached an "Established" state.

This is a sample BGP error handling syslog message:

%ROUTING-BGP-3-MALFORM_UPDATE : Malformed UPDATE message received from neighbor 13.0.3.50 - message length 90 bytes,
 error flags 0x00000840, action taken "TreatAsWithdraw". 
Error details: "Error 0x00000800, Field "Attr-missing", Attribute 1 (Flags 0x00, Length 0), Data []"

This is a sample BGP attribute filtering syslog message for the "discard attribute" action:

[4843.46]RP/0/0/CPU0:Aug 21 17:06:17.919 : bgp[1037]: %ROUTING-BGP-5-UPDATE_FILTERED : 
One or more attributes were filtered from UPDATE message received from neighbor 40.0.101.1 - message length 173 bytes,
 action taken "DiscardAttr".
 Filtering details: "Attribute 16 (Flags 0xc0): Action "DiscardAttr"". NLRIs: [IPv4 Unicast] 88.2.0.0/17

This is a sample BGP attribute filtering syslog message for the "treat-as-withdraw" action:

[391.01]RP/0/0/CPU0:Aug 20 19:41:29.243 : bgp[1037]: %ROUTING-BGP-5-UPDATE_FILTERED :
 One or more attributes were filtered from UPDATE message received from neighbor 40.0.101.1 - message length 166 bytes,
 action taken "TreatAsWdr".
 Filtering details: "Attribute 4 (Flags 0xc0): Action "TreatAsWdr"". NLRIs: [IPv4 Unicast] 88.2.0.0/17

BGP Link-State

BGP Link-State (LS) is an Address Family Identifier (AFI) and Sub-address Family Identifier (SAFI) originally defined to carry interior gateway protocol (IGP) link-state information through BGP. The BGP Network Layer Reachability Information (NLRI) encoding format for BGP-LS and a new BGP Path Attribute called the BGP-LS attribute are defined in RFC7752. The identifying key of each Link-State object, namely a node, link, or prefix, is encoded in the NLRI and the properties of the object are encoded in the BGP-LS attribute.


Note


IGPs do not use BGP LS data from remote peers. BGP does not download the received BGP LS data to any other component on the router.

An example of a BGP-LS application is the Segment Routing Path Computation Element (SR-PCE). The SR-PCE can learn the SR capabilities of the nodes in the topology and the mapping of SR segments to those nodes. This can enable the SR-PCE to perform path computations based on SR-TE and to steer traffic on paths different from the underlying IGP-based distributed best-path computation.

The following figure shows a typical deployment scenario. In each IGP area, one or more nodes (BGP speakers) are configured with BGP-LS. These BGP speakers form an iBGP mesh by connecting to one or more route-reflectors. This way, all BGP speakers (specifically the route-reflectors) obtain Link-State information from all IGP areas (and from other ASes from eBGP peers).

Exchange Link State Information with BGP Neighbor

The following example shows how to exchange link-state information with a BGP neighbor:


Router# configure
Router(config)# router bgp 1
Router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.2
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family link-state link-state
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# exit

IGP Link-State Database Distribution

A given BGP node may have connections to multiple, independent routing domains. IGP link-state database distribution into BGP-LS is supported for both OSPF and IS-IS protocols in order to distribute this information on to controllers or applications that desire to build paths spanning or including these multiple domains.

To distribute OSPFv2 link-state data using BGP-LS, use the distribute link-state command in router configuration mode.


Router# configure
Router(config)# router ospf 100
Router(config-ospf)# distribute link-state instance-id 32

Usage Guidelines and Limitations

  • BGP-LS supports IS-IS and OSPFv2.

  • The identifier field of BGP-LS (referred to as the Instance-ID) identifies the IGP routing domain where the NLRI belongs. The NLRIs representing link-state objects (nodes, links, or prefixes) from the same IGP routing instance must use the same Instance-ID value.

  • When there is only a single protocol instance in the network where BGP-LS is operational, we recommend configuring the Instance-ID value to 0.

  • Assign consistent BGP-LS Instance-ID values on all BGP-LS Producers within a given IGP domain.

  • NLRIs with different Instance-ID values are considered to be from different IGP routing instances.

  • Unique Instance-ID values must be assigned to routing protocol instances operating in different IGP domains. This allows the BGP-LS Consumer (for example, SR-PCE) to build an accurate segregated multi-domain topology based on the Instance-ID values, even when the topology is advertised via BGP-LS by multiple BGP-LS Producers in the network.

  • If the BGP-LS Instance-ID configuration guidelines are not followed, a BGP-LS Consumer may see duplicate link-state objects for the same node, link, or prefix when there are multiple BGP-LS Producers deployed. This may also result in the BGP-LS Consumers getting an inaccurate network-wide topology.

  • The following table defines the supported extensions to the BGP-LS address family for carrying IGP topology information (including SR information) via BGP. For more information on the BGP-LS TLVs, refer to Border Gateway Protocol - Link State (BGP-LS) Parameters.

Table 7. IOS XR Supported BGP-LS Node Descriptor, Link Descriptor, Prefix Descriptor, and Attribute TLVs
TLV Code Point Description Produced by IS-IS Produced by OSPFv2 Produced by BGP
256 Local Node Descriptors X X
257 Remote Node Descriptors X X
258 Link Local/Remote Identifiers X X
259 IPv4 interface address X X
260 IPv4 neighbor address X
261 IPv6 interface address X
262 IPv6 neighbor address X
263 Multi-Topology ID X
264 OSPF Route Type X
265 IP Reachability Information X X
266 Node MSD TLV X X
267 Link MSD TLV X X
512 Autonomous System X
513 BGP-LS Identifier X
514 OSPF Area-ID X
515 IGP Router-ID X X
516 BGP Router-ID TLV X
517 BGP Confederation Member TLV X
1024 Node Flag Bits X X
1026 Node Name X X
1027 IS-IS Area Identifier X
1028 IPv4 Router-ID of Local Node X X
1029 IPv6 Router-ID of Local Node X
1030 IPv4 Router-ID of Remote Node X X
1031 IPv6 Router-ID of Remote Node X
1034 SR Capabilities TLV X X
1035 SR Algorithm TLV X X
1036 SR Local Block TLV X X
1039 Flex Algo Definition (FAD) TLV X X
1044 Flex Algorithm Prefix Metric (FAPM) TLV X X
1088 Administrative group (color) X X
1089 Maximum link bandwidth X X
1090 Max. reservable link bandwidth X X
1091 Unreserved bandwidth X X
1092 TE Default Metric X X
1093 Link Protection Type X X
1094 MPLS Protocol Mask X X
1095 IGP Metric X X
1096 Shared Risk Link Group X X
1099 Adjacency SID TLV X X
1100 LAN Adjacency SID TLV X X
1101 PeerNode SID TLV X
1102 PeerAdj SID TLV X
1103 PeerSet SID TLV X
1114 Unidirectional Link Delay TLV X X
1115 Min/Max Unidirectional Link Delay TLV X X
1116 Unidirectional Delay Variation TLV X X
1117 Unidirectional Link Loss X X
1118 Unidirectional Residual Bandwidth X X
1119 Unidirectional Available Bandwidth X X
1120 Unidirectional Utilized Bandwidth X X
1122 Application-Specific Link Attribute TLV X X
1152 IGP Flags X X
1153 IGP Route Tag X X
1154 IGP Extended Route Tag X
1155 Prefix Metric X X
1156 OSPF Forwarding Address X
1158 Prefix-SID X X
1159 Range X X
1161 SID/Label TLV X X
1170 Prefix Attribute Flags X X
1171 Source Router Identifier X
1172 L2 Bundle Member Attributes TLV X
1173 Extended Administrative Group X X

BGP Permanent Network

BGP permanent network feature supports static routing through BGP. BGP routes to IPv4 or IPv6 destinations (identified by a route-policy) can be administratively created and selectively advertised to BGP peers. These routes remain in the routing table until they are administratively removed.

A permanent network is used to define a set of prefixes as permanent, that is, there is only one BGP advertisement or withdrawal in upstream for a set of prefixes. For each network in the prefix-set, a BGP permanent path is created and treated as less preferred than the other BGP paths received from its peer. The BGP permanent path is downloaded into RIB when it is the best-path.

The permanent-network command in global address family configuration mode uses a route-policy to identify the set of prefixes (networks) for which permanent paths is to be configured. The advertise permanent-network command in neighbor address-family configuration mode is used to identify the peers to whom the permanent paths must be advertised. The permanent paths is always advertised to peers having the advertise permanent-network configuration, even if a different best-path is available. The permanent path is not advertised to peers that are not configured to receive permanent path.

The permanent network feature supports only prefixes in IPv4 unicast and IPv6 unicast address-families under the default Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF).

Restrictions

These restrictions apply while configuring the permanent network:

  • Permanent network prefixes must be specified by the route-policy on the global address family.

  • You must configure the permanent network with route-policy in global address family configuration mode and then configure it on the neighbor address family configuration mode.

  • When removing the permanent network configuration, remove the configuration in the neighbor address family configuration mode and then remove it from the global address family configuration mode.

BGP-RIB Feedback Mechanism for Update Generation

The Border Gateway Protocol-Routing Information Base (BGP-RIB) feedback mechanism for update generation feature avoids premature route advertisements and subsequent packet loss in a network. This mechanism ensures that routes are installed locally, before they are advertised to a neighbor.

BGP waits for feedback from RIB indicating that the routes that BGP installed in RIB are installed in forwarding information base (FIB) before BGP sends out updates to the neighbors. RIB uses the the BCDL feedback mechanism to determine which version of the routes have been consumed by FIB, and updates the BGP with that version. BGP will send out updates of only those routes that have versions up to the version that FIB has installed. This selective update ensures that BGP does not send out premature updates resulting in attracting traffic even before the data plane is programmed after router reload, LC OIR, or flap of a link where an alternate path is made available.

To configure BGP to wait for feedback from RIB indicating that the routes that BGP installed in RIB are installed in FIB, before BGP sends out updates to neighbors, use the update wait-install command in router address-family IPv4 or router address-family VPNv4 configuration mode. The show bgp , show bgp neighbors , and show bgp process performance-statistics commands display the information from update wait-install configuration.

BGP VRF Dynamic Route Leaking

The Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) dynamic route leaking feature provides the ability to import routes between the default-vrf (Global VRF) and any other non-default VRF, to provide connectivity between a global and a VPN host. The import process installs the Internet route in a VRF table or a VRF route in the Internet table, providing connectivity.

Restriction: The BGP VRF Dynamic Route Leaking feature is not supported when BGP aggregate-address prefixes are imported from the source VRF to the destination VRF within a node using dynamic route-leaking and BGP PIC is enabled.


Note


A leaked route should not cover or override any routes in the destination VRF. For example consider two connected routers R1 with destination VRF 'dest-vrf' and R2 with source VRF 'source-vrf'. The source-vrf connected route CR-1 is leaked to dest-vrf. In this case, the route from dest-vrf is covered or overridden by the leaked route CR-1 from the source-vrf.


The dynamic route leaking is enabled by:

  • Importing from default-VRF to non-default-VRF, using the import from default-vrf route-policy route-policy-name [ advertise-as-vpn] command in VRF address-family configuration mode.

    If the advertise-as-vpn option is configured, the paths imported from the default-VRF to the non-default-VRF are advertised to the PEs as well as to the CEs. If the advertise-as-vpn option is not configured, the paths imported from the default-VRF to the non-default-VRF are not advertised to the PE. However, the paths are still advertised to the CEs.

  • Importing from non-default-VRF to default VRF, using the export to default-vrf route-policy route-policy-name command in VRF address-family configuration mode.

A route-policy is mandatory to filter the imported routes. This reduces the risk of unintended import of routes between the Internet table and the VRF tables and the corresponding security issues.

There is no hard limit on the number of prefixes that can be imported. The import creates a new prefix in the destination VRF, which increases the total number of prefixes and paths. However, each VRF importing global routes adds workload equivalent to a neighbor receiving the global table. This is true even if the user filters out all but a few prefixes. Hence, importing five to ten VRFs is ideal.


Note


With dynamic route-leaking enabled, BGP bestpath change suppression for eBGP paths might be skipped. BGP convergence might be impacted.


EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking

The EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking feature leak routes between EVPN address-family and IPv4/IPv6 unicast address-family (Default-VRF), enabling the data center hosts to access the Internet. This feature is an extension of Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) VRF Dynamic route leaking feature that provides connectivity between non-default VRF hosts and Default VRF hosts by exchanging routes between the non-default VRF and Default VRF. EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking feature extends the BGP VRF Dynamic leaking feature, by allowing EVPN/L3VPN hosts to communicate with Default VRF hosts.

The import process installs the Internet route in a VRF table or a VRF route in the Internet table, providing connectivity.

The BGP VRF Dynamic route leaking feature is enabled by:

  • Importing from default-VRF to non-default-VRF using the following command in VRF address-family configuration mode.

    import from default-vrf route-policy route-policy-name [advertise-as-vpn]

    If the advertise-as-vpn keyword is used, the paths imported from the default-VRF to the non-default-VRF are advertised to the (EVPN/L3VPN) PEs as well as to the CEs. If the advertise-as-vpn keyword is not used, the paths imported from the default-VRF to the non-default-VRF are not advertised to the PEs. However, the paths are still advertised to the CEs.

    The EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking feature with advertise-as-vpn keyword, enables to advertise the paths imported from default-VRF to non-default VRFs to EVPN PE peers as well.

    A new command advertise vpnv4/vpnv6 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable is added under neighbor address-family configuration mode for EVPN and VPNv4/VPNv6 unicast to disable advertisement of Default-VRF leaked routes to that neighbor.

  • Importing from non-default-VRF to default-VRF using the following command in VRF address-family configuration mode.

    export to default-vrf route-policy route-policy-name [advertise-as-vpn]

    The Dynamic Route Leaking feature enables leaking of local and CE routes to Default-VRF.

    A new optional keyword allow-imported-vpn is added to the above command, when configured, enables the leaking of EVPN and L3VPN imported/re-originated routes to the Default-VRF.

A route-policy is mandatory to filter the imported routes. This reduces the risk of unintended import of routes between the Internet table and the VRF tables and the corresponding security issues. There is no hard limit on the number of prefixes that can be imported. The import creates a new prefix in the destination VRF, which increases the total number of prefixes and paths.


Note


Each VRF importing global routes adds workload equivalent to a neighbor receiving the global table. This is true even if the user filters out all but a few prefixes.


Scale Limitation of Default Route Leaking

Default VRF route leaking uses Dynamic Route Leaking feature to leak prefixes between the default VRF and the DC VRF. Do not use Dynamic Route Leaking feature to leak default VRF prefixes to large number of DC VRFs, even if you filter out all prefixes except a few that are to be leaked.

The following are the key factors that affect the performance:

  • The default VRF prefix scale, which is approximately 0.7 million internet prefixes.

  • The number of DC VRFs the default VRF prefixes that are to be imported.

To improve the scale, either the prefix scale or the number of VRFs whose prefixes that are to be imported must be reduced.

To manage the scale limitation, Cisco recommends you to do the following:

  • Host the Internet prefixes on an adjacent PE with IPv4 unicast peering with DCI, and advertise a default route towards the DCI. On the DCI, import the default route from default VRF to DC VRFs.

  • Host the Internet prefixes on an adjacent PE with IPv4 unicast peering with DCI. On the DCI, configure a static default route in the DC VRF with the next hop of the default VRF pointing to the adjacent PE address.

  • Configure the static default route 0.0.0.0/0 on DC VRF with nexthop as “vrf default”.


    Note


    If the static routes are re-distributed to BGP, make sure it is not unintentionally advertised out.


EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking on the DCI for Internet Connectivity

The EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking feature leak routes between the Default-VRF and Data Center-VRF on the DCI to provide Internet access to data center hosts.

This feature is enabled by:

  • Leaking routes from Default-VRF to Data Center-VRF

  • Leaking routes to Default-VRF from Data Center-VRF

Leaking Routes from Default-VRF to Data Center-VRF

This section explains the process of leaking Default-VRF routes to Data Center-VRF.

Figure 12. Leaking Routes from Default-VRF to Data Center-VRF


Procedure

Step 1

The Internet routes are present in the Default-VRF on the DCI.

Note

 

A static default-route (0/0) can be configured under Default-VRF router static address-family configuration and redistributed to BGP.

Step 2

A route-policy is configured to select the routes to be leaked from Default-VRF to Data Center-VRF.

Example:

route-policy import-from-default-policy
  if destination in (100.10.0.0/16, 100.20.0.0/16) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy import-from-default-policy-v6
  if destination in (100:10::0/64, 100:20::0/64) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

Note

 
Instead of leaking the internet routes, you can leak the default-route 0/0 from Default-VRF to Data Center-VRF using the following policy.

route-policy import-from-default-policy
  if destination in (0.0.0.0/0) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy import-from-default-policy-v6
  if destination in (0::0/0) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

Step 3

Leak Default-VRF routes specified in the route-policy to Data Center-VRF by configuring import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy(-v6) under Data Center VRF address-family configuration mode.

Example:

vrf data-center-vrf
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy
!
address-family ipv6 unicast
  import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy-v6
!

Step 4

Advertise the leaked (Default-VRF) routes in the Data Center-VRF as EVPN routes towards Data Center routers by configuring advertise-as-vpn option.

Example:

vrf data-center-vrf
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy advertise-as-vpn
!
address-family ipv6 unicast
  import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy-v6 advertise-as-vpn
!

Note

 

To advertise any routes from L3VPN address-family to EVPN peers, use advertise vpnv4/vpnv6 unicast re-originated [stitching-rt] command under neighbor address-family L2VPN EVPN.

EVPN Default-originate

Instead of advertising the Default-VRF routes towards Data Center routers, default-originate can be configured under the EVPN neighbor address-family to advertise the default route. When default-originate is configured under the neighbor address-family for EVPN/L3VPN, there is no need to advertise the Default-VRF leaked routes to the data center and advertise-as-vpn need not be configured.

Example:

router bgp 100
  neighbor 40.0.0.1
    address-family l2vpn evpn
      default-originate

 vrf data-center-vrf
  rd auto
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    allow vpn default-originate
 !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    allow vpn default-originate

Step 5

To block advertisement of the Default-VRF leaked routes towards a particular EVPN/L3VPN peer, use advertise vpnv4/vpnv6 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable command under respective neighbor address-family.

Example:

router bgp 100
  neighbor 40.0.0.1
    address-family l2vpn evpn
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable
!
router bgp 100
  neighbor 60.0.0.1
    address-family vpnv4 unicast
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable
    address-family vpnv6 unicast
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable


Leaking Routes to Default-VRF from Data Center-VRF

This section explains the process of leaking Data Center-VRF routes to Default-VRF.

Figure 13. Leaking Routes to Default-VRF from Data Center-VRF


Procedure

Step 1

Data Center routes are received on the DCI as EVPN Route-type 2 and Route-type 5 NLRI and imported to the Data Center VRFs.

Step 2

A route-policy is configured to select the routes to be leaked from Data Center-VRF to Default-VRF.

Example:

route-policy export-to-default-policy
  if destination in (200.47.0.0/16, 200.168.0.0/16) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy export-to-default-policy-v6
  if destination in (200:47::0/64, 200:168::0/64) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!


Step 3

Leak Data Center-VRF routes specified in the above policy to Default-VRF by configuring export to default-vrf route-policy export-to-default-policy(-v6) [allow-imported-vpn] under Data Center-VRF address-family configuration mode.

Normally only local and CE VRF routes are allowed to be leaked to the Default-VRF, but allow-imported-vpn configuration enables leaking of EVPN/L3VPN imported routes to the Default-VRF.

Example:

vrf data-center-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    export to default-vrf route-policy export-to-default-policy [allow-imported-vpn]
  !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    export to default-vrf route-policy export-to-default-policy-v6 [allow-imported-vpn]
  !

Step 4

The Leaked routes in the Default VRF are advertised to the Internet.

Note

 

Instead of advertising the leaked routes to the Internet, an aggregate can be configured and advertised to the Internet.


Sample Router Configuration
The following sample configuration specifies how EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking feature is configured on a DCI router to provide Internet access to the data center hosts.

vrf data-center-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy advertise-as-vpn
    export to default-vrf route-policy export-to-default-policy allow-imported-vpn
  !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy-v6 advertise-as-vpn
    export to default-vrf route-policy export-to-default-policy-v6 allow-imported-vpn
  !

route-policy import-from-default-policy
  if destination in (100.10.0.0/16, 100.20.0.0/16) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy import-from-default-policy-v6
  if destination in (100:10::0/64, 100:20::0/64) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy export-to-default-policy
  if destination in (200.47.0.0/16, 200.168.0.0/16) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy export-to-default-policy-v6
  if destination in (200:47::0/64, 200:168::0/64) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!

router bgp 100
  neighbor 40.0.0.1
    address-family l2vpn evpn
      import stitching-rt re-originate
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated stitching-rt

  neighbor 60.0.0.1
    address-family vpnv4 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable

    address-family vpnv6 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable
Sample Router Configuration: with default-originate
The following sample configuration specifies how EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking feature is configured along with default-originate on a DCI router to provide Internet access to data center hosts.

vrf data-center-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy <= Remove advertise-as-vpn=>
    export to default-vrf route-policy export-to-default-policy allow-imported-vpn
  !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import from default-vrf route-policy import-from-default-policy-v6 <= Remove advertise-as-vpn=>
    export to default-vrf route-policy export-to-default-policy-v6 allow-imported-vpn
  !
route-policy import-from-default-policy
  if destination in (100.10.0.0/16, 100.20.0.0/16) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!
route-policy import-from-default-policy-v6
  if destination in (100:10::0/64, 100:20::0/64) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!
route-policy export-to-default-policy
  if destination in (200.47.0.0/16, 200.168.0.0/16) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!
route-policy export-to-default-policy-v6
  if destination in (200:47::0/64, 200:168::0/64) then
    pass
  endif
end-policy
!
router bgp 100
  neighbor 40.0.0.1
    address-family l2vpn evpn
      import stitching-rt re-originate
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
      default-originate <= Added=>

  neighbor 60.0.0.1
    address-family vpnv4 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable

    address-family vpnv6 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-default-vrf disable

 vrf data-center-vrf
  rd auto
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    allow vpn default-originate <= Added=>
  !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    allow vpn default-originate <= Added=>

EVPN Service VRF Route Leaking

The EVPN Service VRF Route Leaking feature enables connectivity to the services in the Service VRF to customers in EVPN Data Center VRF. The Service VRF and Data Center VRF routes can be IPv4 and/or IPv6 addresses. The Services VRF is any L3 VRF providing services reachable through connected, static, re-distributed IGP or BGP routes.

This feature leaks routes between Data Center VRF and Service VRF, enabling the EVPN/L3VPN hosts to access the Services in the Service VRF. This feature rely on Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) VRF extranet feature that imports routes between two VRFs.

The import process installs the Data Center VRF routes in a Service VRF table or a Service VRF routes in the Data Center VRF table, providing connectivity.

The BGP Service VRF route leaking feature is enabled by:
  • Importing routes from Service VRF to Data Center VRF and advertising it as EVPN/L3VPN route from Data Center VRF.

    • Importing Service VRF routes to Data Center VRF by attaching Data Center VRF import RTs to Service VRF routes.

      This can be achieved by configuring one or more Data Center VRF import RTs as export RT of Service VRF, or configuring a Service VRF export route-policy to attach import RT EXTCOMM to Service VRF routes matching the import RTs of Data Center VRF using the following command in Service VRF address-family configuration mode.

      export route-policy service-vrf-export-route-policy-name

      Where the route-policy "service-vrf-export-route-policy-name" attaches the RT EXTCOMM matching the one or more import RTs of Data Center VRF to Service VRF routes.

    • Advertising Data Center VRF imported routes that are exported from Service VRFs as EVPN/L3VPN NLRI from Data Center VRF using the following command in Data Center VRF address-family configuration mode.

      import from vrf advertise-as-vpn

      If the advertise-as-vpn keyword is used, the paths imported from the Service VRF to the Data Center VRF are advertised to the (EVPN/L3VPN) PEs as well as to the CEs. If the advertise-as-vpn keyword is not used, the paths imported from the Service VRF to the Data Center VRF are not advertised to the PEs. However, the paths are still advertised to the CEs.

    • Block advertising Data Center VRF leaked routes from being advertised to a neighbor using the following command in neighbor address-family configuration mode.

      advertise vpnv4/vpnv6 unicast imported-from-vrf disable

      A new command advertise vpnv4/vpnv6 unicast imported-from-vrf disable is added under neighbor address-family configuration mode for EVPN and VPNv4/VPNv6 unicast to disable advertisement of VRF to VRF leaked routes to that neighbor.

  • Importing EVPN/L3VPN routes from Data Center VRF to Service VRF

    • Importing EVPN/L3VPN routes from Data Center VRF to Service VRF by attaching Service VRF import RTs.

      This can be achieved by configuring one or more Service VRF import RTs as export RT of Data Center VRF, or configuring a Data Center VRF export route-policy to attach import RT EXTCOMM to Data Center VRF routes matching the import RTs of Service VRF using the following command in Data Center VRF address-family configuration mode.

      export route-policy data-center-vrf-export-route-policy-name

      The route-policy "data-center-vrf-export-route-policy-name" attaches the RT EXTCOMM matching one or more import RTs of Service VRF.

    • Allow leaking of Data Center VRF routes to Service VRF by using the following command in Data Center VRF address-family configuration mode.

      export to vrf allow-imported-vpn


Note


In order to prevent un-intended import of routes to VRFs, select unique RT's to import routes between Service VRF and Data Center VRF, which are not used for normal import of VPN/EVPN routes to Data Center VRFs.


The Extranet Route Leaking feature enables leaking of local and CE routes from one VRF to another VRF. A new command export to vrf allow-imported-vpn is added to enable the leaking of EVPN and L3VPN imported/re-originated Data Center VRF routes to the Service VRF.


Note


A route-policy is preferred to filter the imported routes. This reduces the risk of unintended import of routes between the Data Center VRF and the Service VRF, and the corresponding security issues. There is no hard limit on the number of prefixes that can be imported. The import creates a new prefix in the destination VRF, which increases the total number of prefixes and paths.



Note


This feature does not advertise EVPN/L3VPN PE routes imported to Data Center VRF and leaked to Service VRF as EVPN/L3VPN PE route.


EVPN Service VRF Route Leaking on the DCI for Service Connectivity

The EVPN Service VRF Route Leaking feature leaks routes between the Service VRF and Data Center VRF on the DCI to provide access to Services to data center hosts.

This feature is enabled by:

  • Leaking routes from Service VRF to Data Center VRF

  • Leaking routes to Service VRF from Data Center VRF

Leaking Routes from Service VRF to Data Center VRF

This section explains the process of leaking Service VRF routes to Data Center VRF.

Figure 14. Leaking Routes from Service VRF to Data Center VRF
Procedure

Step 1

The Service routes are present in the Service VRF on the DCI.

Step 2

A route-policy is configured to select the routes to be leaked from Service VRF to Data Center VRF.

Example:

route-policy service-vrf-export-policy
  if destination in (100.10.0.0/16, 100.20.0.0/16) then
    set extcommunity rt (1:1) additive <--- matches import RT of Data Center-VRF
  endif
end-policy
!
route-policy service-vrf-export-policy-v6
  if destination in (100:10::0/64, 100:20::0/64) then
    set extcommunity rt (1:1) additive <--- matches import RT of Data Center-VRF
  endif
end-policy
!

Step 3

Leak Service VRF routes specified in the route-policy to Data Center VRF by configuring export route-policy service-vrf-export-policy(-v6) under Service VRF address-family configuration mode.

Example:

vrf service-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
    export route-policy service-vrf-export-policy
    export route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
   !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
    export route-policy service-vrf-export-policy-v6
    export route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
   !

Step 4

Advertise the leaked (Service VRF) routes in the Data Center VRF as EVPN/L3VPN routes towards Data Center routers by configuring import from vrf advertise-as-vpn under Data Center VRF address-family configuration mode..

Example:

vrf data-center-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import from vrf advertise-as-vpn
    import route-target
      1:1
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
    export route-target
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
  !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import from vrf advertise-as-vpn
    import route-target
      1:1
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
    export route-target
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
  !


Note

 

To advertise any routes from L3VPN address-family to EVPN peers, use advertise vpnv4/vpnv6 unicast re-originated [stitching-rt] command under neighbor address-family L2VPN EVPN.

EVPN Default-originate

Instead of advertising the Service VRF routes towards Data Center routers, default-originate can be configured under the EVPN neighbor address-family to advertise the default route. When allow vpn default-originate is configured under the Data Center VRF, there is no need to advertise the Service VRF leaked routes to the data center and advertise-as-vpn need not be configured.

Example:

router bgp 100
  neighbor 40.0.0.1
    address-family l2vpn evpn
      default-originate

 vrf data-center-vrf
  rd auto
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    allow vpn default-originate
 !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    allow vpn default-originate

Step 5

To block advertisement of the Service VRF leaked routes towards a particular EVPN/L3VPN peer, use advertise vpnv4/vpnv6 unicast imported-from-vrf disable command under respective neighbor address-family.

Example:

router bgp 100
  neighbor 40.0.0.1
    address-family l2vpn evpn
      import stitching-rt re-originate
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
    !
router bgp 100
  neighbor 60.0.0.1
    address-family vpnv4 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
    address-family vpnv6 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-vrf disable


Leaking Routes to Service VRF from Data Center VRF

This section explains the process of leaking Data Center VRF routes to Service VRF.

Figure 15. Leaking Routes to Service VRF from Data Center VRF
Procedure

Step 1

Data Center routes are received on the DCI as EVPN Route-type 2 and Route-type 5 NLRI and imported to the Data Center VRFs.

Step 2

A route-policy is configured to select the routes to be leaked from Data Center VRF to Service VRF.

The policy attaches RT EXTCOMM to Data Center VRF routes matching one or more import RT of the Service VRF.

Example:

route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy
  if destination in (200.47.0.0/16) then <--- EVPN PE route
    set extcommunity rt (4:1) additive <--- matches import stitching-RT of service-VRF
  if destination in (200.168.0.0/16) then <--- VPNv4 PE route
    set extcommunity rt (3:1) additive <--- matches import RT of service-VRF
  endif
end-policy
!
route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy-v6
  if destination in (200:47::0/64) then <--- EVPN PE route
    set extcommunity rt (4:1) additive <--- matches import stitching-RT of service-VRF
  elseif destination in (200:168::0/64) then <--- VPNv6 PE route
    set extcommunity rt (3:1) additive <--- matches import RT of service-VRF
  endif
end-policy
!

Note

 

An EVPN/L3VPN route received from a neighbor configured locally with "import stitching-rt re-originate" is imported to Data Center VRF if the route's RT EXTCOMM matches with one or more Data Center VRF import stitching RTs, and is leaked to Service VRF if the Data Center VRF route's RT EXTCOMM matches with one or more Service VRF import stitching RTs.

Step 3

Leak Data Center VRF routes specified in the above policy to Service VRF by configuring export route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy(-v6) under Data Center VRF address-family configuration mode.

Normally only local and CE VRF routes are allowed to be leaked to the Service VRF, but allow-imported-vpn configuration enables leaking of EVPN/L3VPN imported routes to the Service VRF.

Example:

vrf data-center-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import from vrf advertise-as-vpn
    import route-target
      1:1
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
    export route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy
    export to vrf allow-imported-vpn
    export route-target
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
  !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import from vrf advertise-as-vpn
    import route-target
      1:1
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
    export route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy-v6
    export to vrf allow-imported-vpn
    export route-target
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
  !

Step 4

The Data Center VRF leaked routes in the Service VRF are advertised to Service VRF CE peers.


Sample Router Configuration
The following sample configuration specifies how EVPN Service VRF Route Leaking feature is configured on a DCI router providing access to data center hosts to Services in the Service VRF.

vrf data-center-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import from vrf advertise-as-vpn
    import route-target
      1:1
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
    export route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy
    export to vrf allow-imported-vpn
    export route-target
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
  !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import from vrf advertise-as-vpn
    import route-target
      1:1
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
    export route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy-v6
    export to vrf allow-imported-vpn
    export route-target
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
  !

vrf service-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
    export route-policy service-vrf-export-policy
    export route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
   !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
    export route-policy service-vrf-export-policy-v6
    export route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
   !

route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy
  if destination in (200.47.0.0/16) then
    set extcommunity rt (4:1) additive 
  if destination in (200.168.0.0/16) 
    set extcommunity rt (3:1) additive
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy-v6
  if destination in (200:47::0/64) then 
    set extcommunity rt (4:1) additive
  elseif destination in (200:168::0/64) 
    set extcommunity rt (3:1) additive 
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy service-vrf-export-policy
  if destination in (100.10.0.0/16, 100.20.0.0/16) then
    set extcommunity rt (1:1) additive 
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy service-vrf-export-policy-v6
  if destination in (100:10::0/64, 100:20::0/64) then
    set extcommunity rt (1:1) additive 
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy pass-all
  pass
end-policy
!

router bgp 100
  neighbor 40.0.0.1
    remote-as 100
    address-family l2vpn evpn
      import stitching-rt re-originate
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
    !
  neighbor 60.0.0.1
    remote-as 200
    address-family vpnv4 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      route-policy pass-all in
      route-policy pass-all out
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
    address-family vpnv6 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      route-policy pass-all in
      route-policy pass-all out
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
Sample Router Configuration: with default-originate
The following sample configuration specifies how EVPN Service VRF Route Leaking feature is configured along with default-originate on a DCI router to provide data center hosts access to Services in the Service VRF..

vrf data-center-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import from vrf advertise-as-vpn
    import route-target
      1:1
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
    export route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy
    export to vrf allow-imported-vpn
    export route-target
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
  !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import from vrf advertise-as-vpn
    import route-target
      1:1
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
    export route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy-v6
    export to vrf allow-imported-vpn
    export route-target
      100:1
      200:1 stitching
  !

vrf service-vrf
  address-family ipv4 unicast
    import route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
    export route-policy service-vrf-export-policy
    export route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
   !
  address-family ipv6 unicast
    import route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
    export route-policy service-vrf-export-policy-v6
    export route-target
      3:1
      4:1 stitching
   !

route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy
  if destination in (200.47.0.0/16) then 
    set extcommunity rt (4:1) additive 
  if destination in (200.168.0.0/16) then 
    set extcommunity rt (3:1) additive 
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy data-center-vrf-export-policy-v6
  if destination in (200:47::0/64) then 
    set extcommunity rt (4:1) additive 
  elseif destination in (200:168::0/64) then 
    set extcommunity rt (3:1) additive 
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy service-vrf-export-policy
  if destination in (100.10.0.0/16, 100.20.0.0/16) then
    set extcommunity rt (1:1) additive 
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy service-vrf-export-policy-v6
  if destination in (100:10::0/64, 100:20::0/64) then
    set extcommunity rt (1:1) additive 
  endif
end-policy
!

route-policy pass-all
  pass
end-policy
!

router bgp 100
  neighbor 40.0.0.1
    remote-as 100
    address-family l2vpn evpn
      import stitching-rt re-originate
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated stitching-rt
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
      default-originate <= Added=>
    !
  neighbor 60.0.0.1
    remote-as 200
    address-family vpnv4 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      route-policy pass-all in
      route-policy pass-all out
      advertise vpnv4 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv4 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
      default-originate <= Added=>
    address-family vpnv6 unicast
      import re-originate stitching-rt
      route-policy pass-all in
      route-policy pass-all out
      advertise vpnv6 unicast re-originated
      advertise vpnv6 unicast imported-from-vrf disable
      default-originate <= Added=>

  vrf data-center-vrf
    rd auto
    address-family ipv4 unicast
      allow vpn default-originate <= Added=>
    !
    address-family ipv6 unicast
      allow vpn default-originate <= Added=>

User Defined Martian Check

The Cisco IOS XR Software Release 5.1.0 allows disabling the Martian check for these IP address prefixes:

  • IPv4 address prefixes

    • 0.0.0.0/8

    • 127.0.0.0/8

    • 224.0.0.0/4

  • IPv6 address prefixes

    • ::

    • ::0002 - ::ffff

    • ::ffff:a.b.c.d

    • fe80:xxxx

    • ffxx:xxxx

Resilient Per-CE Label Mode

The Resilient Per-CE Label is an extension of the Per-CE label mode to support Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC) and load balancing.

There are three label modes that are supported. They are:

  • Per-Prefix

    • Label consumption: Large number of labels are required for the MPLS forwarding table on core routers. You need to ensure that the VRF table size is within the MPLS label table limits.

    • Forwarding performance of ASR 9000 Provider Edge router on MPLS to IP path: Optimal. The MPLS label is directly associated with an output interface, hence packets are forwarded by a single pass through the NP microcode.

  • Per-VRF

    • Label consumption: Less labels are required for the MPLS forwarding table on core routers. This is because the Provider Edge router advertises one label per entire VRF.

    • Forwarding performance of ASR 9000 Provider Edge router on MPLS to IP path: Sub-optimal. Aggregate label requires two passes through the NP microcode: 1st pass for MPLS lookup, 2nd pass for IP lookup.

  • Per-CE

    • Label consumption: Only moderate number of labels are required. This is because the Provider Edge router only advertises one label per CE per VRF.

    • Forwarding performance of ASR 9000 Provider Edge router on MPLS to IP path: Optimal. The MPLS label is directly associated with an output interface, hence packets are forwarded by a single pass through the NP microcode.

At present, the three label modes, Per-Prefix, Per-CE, and Per-VRF have these restrictions:
  • No support for PIC

  • No support for load balancing across CEs

  • Temporary forwarding loop during local traffic diversion to support PIC

  • No support for EIBGP multipath load balancing

  • Forwarding performance impact

  • Per-prefix label mode causes scale issues on another vendor router in a network

In the Resilient Per-CE label scheme, BGP installs a unique rewrite label in LSD for every unique set of CE paths or next hops. There may be one or more prefixes in BGP table that points to this label. BGP also installs the CE paths (primary) and optionally a backup PE path into RIB. FIB learns about the label rewrite information from LSD and the IP paths from RIB.

In steady state, labeled traffic destined to the resilient per-CE label is load balanced across all the CE next hops. When all the CE paths fail, any traffic destined to that label will result in an IP lookup and will be forwarded towards the backup PE path, if available. This action is performed on the label independently of the number of prefixes that may point to the label, resulting in the PIC behavior during primary paths failure.

BGP Multipath Enhancements

  • Overwriting of next-hop calculation for multipath prefixes is not allowed. The next-hop-unchanged multipath command disables overwriting of next-hop calculation for multipath prefixes.

  • The ability to ignore as-path onwards while computing multipath is added. The bgp multipath as-path ignore onwards command ignores as-path onwards while computing multipath.

When multiple connected routers start ignoring as-path onwards while computing multipath, it causes routing loops. Therefore, you should not configure the bgp multipath as-path ignore onwards command on routers that can form a loop.

Figure 16. Topology to illustrate formation of loops

Consider three routers R1, R2 and R3 in different autonomous systems (AS-1, AS-2, and AS-3). The routers are connected with each other. R1 announces a prefix to R2 and R3. Both R2 and R3 are configured with multipath and also with bgp multipath as-path ignore onwards command. Since R3 is configured as multipath, R2 will send part of its traffic to R3. Similarly, R3 will send part of its traffic to R2. This creates a forwarding loop between R3 and R2. Therefore, to avoid such forwarding loops you should not configure the bgp multipath as-path ignore onwards command on connected routers.

MVPN with BGP SAFI-2 and SAFI-129

BGP supports Subsequent Address Family Identifier (SAFI)-2 and SAFI-129 for multicast VPNs (MVPNs).

SAFI-129 provides the capability to support multicast routing in the core IPv4 network. SAFI-129 supports BGP-based MVPNs. The addition of SAFI-129 allows multicast to select an upstream multicast hop that may be independent of the unicast topology. Multicast routes learned from the customer edge (CE) router or multicast VPN routes learned from remote provider edge (PE) routers are installed into the multicast Routing Information Base (MuRIB). This MuRIB will be populated with routes that are specific to multicast, and are not used by unicast forwarding. The PE-CE BGP prefixes are advertised using SAFI-2, the PE-PE routes are advertised using SAFI-129.

Overview of BGP Monitoring Protocol

The BGP Monitoring Protocol (BMP) feature enables monitoring of BGP speakers (called BMP clients). You can configure a device to function as a BMP server, which monitors either one or several BMP clients, which in turn, has several active peer sessions configured. You can also configure a BMP client to connect to one or more BMP servers. The BMP feature enables configuration of multiple BMP servers (configured as primary servers) to function actively and independent of each other, simultaneously to monitor BMP clients.

The BMP Protocol provides access to the Adjacent Routing Information Base, Incoming (Adj-RIB-In) table of a peer on an ongoing basis and a periodic dump of certain statistics that the monitoring station can use for further analysis. The BMP provides pre-policy view of the Adj-RIB-In table of a peer.

There can be several BMP servers configured globally across all the BGP instances. The BMP severs configured are common across multiple speaker instances and each BGP peer in an instance can be configured for monitoring by all or a subset of the BMP servers, giving a 'any-to-any' map between BGP peers and BMP servers from the point of view of a BGP speaker. If a BMP server is configured before any of the BGP peers come up, then the monitoring will start as soon as the BGP peers come up. A BMP server configuration can be removed only when there are no BGP peers configured to be monitored by that particular BMP server.

Sessions between BMP clients and BMP servers operate over plain TCP (no encryption/encapsulation). If a TCP session with the BMP server is not established, the client retries to connect every 7 seconds.

The BMP server does not send any messages to its clients (BGP speakers). The message flow is in one direction only—from BGP speakers to the BMP servers

A maximum of eight BMP servers can be configured on the Cisco NCS 5500 Series Routers. Each BMP server is specified by a server ID and certain parameters such as IP address, port number, etc are configurable. Upon successful configuration of a BMP server with host and port details, the BGP speaker attempts to connect to BMP Server. Once the TCP connection is setup, an Initiation message is sent as first message.

The bmp server command enables the user to configure multiple—independent and asynchronous—BMP server connections.

All neighbors for a BGP speaker need not necessarily be BMP clients. BMP clients are the ones that have direct TCP connection with a BMP server. Each of these BGP speakers can have many BGP neighbors or peers. Under a BGP speaker, if any of its neighbors are configured for BMP monitoring, only that particular peer router's messages are sent to BMP servers.

The session connection to BMP server is attempted after an initial-delay at the BMP client. This initial-delay can be configured. If the initial-delay is not configured, then the default connection delay of 7 seconds is used. Configuring the initial delay becomes significant under certain circumstances where, if multiple BMP servers' states toggle closely and refresh delay is so small, then this might result in redundant route-refreshes being generated. This causes considerable network traffic and load on the device. Having different initial delays can reduce the load spike on the network and router.

After the initial delay, TCP connection to BMP servers are attempted. Once the server connections are up, it is checked if there are any peers enabled for monitoring. Once a BGP peer that is already being monitored is in the “ESTAB” state, speaker sends a “peer-up” message for that peer to the BMP server. After the BGP peer receives a route-refresh request, neighbor sends the updates. This route refresh is initiated based on a delay configured for each BMP server. This is called route refresh delay. When there are multiple neighbors to be monitored, each neighbor is set a refresh delay based upon the BMP server they are enabled for. Once all the BGP neighbors have sent the updates in response to the refresh requests, the tables will be up to date in the BMP Server. If a neighbor establishes connection after BMP monitoring has begun, it does not require a route-refresh request. All received routes from that neighbor is sent to BMP servers.


Note


In the case of BMP Pre Inbound Policy Route monitoring, when a new BMP server comes up, route refresh requests are sent to the peer router by the BGP speaker. However, in the case of BMP Post Inbound Policy Route Monitoring route refresh request are not sent to the peer routers when the new BMP server comes up because the BMP table is used for update generation.


It is advantageous to batch up refresh requests to BGP peers, if several BMP servers are activated in quick succession. Use the bmp server initial-refresh-delay command to configure a delay in triggering the refresh mechanism when the first BMP server comes up. If other BMP servers come online within this time-frame, only one set of refresh requests is sent to the BGP peers. You can also configure the bmp server initial-refresh-delay skip command to skip all refresh requests from BGP speakers and just monitor all incoming messages from the peers.

In a client-server configuration, it is recommended that the resource load of the devices be kept minimal and adding excessive network traffic must be avoided. In the BMP configuration, you can configure various delay timers on the BMP server to avoid flapping during connection between the server and client.

Recent Prefixes Events and Trace Support

The Recent Prefixes Events and Trace Support feature enables you to obtain per prefix level churning information without the use of debug commands. The show commands associated with this feature provide you a recent history of major events at the prefix level. They display the last eight events for the last 100 churning number of prefixes across an address family.

The following address families support this feature:

  • IPv4 Unicast

  • IPv6 Unicast

  • IPv4 Multicast

  • IPv6 Multicast

  • VPNv4 Unicast

  • VPNv6 Unicast

  • BGP Link-State

  • L2VPN EVPN

  • IPv4 FlowSpec

Retrictions

The following restrictions apply to recent prefixes only. They do not apply to trace support.

  • You can only track remote prefixes and path updates. You cannot track internal event trigger or local prefixes updates.

  • You cannot track the events when the neighbor session goes down

Verification

Use the following command to check the events for a specific prefix.

Router# show bgp ipv4 unicast recent-prefixes 192.168.112.0/24 priv$

P/0/RP0/CPU0:root# 
Tue Jan 21 10:30:44.488 UTC

Address-Family: IPv4 Unicast Route-Distinguisher: 0:0:0
192.168.112.0/24
Event History [Total events: 8]
-------------------------------------
Time                 Event     Context1  Context2  Context3
====                 =====     =====     =====     =====
Dec 19 16:39:53.329  Withdraw  0x3010101  0x0     0x4000000000020004
Dec 19 16:39:53.330  Create    0x3010101  0x0     0x4000000000020005
Dec 19 16:39:53.330  Modify    0x3010101  0x0     0x4000000000020005
Dec 19 16:40:42.717  Create    0x3010101  0x0     0x4000000000020005
Dec 19 18:16:33.318  Create    0x3010101  0x0     0x4000000000020005
Jan 2 13:36:18.595  Modify     0x3010101  0x0     0x4000000000020005
Jan 2 15:16:00.344  Duplicate  0x3010101  0x0     0x4000000000020005
Jan 14 15:56:28.561 Duplicate 0x3010101   0x0     0x4000000000020005
-------------------------------------

Verify the route distinguishers and corresponding prefix.

Router# show bgp l2vpn recent-prefixes
 
Address-Family     Route-Distinguisher         Prefix
==============     ===================         ==============
L2VPN EVPN         0:0:0 [5][0][32]           [198.51.100.22]/24
L2VPN EVPN         10.5.0.1:100 [5][0][32]    [192.0.2.1]/24
L2VPN EVPN         10.5.0.1:100 [5][0][32]    [192.0.2.2]/24
L2VPN EVPN         10.5.0.1:100 [5][0][32]    [192.0.2.3]/24
L2VPN EVPN         10.5.0.1:100 [5][0][32]    [192.0.2.4]/24

Verify recently updated or deleted prefixes.

Router# show bgp ipv4 unicast recent-prefixes 
 
Address-Family   Route-Distinguisher Prefix
================ =================== ==============
IPv4 Unicast     0:0:0               10.1.1.1/32
IPv4 Unicast     0:0:0               10.1.1.101/32
IPv4 Unicast     0:0:0               10.1.1.100/32
IPv4 Unicast     0:0:0               10.1.1.99/32
IPv4 Unicast     0:0:0               10.1.1.98/32
IPv4 Unicast     0:0:0               10.1.1.93/32

Verify recently updated or deleted prefixes with timestamps and related contexts.

Router# show bgp ipv4 unicast recent-prefixes private
 
Address-Family: IPv4 Unicast Route-Distinguisher: 0:0:0
10.1.1.10/32
Event History [Total events: 4]
-------------------------------------
Time                Event     Context1    Context2  Context3
====                =====    =====       =====     =====
Jul 24 17:03:58.357 Create   0x13000001  0x0       0x4000000000000007
Jul 24 17:04:12.365 Withdraw 0x13000001  0x0       0x4000000001040006
Jul 24 17:04:31.625 Create   0x13000001  0x0       0x4000000000000007
Jul 24 17:04:39.880 Duplicate 0x13000001 0x0       0x4000000000000007

Verify recent history of major events in the link-state database of a network advertised through BGP.

Router# show bgp link-state link-state recent-prefixes
 
Address-Family: Link-state Link-state Route-Distinguisher: 0:0:0
[E][B][I0x0][N[c1][b19.0.0.1][q19.0.0.1]][R[c200][q19.0.0.2]][L[i26.0.101.100][n29.0.1.30]]/600
Event History [Total events: 4]
-------------------------------------
Time Event Context1 Context2 Context3
==== ===== ===== ===== =====
Aug 1 15:45:25.171 Create 0x13000001 0x0 0x4000000000020005

Reasons for not Advertising BGP Prefix to a Peer

The following are the categories of reasons for which a BGP prefix may not be advertised to a peer or a set of peers. The exact reason for which the BGP prefix is not advertised is displayed in the output of the show bgp ipv4 unicast update-group performance-statistics command.

  • Path element not applicable

  • Path not available

  • Block stitching route targer (RT) constraint

  • Block RT constraint network layer reachability information (NLRI)

  • Imported path to non-customer edge (CE) neighbor

  • VPN only path to CE neighbor

  • External peer with no export

  • Encapsulation mismatch (VxLAN)

  • Sender Autonomous System (AS)

  • Non-client to non-client

  • Cluster identifier not set

  • Client to non-client for cluster

  • No PIM feedback for eBGP neighbor

  • No PIM feedback

  • PIM withdraw Feedback

  • Wait for PIM feedback

  • Prefix-based outbound route filter (ORF)

  • RT type mismatch

  • No out-policy for eBGP neighbor

  • Out-policy

  • Nexthop and label select fail

  • V6 nexthop for V4 NLRI non-extended encoding capable

  • No label

  • Net suppressed

  • No second label

  • Dropped by RT filter

  • Dropped by MVPN neighbor filter

  • Oversized

  • Split horizon update

Verification

The below example shows how to display performance statisticsfor a unadvertized prefix without enabling debug commands and checking the logs.

BGP prefix may not be advertized to a peer or a set of peers. The below example shows how to display the total numbers of prefixes not advertising in any AFI or SAFI, including repeating counts on 1 or more prefixes

Router# show bgp update-group performance-statistics

Update group for IPv4 Unicast, index 0.1:
..
Update timer last processed: Sep 23 00:10:15.350
  Not-Advertised Stats:
    Non-Client to Non-Client       : 105        Sep 23 00:10:15.350
    Path Not Available	      : 132        Sep 23 00:10:15.350

BGP Slow Peer Automatic Isolation from Update Group

Table 8. Feature History Table

Feature Name

Release Information

Feature Description

BGP Slow Peer Automatic Isolation from Update Group

Release 7.3.1

A slow peer cannot keep up with the rate at which the router generates BGP update messages over a period of time, in an update group. This feature automatically detects a slow peer in an update group and moves it to a new update group. The feature is enabled on the router, by default.

New commands introduced in this release:

  • slow-peer detection enable

  • clear bgp slow-peers

Updated commands in this release:

  • slow-peer detection disable

Table 9. Feature History Table

Feature Name

Release Information

Feature Description

BGP Slow Peer Automatic Isolation from Update Group

Release 7.3.1

A slow peer cannot keep up with the rate at which the router generates BGP update messages over a period of time, in an update group. This feature automatically detects a slow peer in an update group and moves it to a new update group. The feature is enabled on the router, by default.

New commands introduced in this release:

  • slow-peer detection enable

  • clear bgp slow-peers

Updated commands in this release:

  • slow-peer detection disable

The BGP Slow Peer Automatic Isolation from Update Group feature enables you to detect a slow peer in an update group and moving it to its own update group.

When a peer is slow in an BGP update group it cannot keep up with the rate at which update messages are generated over a prolonged time causing formatted messages to build up. The rest of the members of the group that are faster than the slow peer and have completed transmission of the formatted messages will not have anything new to send even though there may be newly modified BGP nets waiting to be advertised or withdrawn.

This feature enables you to detect a slow peer in an update group and moves it to its own update group. This feature is enabled by default.

When a slow peer is detected it is automatically moved to a new update group. Hence if there are slow peers then there will be an update group containing one or more slow peers corresponding to the original update group. There will be only one update group containing slow peers corresponding to the original update group. Hence, if multiple peers are slow, they will be in different sub-groups within the new slow update group. On recovery of the slow peer the peer is moved back to the original update group.

The presence of a slow peer in an update group, increases the number of formatted updates that are pending transmission. Events causing large churn in the BGP table, such as connection resets can result in a short-lived spike in the rate of update generation. A peer that temporarily falls behind during such events but quickly recovers after the event is not considered a slow peer.

This feature enables moving all the slow peers out of their original group, and into a new group dedicated to slow peers. After the slow peers are moved out, the non-slow members in the original group progress at their regular pace and catch up with the BGP table changes. The slow members consume updates at the slower pace and lag in their new dedicated group. One group for slow peers is required for each original group containing a slow peer. It is not possible to group together slow peers from different original groups as they will have a different outbound policy configuration.

Both the feature and splitting of update groups is enabled by default.

Configuration Examples

Detect Dynamic Slow Peers at the Global Configuration Level

Perform the following steps to disable slow peer detection globally and override all configuration under the neighbor. Any slow peers that are detected are marked as normal peers. They are moved back to their original update groups. No more slow peers are detected.

Router# configure
Router(config)# slow-peer-detection disable

Manually Configure Static Slow Peers at the Neighbor Configuration Level

Perform the following steps to control the behavior of the slow-peer detection and mitigation at neighbor configuration level. The configuration manually marks a neighbor as slow peer. Also, the peer will be part of slow update group.


Router(config)# router bgp 5
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4
Router(config-bgp-af)# neighbor 172.60.2.3
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# slow-peer detection disable split-updategroup static

Configure Dynamic Slow Peers at the Neighbor Configuration Level

Use the split-update-group dynamic command to dynamically detect the slow peer and move it to a slow update group.


Note


When the split-update-group dynamic command alone is configured, the dynamically detected slow peer is moved to a slow update group. If there already exists a slow peer update group, the dynamic slow peer is moved to slow peer update group, otherwise a new slow peer update group is created and the peer is moved to the new slow peer update group. This option is enabled by default.



Note


If the permanent keyword is not configured, the slow peer is moved to its regular original update group, after it becomes regular peer. If the permanent keyword is configured, the peer will not be moved to its original update group automatically. The administrator can use clear command to move it to original update group. Use this option if a peer keeps becoming a slow peer and recovering.


Router(config)# router bgp 5
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4
Router(config-bgp-af)# neighbor 172.60.2.3
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# slow-peer detection enable split-update-group
dynamic permanent

Clear Dynamically Detected Slow Peers

Perform the following task to clears all slow peers part of a specific address family identifiers (AFI) or subsequent address family identifiers (SAFI):

Router# clear bgp slow-peers <afi> <safi>

Perform the following task to clear all slow peers for all AFI or SAFI of the neighbor:

Router# clear bgp slow-peers <neighbor-address> 

Perform the following task to clear the specified combination:

Router# clear bgp slow-peers <afi> <safi> <neighbor-address>

Running Configuration

This section shows the BGP Slow Peer Automatic Isolation from Update Group running configuration.


slow-peer-detection disable
router bgp 5
address-family ipv4
 neighbor 172.60.2.3
 slow-peer detection disable split-update-group static
router bgp 5
address-family ipv4
 neighbor 172.60.2.3
 slow-peer detection enable split-update-group dynamic permanent

Verification

Router# show bgp vrf <vrf-name> <afi> <safi> update out neighbor slowpeers <brief>
<SME to provide show output.>
Router# show bgp all all update out neighbor slow-peers
Fri Sep 13 13:57:48.503 PDT
Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
----------------------------
+++++++++++++++++++AFTER 5 MINUTES ++++++++++++++++++++++
Router# show bgp all all update out neighbor slow-peers
Fri Sep 13 14:02:23.097 PDT
Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
----------------------------
VRF "default", Address-family "IPv4 Unicast"
Main routing table version: 3329832
RIB version: 3329832
Neighbor 11.11.11.21
Filter-group 0.3, Refresh filter-group ---
Sub-group 0.2, Refresh sub-group ---
Update-group 0.3
Update OutQ: 20447800 bytes (7680 messages) Refresh
update OutQ: 0 bytes (0 messages) Filter-group pending:
7680 messages

How to Implement BGP

Enabling BGP Routing

Perform this task to enable BGP routing and establish a BGP routing process. Configuring BGP neighbors is included as part of enabling BGP routing.


Note


At least one neighbor and at least one address family must be configured to enable BGP routing. At least one neighbor with both a remote AS and an address family must be configured globally using the address family and remote as commands.


Before you begin

BGP must be able to obtain a router identifier (for example, a configured loopback address). At least, one address family must be configured in the BGP router configuration and the same address family must also be configured under the neighbor.


Note


If the neighbor is configured as an external BGP (eBGP) peer, you must configure an inbound and outbound route policy on the neighbor using the route-policy command.



Note


Instead of configuring an inbound and outbound route policy, you can configure the unsafe eBGP policy to allow all eBGP neighbors to pass routes using the bgp unsafe-ebgp-policy command.



Note


While establishing eBGP neighborship between two peers, BGP checks if the two peers are directly connected. If the peers are not directly connected, BGP does not try to establish a relationship by default. If two BGP peers are not directly connected and peering is required between the loop backs of the routers, you can use the ignore-connected-check command. This command overrides the default check that BGP performs which is to verify if source IP in BGP control packets is in same network as that of destination. In this scenario, a TTL value of 1 is sufficient if ignore-connected-check is used.

Configuring egp-multihop ttl is needed when the peers are not directly connected and there are more routers in between. If the egp-multihop ttl command is not configured, eBGP sets the TTL of packets carrying BGP messages to 1 by default. When eBGP needs to be setup between routers which are more than one hop away, you need to configure a TTL value which is at least equal to the number of hops between them. For example, if there are 2 hops (R2, R3) between two BGP peering routers R1 and R4, you need to set a TTL value of 3.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. route-policy route-policy-name
  3. end-policy
  4. Use the commit or end command.
  5. configure
  6. router bgp as-number
  7. bgp router-id ip-address
  8. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  9. exit
  10. neighbor ip-address
  11. remote-as as-number
  12. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  13. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out }
  14. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

route-policy route-policy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy drop-as-1234
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if as-path passes-through '1234' then
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# apply check-communities
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# else
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# pass
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# endif
  

(Optional) Creates a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode, where you can define the route policy.

Step 3

end-policy

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

(Optional) Ends the definition of a route policy and exits route policy configuration mode.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 5

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 6

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 7

bgp router-id ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp router-id 192.168.70.24

Configures the local router with a specified router ID.

Step 8

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 9

exit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit

Exits the current configuration mode.

Step 10

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 11

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 12

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 13

route-policy route-policy-name { in | out }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy drop-as-1234 in

(Optional) Applies the specified policy to inbound IPv4 unicast routes.

Step 14

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring Multiple BGP Instances for a Specific Autonomous System

Perform this task to configure multiple BGP instances for a specific autonomous system.

All configuration changes for a single BGP instance can be committed together. However, configuration changes for multiple instances cannot be committed together.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number [instance instance name ]
  3. bgp router-id ip-address
  4. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number [instance instance name ]

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100 instance inst1

Enters BGP configuration mode for the user specified BGP instance.

Step 3

bgp router-id ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp router-id 10.0.0.0

Configures a fixed router ID for the BGP-speaking router (BGP instance).

Note

 

You must manually configure unique router ID for each BGP instance.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring a Routing Domain Confederation for BGP

Perform this task to configure the routing domain confederation for BGP. This includes specifying a confederation identifier and autonomous systems that belong to the confederation.

Configuring a routing domain confederation reduces the internal BGP (iBGP) mesh by dividing an autonomous system into multiple autonomous systems and grouping them into a single confederation. Each autonomous system is fully meshed within itself and has a few connections to another autonomous system in the same confederation. The confederation maintains the next hop and local preference information, and that allows you to retain a single Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) for all autonomous systems. To the outside world, the confederation looks like a single autonomous system.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. bgp confederation identifier as-number
  4. bgp confederation peers as-number
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

bgp confederation identifier as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation identifier 5

Specifies a BGP confederation identifier.

Step 4

bgp confederation peers as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1091
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1092
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1093
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1094
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1095
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp confederation peers 1096
  

Specifies that the BGP autonomous systems belong to a specified BGP confederation identifier. You can associate multiple AS numbers to the same confederation identifier, as shown in the example.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Resetting an eBGP Session Immediately Upon Link Failure

By default, if a link goes down, all BGP sessions of any directly adjacent external peers are immediately reset. Use the bgp fast-external-fallover disable command to disable automatic resetting. Turn the automatic reset back on using the no bgp fast-external-fallover disable command.

eBGP sessions flap when the node reaches 3500 eBGP sessions with BGP timer values set as 10 and 30. To support more than 3500 eBGP sessions, increase the packet rate by using the lpts pifib hardware police location location-id command. Following is a sample configuration to increase the eBGP sessions:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#configure 
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#lpts pifib hardware police location 0/2/CPU0
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pifib-policer-per-node)#flow bgp configured rate 4000
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pifib-policer-per-node)#flow bgp known rate 4000
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pifib-policer-per-node)#flow bgp default rate 4000
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pifib-policer-per-node)#commit

Logging Neighbor Changes

Logging neighbor changes is enabled by default. Use the log neighbor changes disable command to turn off logging. The no log neighbor changes disable command can also be used to turn logging back on if it has been disabled.

Adjusting BGP Timers

Perform this task to set the timers for BGP neighbors.

BGP uses certain timers to control periodic activities, such as the sending of keepalive messages and the interval after which a neighbor is assumed to be down if no messages are received from the neighbor during the interval. The values set using the timers bgp command in router configuration mode can be overridden on particular neighbors using the timers command in the neighbor configuration mode.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. timers bgp keepalive hold-time
  4. neighbor ip-address
  5. timers keepalive hold-time
  6. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 123

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

timers bgp keepalive hold-time

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# timers bgp 30 90

Sets a default keepalive time and a default hold time for all neighbors.

Step 4

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 5

timers keepalive hold-time

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# timers 60 220

(Optional) Sets the keepalive timer and the hold-time timer for the BGP neighbor.

Step 6

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Changing the BGP Default Local Preference Value

Perform this task to set the default local preference value for BGP paths.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. bgp default local-preference value
  4. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

bgp default local-preference value

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp default local-preference 200

Sets the default local preference value from the default of 100, making it either a more preferable path (over 100) or less preferable path (under 100).

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring the MED Metric for BGP

Perform this task to set the multi exit discriminator (MED) to advertise to peers for routes that do not already have a metric set (routes that were received with no MED attribute).

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. default-metric value
  4. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

default-metric value

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# default metric 10

Sets the default metric, which is used to set the MED to advertise to peers for routes that do not already have a metric set (routes that were received with no MED attribute).

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring BGP Weights

Perform this task to assign a weight to routes received from a neighbor. A weight is a number that you can assign to a path so that you can control the best-path selection process. If you have particular neighbors that you want to prefer for most of your traffic, you can use the weight command to assign a higher weight to all routes learned from that neighbor.

Before you begin


Note


The clear bgp command must be used for the newly configured weight to take effect.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  6. weight weight-value
  7. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 5

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 6

weight weight-value

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# weight 41150

Assigns a weight to all routes learned through the neighbor.

Step 7

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Tuning the BGP Best-Path Calculation

Perform this task to change the default BGP best-path calculation behavior.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. bgp bestpath med missing-as-worst
  4. bgp bestpath med always
  5. bgp bestpath med confed
  6. bgp bestpath as-path ignore
  7. bgp bestpath compare-routerid
  8. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 126

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

bgp bestpath med missing-as-worst

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath med missing-as-worst

Directs the BGP software to consider a missing MED attribute in a path as having a value of infinity, making this path the least desirable path.

Step 4

bgp bestpath med always

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath med always

Configures the BGP speaker in the specified autonomous system to compare MEDs among all the paths for the prefix, regardless of the autonomous system from which the paths are received.

Step 5

bgp bestpath med confed

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath med confed

Enables BGP software to compare MED values for paths learned from confederation peers.

Step 6

bgp bestpath as-path ignore

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath as-path ignore

Configures the BGP software to ignore the autonomous system length when performing best-path selection.

Step 7

bgp bestpath compare-routerid

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp bestpath compare-routerid

Configure the BGP speaker in the autonomous system to compare the router IDs of similar paths.

Step 8

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Indicating BGP Back-door Routes

Perform this task to set the administrative distance on an external Border Gateway Protocol (eBGP) route to that of a locally sourced BGP route, causing it to be less preferred than an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) route.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. network { ip-address / prefix-length | ip-address mask } backdoor
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

network { ip-address / prefix-length | ip-address mask } backdoor

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# network 172.20.0.0/16 

Configures the local router to originate and advertise the specified network.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring Aggregate Addresses

Perform this task to create aggregate entries in a BGP routing table.


Note


For optimal CPU utilization when deploying BGP aggregate for supernet addresses with a higher scale such as internet bgp table, it is recommended to:

  • Use aggregate subnet of size not exceeding /24.

  • Tune the subnet mask size based on network scale and churn.

  • Use the default-originate or network 0.0.0.0 CLI instead of 0.0.0.0 as aggregate, when advertising the default route 0.0.0.0.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. aggregate-address address/mask-length [ as-set ] [ as-confed-set ] [ summary-only ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

aggregate-address address/mask-length [ as-set ] [ as-confed-set ] [ summary-only ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# aggregate-address 10.0.0.0/8 as-set

Creates an aggregate address. The path advertised for this route is an autonomous system set consisting of all elements contained in all paths that are being summarized.

  • The as-set keyword generates autonomous system set path information and community information from contributing paths.

  • The as-confed-set keyword generates autonomous system confederation set path information from contributing paths.

  • The summary-only keyword filters all more specific routes from updates.

  • The route-policy route-policy-name keyword and argument specify the route policy used to set the attributes of the aggregate route.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Redistributing iBGP Routes into IGP

Perform this task to redistribute iBGP routes into an Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP), such as Intermediate System-to-Intermediate System (IS-IS) or Open Shortest Path First (OSPF).


Note


Use of the bgp redistribute-internal command requires the clear route * command to be issued to reinstall all BGP routes into the IP routing table.



Caution


Redistributing iBGP routes into IGPs may cause routing loops to form within an autonomous system. Use this command with caution.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. bgp redistribute-internal
  4. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

bgp redistribute-internal

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp redistribute-internal

Allows the redistribution of iBGP routes into an IGP, such as IS-IS or OSPF.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring Discard Extra Paths

Perform this task to configure BGP maximum-prefix discard extra paths.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  5. maximum-prefix maximum discard-extra-paths
  6. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters Global Configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 10 

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.1 

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast 

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 5

maximum-prefix maximum discard-extra-paths

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# maximum-prefix 1000 discard-extra-paths 

Configures a limit to the number of prefixes allowed.

Configures discard extra paths to discard extra paths when the maximum prefix limit is exceeded.

Step 6

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring Per Neighbor TCP MSS

Perform this task to configure TCP MSS under neighbor group, which is inherited by a neighbor.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family ipv4 unicast
  4. exit
  5. neighbor-group name
  6. tcp mss segment-size
  7. address-family ipv4 unicast
  8. exit
  9. exit
  10. neighbor ip-address
  11. remote-as as-number
  12. use neighbor-group group-name
  13. address-family ipv4 unicast
  14. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters Global Configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 10 

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family ipv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast 

Specifies the IPv4 address family unicast and enters address family configuration mode.

Step 4

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit 

Exits router address family configuration mode, and returns to BGP configuration mode.

Step 5

neighbor-group name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group n1

Enters neighbor group configuration mode.

Step 6

tcp mss segment-size

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# tcp mss 500

Configures TCP maximum segment size. The range is from 68 to 10000.

Step 7

address-family ipv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast 

Specifies the IPv4 address family unicast and enters address family configuration mode.

Step 8

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit 

Exits router address family configuration mode.

Step 9

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit 

Exits the neighbor group configuration mode.

Step 10

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.2

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 11

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system (AS) number to it.

  • Range for 2-byte autonomous system numbers (ASNs) is 1 to 65535.

  • Range for 4-byte autonomous system numbers (ASNs) in asplain format is 1 to 4294967295.

  • Range for 4-byte autonomous system numbers (ASNs) is asdot format is 1.0 to 65535.65535.

Step 12

use neighbor-group group-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group n1

Specifies that the BGP neighbor inherit configuration from the specified neighbor group.

Step 13

address-family ipv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast 
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# 

Specifies the IPv4 address family unicast and enters address family configuration mode.

Step 14

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Disabling Per Neighbor TCP MSS

Perform this task to disable TCP MSS for a particular neighbor under neighbor group.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family ipv4 unicast
  4. exit
  5. neighbor-group name
  6. tcp mss segment-size
  7. address-family ipv4 unicast
  8. exit
  9. exit
  10. neighbor ip-address
  11. remote-as as-number
  12. use neighbor-group group-name
  13. tcp mss inheritance-disable
  14. address-family ipv4 unicast
  15. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters Global Configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 10 

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family ipv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast 

Specifies the IPv4 address family unicast and enters address family configuration mode.

Step 4

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit 

Exits router address family configuration mode, and returns to BGP configuration mode.

Step 5

neighbor-group name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group n1

Enters neighbor group configuration mode.

Step 6

tcp mss segment-size

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# tcp mss 500

Configures TCP maximum segment size. The range is from 68 to 10000.

Step 7

address-family ipv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast 

Specifies the IPv4 address family unicast and enters address family configuration mode.

Step 8

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit 

Exits router address family configuration mode.

Step 9

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit 

Exits the neighbor group configuration mode.

Step 10

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.2

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 11

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system (AS) number to it.

  • Range for 2-byte autonomous system numbers (ASNs) is 1 to 65535.

  • Range for 4-byte autonomous system numbers (ASNs) in asplain format is 1 to 4294967295.

  • Range for 4-byte autonomous system numbers (ASNs) is asdot format is 1.0 to 65535.65535.

Step 12

use neighbor-group group-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group n1

Specifies that the BGP neighbor inherit configuration from the specified neighbor group.

Step 13

tcp mss inheritance-disable

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# tcp mss inheritance-disable

Disables TCP MSS for the neighbor.

Step 14

address-family ipv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast 
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# 

Specifies the IPv4 address family unicast and enters address family configuration mode.

Step 15

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Redistributing Prefixes into Multiprotocol BGP

Perform this task to redistribute prefixes from another protocol into multiprotocol BGP.

Redistribution is the process of injecting prefixes from one routing protocol into another routing protocol. This task shows how to inject prefixes from another routing protocol into multiprotocol BGP. Specifically, prefixes that are redistributed into multiprotocol BGP using the redistribute command are injected into the unicast database, the multicast database, or both.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. Do one of the following:
    • redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]]} [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]]} [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

Do one of the following:

  • redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]]} [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]]} [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# redistribute ospf 110

Causes routes from the specified instance to be redistributed into BGP.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring BGP Route Dampening

Perform this task to configure and monitor BGP route dampening.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. bgp dampening [ half-life [ reuse suppress max-suppress-time ] | route-policy route-policy-name ]
  5. Use the commit or end command.
  6. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics
  7. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics regexp regular-expression
  8. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] route-policy route-policy-name
  9. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] { mask | /prefix-length }}
  10. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics { ip-address [{ mask | /prefix-length } [ longer-prefixes
  11. clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics
  12. clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics regexp regular-expression
  13. clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] route-policy route-policy-name
  14. clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics network / mask-length
  15. clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics ip-address / mask-length
  16. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] dampened-paths
  17. clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] dampening ip-address / mask-length

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

bgp dampening [ half-life [ reuse suppress max-suppress-time ] | route-policy route-policy-name ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# bgp dampening 30 1500 10000 120

Configures BGP dampening for the specified address family.

  • half-life —(Optional) Time (in minutes) after which a penalty is decreased. Once the route has been assigned a penalty, the penalty is decreased by half after the half-life period (which is 15 minutes by default). Penalty reduction happens every 5 seconds. Range of the half-life period is from 1 to 45 minutes.

  • reuse —(Optional) Value for route reuse if the flapping route penalty decreases and falls below the reuse value. When this happens, the route is unsuppressed. The process of unsuppressing routes occurs at 10-second increments. Range is 1 to 20000.

  • suppress —(Optional) Maximum penalty value. Suppress a route when its penalty exceeds the value specified. When this happens, the route is suppressed. Range is 1 to 20000.

  • max-suppress-time —(Optional) Maximum time (in minutes) a route can be suppressed. Range is 1 to 255. If the half-life value is allowed to default, the maximum suppress time defaults to 60 minutes.

  • route-policy route-policy-name —(Optional) Specifies the route policy to use to set dampening parameters.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 6

show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp flap statistics

Displays BGP flap statistics.

Step 7

show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics regexp regular-expression

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp flap-statistics regexp _1$

Displays BGP flap statistics for all paths that match the regular expression.

Step 8

show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] route-policy route-policy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# show bgp flap-statistics route-policy policy_A

Displays BGP flap statistics for the specified route policy.

Step 9

show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] { mask | /prefix-length }}

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp flap-statistics 172.20.1.1

Displays BGP flap for the specified prefix.

Step 10

show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics { ip-address [{ mask | /prefix-length } [ longer-prefixes

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp flap-statistics 172.20.1.1 longer-prefixes

Displays BGP flap statistics for more specific entries for the specified IP address.

Step 11

clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp all all flap-statistics 

Clears BGP flap statistics for all routes.

Step 12

clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics regexp regular-expression

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast flap-statistics regexp _1$

Clears BGP flap statistics for all paths that match the specified regular expression.

Step 13

clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] route-policy route-policy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast flap-statistics route-policy policy_A

Clears BGP flap statistics for the specified route policy.

Step 14

clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics network / mask-length

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast flap-statistics 192.168.40.0/24

Clears BGP flap statistics for the specified network.

Step 15

clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] flap-statistics ip-address / mask-length

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast flap-statistics 172.20.1.1

Clears BGP flap statistics for routes received from the specified neighbor.

Step 16

show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] dampened-paths

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp dampened-paths

Displays the dampened routes, including the time remaining before they are unsuppressed.

Step 17

clear bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | labeled-unicast | all } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | labeled-unicast } | vpnv4 unicast [ rd rd-address ] | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 { unicast | labeled-unicast } | ipv6 unicast ]] dampening ip-address / mask-length

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp dampening

Clears route dampening information and unsuppresses the suppressed routes.

Caution

 

Always use the clear bgp dampening command for an individual address-family. The all option for address-families with clear bgp dampening should never be used during normal functioning of the system. For example, use clear bgp ipv4 unicast dampening prefix x.x.x./y

Applying Policy When Updating the Routing Table

Perform this task to apply a routing policy to routes being installed into the routing table.

Before you begin

See the Implementing Routing Policy on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Routing Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers (this publication) for a list of the supported attributes and operations that are valid for table policy filtering.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. table-policy policy-name
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120.6

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

table-policy policy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# table-policy tbl-plcy-A

Applies the specified policy to routes being installed into the routing table.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Setting BGP Administrative Distance

Perform this task to specify the use of administrative distances that can be used to prefer one class of route over another.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. distance bgp external-distance internal-distance local-distance
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

distance bgp external-distance internal-distance local-distance

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# distance bgp 20 20 200

Sets the external, internal, and local administrative distances to prefer one class of routes over another. The higher the value, the lower the trust rating.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring a BGP Neighbor Group and Neighbors

Perform this task to configure BGP neighbor groups and apply the neighbor group configuration to a neighbor. A neighbor group is a template that holds address family-independent and address family-dependent configurations associated with the neighbor.

After a neighbor group is configured, each neighbor can inherit the configuration through the use command. If a neighbor is configured to use a neighbor group, the neighbor (by default) inherits the entire configuration of the neighbor group, which includes the address family-independent and address family-dependent configurations. The inherited configuration can be overridden if you directly configure commands for the neighbor or configure session groups or address family groups through the use command.

You can configure an address family-independent configuration under the neighbor group. An address family-dependent configuration requires you to configure the address family under the neighbor group to enter address family submode.

From neighbor group configuration mode, you can configure address family-independent parameters for the neighbor group. Use the address-family command when in the neighbor group configuration mode.

After specifying the neighbor group name using the neighbor group command, you can assign options to the neighbor group.


Note


All commands that can be configured under a specified neighbor group can be configured under a neighbor.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. exit
  5. neighbor-group name
  6. remote-as as-number
  7. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  8. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out }
  9. exit
  10. exit
  11. neighbor ip-address
  12. use neighbor-group group-name
  13. remote-as as-number
  14. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

exit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit

Exits the current configuration mode.

Step 5

neighbor-group name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group nbr-grp-A

Places the router in neighbor group configuration mode.

Step 6

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# remote-as 2002

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 7

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 8

route-policy route-policy-name { in | out }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# route-policy drop-as-1234 in

(Optional) Applies the specified policy to inbound IPv4 unicast routes.

Step 9

exit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp-af)# exit

Exits the current configuration mode.

Step 10

exit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# exit

Exits the current configuration mode.

Step 11

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 12

use neighbor-group group-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# use neighbor-group nbr-grp-A

(Optional) Specifies that the BGP neighbor inherit configuration from the specified neighbor group.

Step 13

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 14

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring a Route Reflector for BGP

Perform this task to configure a route reflector for BGP.

All the neighbors configured with the route-reflector-clientcommand are members of the client group, and the remaining iBGP peers are members of the nonclient group for the local route reflector.

Together, a route reflector and its clients form a cluster. A cluster of clients usually has a single route reflector. In such instances, the cluster is identified by the software as the router ID of the route reflector. To increase redundancy and avoid a single point of failure in the network, a cluster can have more than one route reflector. If it does, all route reflectors in the cluster must be configured with the same 4-byte cluster ID so that a route reflector can recognize updates from route reflectors in the same cluster. The bgp cluster-id command is used to configure the cluster ID when the cluster has more than one route reflector.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. bgp cluster-id cluster-id
  4. neighbor ip-address
  5. remote-as as-number
  6. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  7. route-reflector-client
  8. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

bgp cluster-id cluster-id

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp cluster-id 192.168.70.1

Configures the local router as one of the route reflectors serving the cluster. It is configured with a specified cluster ID to identify the cluster.

Step 4

neighbor ip-address

Example:


  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24
  

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 5

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2003

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 6

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 7

route-reflector-client

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-reflector-client

Configures the router as a BGP route reflector and configures the neighbor as its client.

Step 8

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring BGP Route Filtering by Route Policy

Perform this task to configure BGP routing filtering by route policy.

Before you begin

See the Implementing Routing Policy on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Routing Configuration Guide (this publication) for a list of the supported attributes and operations that are valid for inbound and outbound neighbor policy filtering.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. route-policy name
  3. end-policy
  4. router bgp as-number
  5. neighbor ip-address
  6. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  7. route-policy route-policy-name { in | out }
  8. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

route-policy name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy drop-as-1234
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if as-path passes-through '1234' then
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# apply check-communities
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# else
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# pass
  RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# endif
  

(Optional) Creates a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode, where you can define the route policy.

Step 3

end-policy

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

(Optional) Ends the definition of a route policy and exits route policy configuration mode.

Step 4

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 5

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 6

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 7

route-policy route-policy-name { in | out }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy drop-as-1234 in

Applies the specified policy to inbound routes.

Step 8

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring BGP Attribute Filtering

Perform the following tasks to configure BGP attribute filtering:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. attribute-filter group attribute-filter group name
  4. attribute attribute code { discard | treat-as-withdraw }

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

attribute-filter group attribute-filter group name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# attribute-filter group ag_discard_med

Specifies the attribute-filter group name and enters the attribute-filter group configuration mode, allowing you to configure a specific attribute filter group for a BGP neighbor.

Step 4

attribute attribute code { discard | treat-as-withdraw }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-attrfg)# attribute 24 discard
Specifies a single or a range of attribute codes and an associated action. The allowed actions are:
  • Treat-as-withdraw— Considers the update message for withdrawal. The associated IPv4-unicast or MP_REACH NLRIs, if present, are withdrawn from the neighbor's Adj-RIB-In.

  • Discard Attribute— Discards this attribute. The matching attributes alone are discarded and the rest of the Update message is processed normally.

Configuring BGP Next-Hop Trigger Delay

Perform this task to configure BGP next-hop trigger delay. The Routing Information Base (RIB) classifies the dampening notifications based on the severity of the changes. Event notifications are classified as critical and noncritical. This task allows you to specify the minimum batching interval for the critical and noncritical events.

Procedure


Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

nexthop trigger-delay { critical delay | non-critical delay }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# nexthop trigger-delay critical 15000

Sets the critical next-hop trigger delay.

This list provides the default critical and non-critical delay values for the specified address families.

  • critical : 3000 msec for all address families, except VPNv4 and VPNv6 address families.

  • critical : 50 msec for VPNv4 and VPNv6 address families.

  • non-critical : 10000 msec for all address families.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.


Disabling Next-Hop Processing on BGP Updates

Perform this task to disable next-hop calculation for a neighbor and insert your own address in the next-hop field of BGP updates. Disabling the calculation of the best next hop to use when advertising a route causes all routes to be advertised with the network device as the next hop.


Note


Next-hop processing can be disabled for address family group, neighbor group, or neighbor address family.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  6. next-hop-self
  7. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 206

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 5

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 6

next-hop-self

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# next-hop-self

Sets the next-hop attribute for all routes advertised to the specified neighbor to the address of the local router. Disabling the calculation of the best next hop to use when advertising a route causes all routes to be advertised with the local network device as the next hop.

Step 7

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring BGP Community and Extended-Community Advertisements

Perform this task to specify that community/extended-community attributes should be sent to an eBGP neighbor. These attributes are not sent to an eBGP neighbor by default. By contrast, they are always sent to iBGP neighbors. This section provides examples on how to enable sending community attributes. The send-community-ebgp keyword can be replaced by the send-extended-community-ebgp keyword to enable sending extended-communities.

If the send-community-ebgp command is configured for a neighbor group or address family group, all neighbors using the group inherit the configuration. Configuring the command specifically for a neighbor overrides inherited values.


Note


BGP community and extended-community filtering cannot be configured for iBGP neighbors. Communities and extended-communities are always sent to iBGP neighbors under VPNv4, MDT, IPv4, and IPv6 address families.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. address-family {ipv4 {labeled-unicast | unicast | mdt | multicast | mvpn | tunnel } | ipv6 {labeled-unicast | mvpn | unicast }}
  6. Use one of these commands:
    • send-community-ebgp
    • send-extended-community-ebgp
  7. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002 

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 5

address-family {ipv4 {labeled-unicast | unicast | mdt | multicast | mvpn | tunnel } | ipv6 {labeled-unicast | mvpn | unicast }}

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv6 unicast

Enters neighbor address family configuration mode for the specified address family. Use either ipv4 or ipv6 address family keyword with one of the specified address family sub mode identifiers.

IPv6 address family mode supports these sub modes:
  • labeled-unicast

  • mvpn

  • unicast

IPv4 address family mode supports these sub modes:
  • labeled-unicast

  • mdt

  • multicast

  • mvpn

  • rt-filter

  • tunnel

  • unicast

Refer the address-family (BGP) command in BGP Commands module of Routing Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers for more information on the Address Family Submode support.

Step 6

Use one of these commands:

  • send-community-ebgp
  • send-extended-community-ebgp

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# send-community-ebgp

or

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# send-extended-community-ebgp

Specifies that the router send community attributes or extended community attributes (which are disabled by default for eBGP neighbors) to a specified eBGP neighbor.

Step 7

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring the BGP Cost Community

Perform this task to configure the BGP cost community.

BGP receives multiple paths to the same destination and it uses the best-path algorithm to decide which is the best path to install in RIB. To enable users to determine an exit point after partial comparison, the cost community is defined to tie-break equal paths during the best-path selection process.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. route-policy name
  3. set extcommunity cost { cost-extcommunity-set-name | cost-inline-extcommunity-set } [ additive ]
  4. end-policy
  5. router bgp as-number
  6. Do one of the following:
    • default-information originate
    • aggregate-address address/mask-length [ as-set ] [ as-confed-set ] [ summary-only ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  7. Do one of the following:
    • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } network { ip-address/prefix-length | ip-address mask } [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • neighbor ip-address remote-as as-number address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }
    • route-policy route-policy-name { in | out }
  8. Use the commit or end command.
  9. show bgp [ vrf vrf-name ] ip-address

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

route-policy name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy costA

Enters route policy configuration mode and specifies the name of the route policy to be configured.

Step 3

set extcommunity cost { cost-extcommunity-set-name | cost-inline-extcommunity-set } [ additive ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# set extcommunity cost cost_A

Specifies the BGP extended community attribute for cost.

Step 4

end-policy

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# end-policy

Ends the definition of a route policy and exits route policy configuration mode.

Step 5

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Enters BGP configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 6

Do one of the following:

  • default-information originate
  • aggregate-address address/mask-length [ as-set ] [ as-confed-set ] [ summary-only ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv6 unicast | vpnv4 unicast } redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]

Applies the cost community to the attach point (route policy).

Step 7

Do one of the following:

  • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast } network { ip-address/prefix-length | ip-address mask } [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • neighbor ip-address remote-as as-number address-family { ipv4 unicast | ipv4 multicast | ipv4 tunnel | ipv4 mdt | ipv6 unicast | ipv6 multicast | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }
  • route-policy route-policy-name { in | out }

Step 8

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 9

show bgp [ vrf vrf-name ] ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp 172.168.40.24

Displays the cost community in the following format:

Cost: POI : cost-community-ID : cost-number

Configuring Software to Store Updates from a Neighbor

Perform this task to configure the software to store updates received from a neighbor.

The soft-reconfiguration inbound command causes a route refresh request to be sent to the neighbor if the neighbor is route refresh capable. If the neighbor is not route refresh capable, the neighbor must be reset to relearn received routes using the clear bgp soft command. See the Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Inbound Soft Reset.


Note


Storing updates from a neighbor works only if either the neighbor is route refresh capable or the soft-reconfiguration inbound command is configured. Even if the neighbor is route refresh capable and the soft-reconfiguration inbound command is configured, the original routes are not stored unless the always option is used with the command. The original routes can be easily retrieved with a route refresh request. Route refresh sends a request to the peer to resend its routing information. The soft-reconfiguration inbound command stores all paths received from the peer in an unmodified form and refers to these stored paths during the clear. Soft reconfiguration is memory intensive.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  5. soft-reconfiguration inbound [ always]
  6. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120 

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 5

soft-reconfiguration inbound [ always]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# soft-reconfiguration inbound always

Configures the software to store updates received from a specified neighbor. Soft reconfiguration inbound causes the software to store the original unmodified route in addition to a route that is modified or filtered. This allows a “soft clear” to be performed after the inbound policy is changed.

Soft reconfiguration enables the software to store the incoming updates before apply policy if route refresh is not supported by the peer (otherwise a copy of the update is not stored). The always keyword forces the software to store a copy even when route refresh is supported by the peer.

Step 6

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Graceful Restart

The BGP graceful restart helper mode feature is available globally. Graceful restart is the mechanism by which BGP routing peers continue to forward traffic while the BGP session is restarting. If a BGP session is already established with a neighbor and the neighbor requests a new session, the new session is accepted if graceful restart is configured for that neighbor on the local BGP speaker. There must also be one AFI/SAFI in the Graceful Restart Capability in the OPEN message received from that neighbor's existing session; otherwise, the old session is retained.

Depending on the network topology, if not all IBGP speakers are not capable for a graceful restart, there could be an increased exposure to forwarding loops when graceful restart procedures are exercised. For more information, refer to IETF RFC4724 Graceful Restart Mechanism for BGP.

The topology below explains how a forwarding loop is created.

  1. R1, R2, R3,and R4 are in one AS and have IBGP sessions with each other (full mesh). R5 is in another AS and has EBGP sessions to R1 and R4, and R1 is the best path to R5.

  2. R3 sends traffic to R5. This traffic goes through R2 then R1.

  3. R2 and R4 do not implement BGP GR.

  4. R3 implements BGP GR.

  5. BGP on R1 restarts. R1 preserves its BGP routes. R4 now considers its path best and advertises it.

  6. R2 has discarded its path to R1 and uses the path to R4

  7. R3 still uses R1 as its best path because it has retained it due to GR.

  8. R3 continues to send traffic using R2.

  9. R2 now sends the traffic to R4 using R3.

  10. This creates a forwarding loop between R2 and R3.

BGP performs graceful restart when the restarting speaker can forward packets, for example:

  • When a new BGP TCP connection is received from the restarting speaker.

  • When the BGP TCP session from the restarting speaker terminates, but not after a notification message is received on it.


Note


Unconfiguring a neighbor (no neighbor command) or BGP (no router bgp command) may trigger a graceful restart (GR) on the neighboring router. If you do not want BGP to perform a graceful restart, disable the BGP neighbor by configuring an administrative shutdown under the neighbor settings before unconfiguring the neighbor or BGP.


BGP Graceful Restart operates under the basis that the restarting speaker is still capable of forwarding to all its BGP routes. If a forwarding failure on the restarting speaker is detected, then BGP graceful restart must be aborted. The following scenarios indicate that the BGP neighbor isn’t forwarding:

  • The BGP hold time has expired. The local speaker sends keepalive messages and update messages to the neighbor. If the neighbor does not respond to the keepalive messages with TCP RST packets, then TCP is no longer functional, indicating that the neighbor is non-functional.

  • The interface to the neighbor goes down.

  • The BFD session to the neighbor fails.

If the purge-time is configured to 0 when the BGP process on the local BGP speaker goes down, the local speaker immediately purges the BGP routes from its routing information base (RIB). In addition, the local BGP speaker will not include Address Family Identifiers (AFI) or Subsequent Address Family Identifiers (SAFI) in graceful restart capability announcements. Neighbor routes are retained.


Note


BGP graceful restart is enabled globally on the BGP speaker and can be disabled on individual neighbors.

Configuring Graceful Restart

Perform this task to configure BGP graceful restart.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. router bgp as-number
  2. bgp graceful restart
  3. bgp graceful restart purge time purge-time

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:ios(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 2

bgp graceful restart

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:ios(config-bgp)#bgp graceful-restart

Enables BGP graceful restart functionality on the router.

Step 3

bgp graceful restart purge time purge-time

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:ios(config-bgp)#bgp graceful-restart purge-time 0

Specifies the maximum time before stale routes are purged from the routing information base (RIB) when the local BGP process restarts. The purge-time range is from 0 to 6000 seconds.

Graceful Restart Helper Mode Preemption

Helper Mode Preemption removes the condition that requires at least one AFI/SAFI in the Graceful Restart Capability in the OPEN message that’s received from that neighbor's existing session. Now, if a BGP session is already established and the same neighbor requests a new session, the new session is accepted if graceful restart is configured for that neighbor on the local BGP speaker. Otherwise, the old session is retained.

In the current implementation, when a BGP session goes down, the routes are preserved and marked as stale for every address family for which an AFI/SAFI exists in the Graceful Restart Capability received in the BGP OPEN Message from that neighbor. Now, when a BGP neighbor session goes down, and it is not configured for graceful-restart and bgp graceful-restart retain-nbr-routes disable is configured, then the local BGP speaker does not retain the routes received from that neighbor.

Configuring Graceful Restart Helper Mode Preemption

Perform this task to configure BGP graceful restart helper mode preemption.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. router bgp as-number
  2. bgp graceful restart
  3. bgp graceful restart retain-nbr-routes-disable

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:ios(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 2

bgp graceful restart

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:ios(config-bgp)#bgp graceful-restart

Enables BGP graceful restart functionality on the router.

Step 3

bgp graceful restart retain-nbr-routes-disable

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:ios(config-bgp)#bgp graceful-restart retain-nbr-routes disable

Specifies the local BGP speaker does not retain the routes received from the neighbor

BGP Persistence

BGP persistence enables the local router to retain routes that it has learnt from the configured neighbor even after the neighbor session is down. BGP persistence is also referred as Long Lived Graceful Restart (LLGR). LLGR takes effect after graceful restart (GR) ends or immediately if GR is not enabled. LLGR ends either when the LLGR stale timer expires or when the neighbor sends the end-of-RIB marker after it has revised its routes. When LLGR for a neighbor ends, all routes from that neighbor that are still stale will be deleted. The LLGR capability is signaled to a neighbor in the BGP OPEN message if it has been configured for that neighbor. LLGR differs from graceful restart in the following ways.

  • It can be in effect for a much longer time than GR

  • LLGR stale routes are least preferred during route selection (bestpath computation).

  • An LLGR stale route will be advertised with the LLGR_STALE community attached if it is selected as best path. It will not be advertised at all to routers that are not LLGR capable.

  • LLGR stale routes will not be deleted when the forwarding path to the neighbor is detected to be down

  • An LLGR stale route will not be deleted if the BGP session to the neighbor goes down multiple times even if that neighbor does not re-advertise the route.

  • Any route that has the NO_LLGR community will not be retained.


Note


You can disable GR helper-only for peer-group and neighbor, when there is no global GR helper-only configured.


BGP will not pass the updates containing communities 65535:6, 65535:7 to its neighbors until the neighbors negotiate BGP persistence capabilities. The communities 65535:6 and 65535:7 are reserved for LLGR_STALE and NO_LLGR respectively, BGP behavior maybe unpredictable if you have configured these communities prior to release 5.2.2. We recommend not to configure the communities 65535:6 and 65535:7.

The BGP persistence feature is supported only on the following AFIs:

  • VPNv4 and VPNv6

  • RT constraint

  • Flow spec (IPv4, IPv6, VPNv4 and VPNv6)

  • Private IPv4 and IPv6 (IPv4/v6 address family inside VRF)

BGP Persistence Configuration: Example

This example sets long lived graceful restart (LLGR) stale-time of 16777215 on BGP neighbor 3.3.3.3.


router bgp 100
 neighbor 3.3.3.3
  remote-as 30813
  update-source Loopback0
  graceful-restart stalepath-time 150
  address-family vpnv4 unicast
   long-lived-graceful-restart capable
   long-lived-graceful-restart stale-time send 16777215 accept 16777215
  !
  address-family vpnv6 unicast
   long-lived-graceful-restart capable
   long-lived-graceful-restart stale-time send 16777215 accept 16777215

BGP Graceful Maintenance

When a BGP link or router is taken down, other routers in the network find alternative paths for the traffic that was flowing through the failed router or link, if such alternative paths exist. The time required before all routers involved can reach a consensus about an alternate path is called convergence time. During convergence time, traffic that is directed to the router or link that is down is dropped. The BGP Graceful Maintenance feature allows the network to perform convergence before the router or link is taken out of service. The router or link remains in service while the network reroutes traffic to alternative paths. Any traffic that is yet on its way to the affected router or link is still delivered as before. After all traffic has been rerouted, the router or link can safely be taken out of service.

The Graceful Maintenance feature is helpful when alternate paths exist and these alternate paths are not known to routers at the time that the primary paths are withdrawn. The feature provides these alternate paths before the primary paths are withdrawn. The feature is most helpful in networks where convergence time is long. Several factors, such as large routing tables and presence of route reflectors, can result in longer convergence time.

When a BGP router or link is brought into service, the possibility of traffic loss during convergence also exists, although it is less than when a router or link is taken out of service. The BGP Graceful Maintenance feature can also be used in this scenario.

Restrictions for BGP Graceful Maintenance

The following restrictions apply for BGP Graceful Maintenance:

  • If the affected router is configured to send the GSHUT community attribute, then other routers in the network that receive it must be configured to interpret it. You must match the community with a routing policy and set a lower preference.

  • The LOCAL_PREF attribute is not sent to another AS. Therefore, the LOCAL_PREF option cannot be used on an eBGP link.

    Note


    This restriction does not apply to eBGP links between member-ASs of an AS confederation.


  • Alternative routes must exist in the network, otherwise advertising a lower preference has no effect. For example, there is no advantage in configuring Graceful Maintenance for a singly-homed customer router which does not have alternate routes.

  • If time consuming policies exist, either at the output of the sending router or at the input of the receiving router, the Graceful Maintenance operation can take a long time.

  • Configuring an eBGP ASBR neighbor results in advertising an implicit null label for directly connected routes via BGP. If a user shuts down an eBGP neighbor, the label is not reprogrammed as the system withdraws rewrites on any neighbor state changes. Implicit null label feature support helps avoid churn in terms of adding or removing rewrites for neighbor flaps.

Graceful Maintenance Operation

When Graceful Maintenance is activated, the affected routes are advertised again with a reduced preference. This causes neighboring routers to choose alternative routes. You can use any of the following methods to a signal reduced route preference:
  • Add GSHUT community: Use this method to allow remote routers the freedom to set a preference. Receiving routers must match this community in a policy and set their own preference.

  • Reduce LOCAL_PREF value: This works for internal BGP neighbors. Use this method if remote routers do not match the GSHUT community.

  • Prepend AS Path: This works for both internal and external BGP neighbors. Use this method if remote routers do not match the GSHUT community.

When Graceful Maintenance is activated on a BGP connection, the following two operations happen:
  1. All routes received from the connection are re-advertised to other neighbors with a lower preference. Note, this happens to only those routes that have actually been advertised to other neighbors. It is possible that a received route was not selected as the best path and therefore not advertised. In that case, it will not be re-advertised.

  2. All routes that were advertised to the connection is re-advertised with a lower preference.

In order for the first operation to happen, all routes received from the connection are tagged with an internal attribute called graceful-shut. This attribute is stored internal to only the router; it is not advertised by BGP. This attribute can be seen when the route is displayed with the show bgp command. It is different from the GSHUT community. The GSHUT community is advertised by BGP and can be seen in the community list when the route is displayed with the show bgp command.

All routes that have the graceful-shut attribute are given the lowest preference during route-selection. Any new route updates that are sent or received on a BGP session under Graceful Maintenance are also treated as described above.

Inter Autonomous System

Advertising a lower preference to another AS in the public Internet may cause unnecessary routing advertisements in distant networks, which may not be desirable. An additional configuration under the neighbor address family, send-community-gshut-ebgp, is necessary for the router to originate the GSHUT community to the eBGP neighbor.

Note


This does not affect the GSHUT community on a route that already had this community when it was received; it only affects the GSHUT community when this router adds it.


No Automatic Shutdown

The Graceful Maintenance feature does not perform any shutdown. When Graceful Maintenance is configured, it remains configured, even through system restarts. It is intended to be used in conjunction with a shutdown of a router or a BGP neighbor. The operator must explicitly shut down whenever it is needed. After Graceful Maintenance is no longer required, the operator must explicitly deactivate it. Graceful Maintenance may be deactivated either after the shutdown is completed, or after the deactivated facilities are again brought up. Whether to leave Graceful Maintenance activated through a bring-up operation depends on whether the transient routing during the bring-up operation is considered a problem.

When to Shut Down After Graceful Maintenance

The router or link can be shut down after the network has converged as a result of a graceful-maintenance activation. Convergence can take from less than a second to more than an hour. Unfortunately, a single router cannot know when a whole network has converged. After a graceful-maintenance activation, it can take a few seconds to start sending updates. Then, the “InQ” and “OutQ” of neighbors in the show bgp <vrf> <afi> <safi> summary command's output indicates the level of BGP messaging. Both InQ and OutQ should be 0 after convergence. Neighbors should stop sending traffic. However, they won't stop sending traffic if they do not have alternate paths; and in that case traffic loss cannot be prevented.

Activate Graceful Maintenance under BGP Router (All Neighbors)

Activating Graceful Maintenance under a BGP router results in activatebeing configured under graceful-maintenance for all neighbors. With just this one configuration, you get the same result if you were to go to every neighbor that has graceful-maintenance configured, and added activate under it. If you add the keyword all-neighbors, thus, graceful-maintenance activate all-neighbors, then the router acts as if you configured graceful-maintenance activate under every neighbor.

Note


We suggest that you activate Graceful Maintenance under a BGP router instance only if it is acceptable to send the GSHUT community for all routes on every neighbor. Re-sending all routes to every neighbor can take significant amount of time on a large router. Sending GSHUT to a neighbor that does not have alternative routes is pointless. If a router has many of such neighbors then a significant amount of time can be saved by not activating Graceful Maintenance on them.


The BGP Graceful Maintenance feature allows you to enable Graceful Maintenance either on a single neighbor, on a group of neighbors across BGP sessions, or on all neighbors. Enabling Graceful Maintenance under a neighbor sub-mode, does two things:
  1. All routes that are advertised to this neighbor that has the graceful-shut attribute are advertised to that neighbor with the GSHUT community.

  2. Enters graceful-maintenance configuration mode to allow further configuration.

Using the activate keyword under graceful-maintenance, causes the following:
  1. All routes that are received from this neighbor acquire the graceful-shut attribute.
  2. All routes that are advertised to this neighbor are re-advertised to that neighbor with the GSHUT community.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. graceful-maintenance activate [ all-neighbors | retain-routes ]
  4. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

graceful-maintenance activate [ all-neighbors | retain-routes ]

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# graceful-maintenance activate 
all-neighhbors
Announces routes with the g-shut community and other attributes as configured under the neighbors. This causes neighbors to reject routes from this router and choose alternates. This allows the router to be gracefully brought in or out of service.
If you use the all-neighbors keyword, Graceful Maintenance is activated even for those neighbors that do not have it activated. Choosing retain-routes causes RIB to retain BGP routes when the BGP process is stopped.
Use the retain-routes option when only BGP must be brought down instead of the entire router, and when it is known that neighboring routers are kept in operation during the maintenance of the local BGP. If RIB has alternative routes provided by another protocol or a default route, then it is recommended that you do not to retain BGP routes after the BGP process stops.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

What to do next

After activating Graceful Maintenance, you must wait for all the routes to be sent and for the neighboring routers to redirect their traffic away from the router or link under maintenance. After the traffic is redirected, then it is safe to take the router or link out of service. While there is no definitive way to know when all the routes have been sent, you can use the show bgp summary command to check the OutQ of the neighbors. When OutQ reaches a value 0, there are no more updates to be sent.

Activate Graceful Maintenance on a Single Neighbor

Use the following steps to activate Graceful Maintenance for a single neighbor:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. graceful-maintenance activate
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

graceful-maintenance activate

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# graceful-maintenance 
activate

Announces routes with Graceful Maintenance attributes.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Activate Graceful Maintenance on a Group of Neighbors

Use the following steps to activate Graceful Maintenance on a group of neighbors:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor-group Neighbor-group name
  4. graceful-maintenance activate
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor-group Neighbor-group name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor-group AS_1

Places the router in neighbor group configuration mode.

Step 4

graceful-maintenance activate

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbrgrp)# graceful-maintenance 
activate

Announces routes with Graceful Maintenance attributes.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

What to do next
You must configure the send-community-gshut-ebgp command under the neighbor address family of an eBGP neighbor for this router to add the GSHUT community.

Note


Sending GSHUT community may not be desirable under every address family of an eBGP neighbor. To allow you to target GSHUT community to a specific set of address families, use the send-community-gshut-ebgp command.


Direct Router to Reduce Route Preference

The BGP Graceful Maintenance feature works only with the availability of alternate paths. You must advertise routes with a lower preference to allow alternate routes to take over before taking down a link or router. Use the following steps to modify the route preference:

Note


Attributes for graceful maintenance are added to a route update message after an outbound policy has been applied to it.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. graceful-maintenance as-prepends value | local-preference value

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 5

graceful-maintenance as-prepends value | local-preference value

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# graceful-maintenance 
local-preference 4
Specifies the number of times the local AS number is to be to prepended to the AS path of routes and advertises the GSHUT community with the local preference value specified for the routes. When the router adds the GSHUT community to a route as it advertises it, it also changes the LOCAL_PREF attribute and prepends the local AS number as specified in the commands. Sending GSHUT provides flexibility in the manner in which neighboring routers handle the lower preference: they can match it in a route policy and do the most appropriate thing with it. On the other hand, in simple networks, it is easier to set local-preference to 0, than to create route policies everywhere else.

Note

 

LOCAL_PREF is not sent to real eBGP neighbors, but sent to confederation member AS eBGP neighbors. To lower the preference to eBGP neighbors, as-prepends value is required.

Example: Configure route policy matching GSHUT community to lower route preference
route-policy gshut
  if community matches-any gshut then
    set local-preference 0
  endif
  pass
end-policy


neighbor 666.0.0.3
    address-family ipv4 unicast
      route-policy gshut in

Note


Routes received from a GSHUT neighbor are marked with a GSHUT attribute to distinguish them from routes received with the GSHUT community. When a neighbor is taken out of maintenance, the attribute on its paths is removed, but not the community. The attribute is internal and not sent in BGP messages. It is used to reject routes during path selection.


Bring Router or Link Back into Service

Before you bring the router or link back into service, you must first activate graceful maintenance and then remove the activate configuration.

Show Command Outputs to Verify BGP Graceful Maintenance

This section lists the show commands you can use to verify that BGP Graceful Maintenance is activated and check related attributes:

Use the show bgp <IP address> command to display graceful-shutdown community and the graceful-shut path attribute with BGP graceful maintenance activated:
RP/0/0/CPU0:R4#show bgp 5.5.5.5
...
10.10.10.1 from 10.10.10.1 (192.168.0.5)
Received Label 24000
Origin incomplete, metric 0, localpref 100, valid, internal, best, group-best,
import-candidate
Received Path ID 0, Local Path ID 1, version 4
Community: graceful-shutdown
Originator: 192.168.0.5, Cluster list: 192.168.0.1
The following is sample output from the show bgp community graceful-shutdown command displaying the graceful maintenance feature information:
RP/0/0/CPU0:R4#show bgp community graceful-shutdown
BGP router identifier 192.168.0.4, local AS number 4
BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
BGP table state: Active
Table ID: 0xe0000000 RD version: 18
BGP main routing table version 18
BGP scan interval 60 secs
Status codes: s suppressed, d damped, h history, * valid, > best
i - internal, r RIB-failure, S stale, N Nexthop-discard
Origin codes: i - IGP, e - EGP, ? - incomplete
Network Next Hop Metric LocPrf Weight Path
* 5.5.5.5/32 10.10.10.1 88 0 1 ?
Processed 1 prefixes, 1 paths
The following is the sample output from the show bgp neighbors command with the ip-address and configuration argument and keyword to display graceful maintenance feature attributes:
RP/0/0/CPU0:R1#show bgp neighbor 12.12.12.5
...
Graceful Maintenance locally active, Local Pref=45, AS prepends=3
...
For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
...
GSHUT Community attribute sent to this neighbor
...
**************************************************************************
RP/0/0/CPU0:R1#show bgp neighbor 12.12.12.5 configuration
neighbor 12.12.12.5
remote-as 1 []
graceful-maintenance 1 []
gr-maint local-preference 45 []
gr-maint as-prepends 3 []
gr-maint activate []
The following is the sample output of the show rpl community-set command with graceful maintenance feature attributes displayed:
RP/0/0/CPU0:R5#show rpl community-set
Listing for all Community Set objects
community-set gshut
graceful-shutdown
end-set
The following is the sample of the syslog that is issued when a BGP neighbor that has graceful maintenance activated, comes up. It is a warning text that reminds you to deactivate graceful maintenance after convergence.
RP/0/0/CPU0:Jan 28 22:01:36.356 : bgp[1056]: %ROUTING-BGP-5-ADJCHANGE : neighbor 10.10.10.4 Up (VRF: default) (AS: 4) 
WARNING: Graceful Maintenance is Active

Flow-tag propagation

The flow-tag propagation feature enables you to establish a co-relation between route-policies and user-policies. Flow-tag propagation using BGP allows user-side traffic-steering based on routing attributes such as, AS number, prefix lists, community strings and extended communities. Flow-tag is a logical numeric identifier that is distributed through RIB as one of the routing attribute of FIB entry in the FIB lookup table. A flow-tag is instantiated using the 'set' operation from RPL and is referenced in the C3PL PBR policy, where it is associated with actions (policy-rules) against the flow-tag value.

You can use flow-tag propagation to:

  • Classify traffic based on destination IP addresses (using the Community number) or based on prefixes (using Community number or AS number).
  • Select a TE-group that matches the cost of the path to reach a service-edge based on customer site service level agreements (SLA).
  • Apply traffic policy (TE-group selection) for specific customers based on SLA with its clients.
  • Divert traffic to application or cache server.

For more information on the commands for flow-tag propagation see the BGP Commands module in the Routing Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers.

Restrictions for flow-tag propagation

Some restrictions are placed with regard to using Quality-of-service Policy Propagation Using Border Gateway Protocol (QPPB) and flow-tag feature together in a ASR9K platform. These include:

  • A route-policy can have either 'set qos-group' or 'set flow-tag,' but not both for a prefix-set.
  • Route policy for qos-group and route policy flow-tag cannot have overlapping routes. The QPPB and flow tag features can coexist (on same as well as on different interfaces) as long as the route policy used by them do not have any overlapping route.
  • Mixing usage of qos-group and flow-tag in route-policy and policy-map is not recommended.

Source and destination-based flow tag

The source-based flow tag feature allows you to match packets based on the flow-tag assigned to the source address of the incoming packets. Once matched, you can then apply any supported PBR action on this policy.

Configure Source and Destination-based Flow Tag

This task applies flow-tag to a specified interface. The packets are matched based on the flow-tag assigned to the source address of the incoming packets.


Note


You will not be able to enable both QPPB and flow tag feature simultaneously on an interface.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. interface type interface-path-id
  3. ipv4 | ipv6 bgp policy propagation input flow-tag{destination | source}
  4. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

interface type interface-path-id

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0

Enters interface configuration mode and associates one or more interfaces to the VRF.

Step 3

ipv4 | ipv6 bgp policy propagation input flow-tag{destination | source}

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-if)# ipv4 bgp policy propagation input flow-tag source

Enables flow-tag policy propagation on source or destination IP address on an interface.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes, and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration mode, without committing the configuration changes.

Example
The following show commands display outputs with PBR policy applied on the router:
show running-config interface gigabitEthernet 0/0/0/12
Thu Feb 12 01:51:37.820 UTC
interface GigabitEthernet0/0/0/12
 service-policy type pbr input flowMatchPolicy
 ipv4 bgp policy propagation input flow-tag source
 ipv4 address 192.5.1.2 255.255.255.0
!

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:ASR9K-0#show running-config policy-map type pbr flowMatchPolicy 
Thu Feb 12 01:51:45.776 UTC
policy-map type pbr flowMatchPolicy
 class type traffic flowMatch36 
  transmit
 ! 
 class type traffic flowMatch38 
  transmit
 ! 
 class type traffic class-default 
 ! 
 end-policy-map
! 

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:ASR9K-0#show running-config class-map type traffic flowMatch36
Thu Feb 12 01:52:04.838 UTC
class-map type traffic match-any flowMatch36
 match flow-tag 36 
 end-class-map
!

Configuring a VPN Routing and Forwarding Instance in BGP

Layer 3 (virtual private network) VPN can be configured only if there is an available Layer 3 VPN license for the line card slot on which the feature is being configured. If advanced IP license is enabled, 4096 Layer 3 VPN routing and forwarding instances (VRFs) can be configured on an interface. If the infrastructure VRF license is enabled, eight Layer 3 VRFs can be configured on the line card.

See the Software Entitlement on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module in System Management Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers for more information on advanced IP licencing.

The following error message appears if the appropriate licence is not enabled:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#LC/0/0/CPU0:Dec 15 17:57:53.653 : rsi_agent[247]:
%LICENSE-ASR9K_LICENSE-2-INFRA_VRF_NEEDED : 5 VRF(s) are configured without license A9K-iVRF-LIC in violation of the Software Right To Use Agreement. 
This feature may be disabled by the system without the appropriate license.
Contact Cisco to purchase the license immediately to avoid potential service interruption.

Note


An AIP license is not required for configuring L2VPN services.


The following tasks are used to configure a VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instance in BGP:

Defining Virtual Routing and Forwarding Tables in Provider Edge Routers

Perform this task to define the VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) tables in the provider edge (PE) routers.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. vrf vrf-name
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. maximum prefix maximum [ threshold ]
  5. import route-policy policy-name
  6. import route-target [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ]
  7. export route-policy policy-name
  8. export route-target [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ]
  9. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

vrf vrf-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# vrf vrf_pe

Configures a VRF instance.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

maximum prefix maximum [ threshold ]

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# maximum prefix 2300

Configures a limit to the number of prefixes allowed in a VRF table.

A maximum number of routes is applicable to dynamic routing protocols as well as static or connected routes.

You can specify a threshold percentage of the prefix limit using the mid-threshold argument.

Step 5

import route-policy policy-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# import route-policy policy_a

(Optional) Provides finer control over what gets imported into a VRF. This import filter discards prefixes that do not match the specified policy-name argument.

Step 6

import route-target [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ]

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# import route-target 234:222

Specifies a list of route target (RT) extended communities. Only prefixes that are associated with the specified import route target extended communities are imported into the VRF.

Step 7

export route-policy policy-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)# export route-policy policy_b

(Optional) Provides finer control over what gets exported into a VRF. This export filter discards prefixes that do not match the specified policy-name argument.

Step 8

export route-target [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ]

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routerr(config-vrf-af)# export route-target 123;234

Specifies a list of route target extended communities. Export route target communities are associated with prefixes when they are advertised to remote PEs. The remote PEs import them into VRFs which have import RTs that match these exported route target communities.

Step 9

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring the Route Distinguisher

The route distinguisher (RD) makes prefixes unique across multiple VPN routing and forwarding (VRF) instances.

In the L3VPN multipath same route distinguisher (RD)environment, the determination of whether to install a prefix in RIB or not is based on the prefix's bestpath. In a rare misconfiguration situation, where the best pah is not a valid path to be installed in RIB, BGP drops the prefix and does not consider the other paths. The behavior is different for different RD setup, where the non-best multipath will be installed if the best multipath is invalid to be installed in RIB.

Perform this task to configure the RD.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. bgp router-id ip-address
  4. vrf vrf-name
  5. rd { as-number : nn | ip-address : nn | auto }
  6. Do one of the following:
    • end
    • commit

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Enters BGP configuration mode allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

bgp router-id ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# bgp router-id 10.0.0.0

Configures a fixed router ID for the BGP-speaking router.

Step 4

vrf vrf-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_pe

Configures a VRF instance.

Step 5

rd { as-number : nn | ip-address : nn | auto }

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# rd 345:567

Configures the route distinguisher.

Use the auto keyword if you want the router to automatically assign a unique RD to the VRF.

Automatic assignment of RDs is possible only if a router ID is configured using the bgp router-id command in router configuration mode. This allows you to configure a globally unique router ID that can be used for automatic RD generation. The router ID for the VRF does not need to be globally unique, and using the VRF router ID would be incorrect for automatic RD generation. Having a single router ID also helps in checkpointing RD information for BGP graceful restart, because it is expected to be stable across reboots.

Step 6

Do one of the following:

  • end
  • commit
Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# end

or


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# commit

Saves configuration changes.

  • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes:

    
      Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]:
    
    • Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC configuration mode.

    • Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC configuration mode without committing the configuration changes.

    • Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes.

  • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session.

Configuring PE-PE or PE-RR Interior BGP Sessions

To enable BGP to carry VPN reachability information between provider edge (PE) routers you must configure the PE-PE interior BGP (iBGP) sessions. A PE uses VPN information carried from the remote PE router to determine VPN connectivity and the label value to be used so the remote (egress) router can demultiplex the packet to the correct VPN during packet forwarding.

The PE-PE, PE-route reflector (RR) iBGP sessions are defined to all PE and RR routers that participate in the VPNs configured in the PE router.

Perform this task to configure PE-PE iBGP sessions and to configure global VPN options on a PE.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family vpnv4 unicast
  4. exit
  5. neighbor ip-address
  6. remote-as as-number
  7. description text
  8. password { clear | encrypted } password
  9. shutdown
  10. timers keepalive hold-time
  11. update-source type interface-id
  12. address-family vpnv4 unicast
  13. route-policy route-policy-name in
  14. route-policy route-policy-name out
  15. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family vpnv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpvn4 unicast

Enters VPN address family configuration mode.

Step 4

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit

Exits the current configuration mode.

Step 5

neighbor ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.16.1.1

Configures a PE iBGP neighbor.

Step 6

remote-as as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1

Assigns the neighbor a remote autonomous system number.

Step 7

description text

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# description neighbor 172.16.1.1

(Optional) Provides a description of the neighbor. The description is used to save comments and does not affect software function.

Step 8

password { clear | encrypted } password

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# password encrypted 123abc

Enables Message Digest 5 (MD5) authentication on the TCP connection between the two BGP neighbors.

Step 9

shutdown

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# shutdown

Terminates any active sessions for the specified neighbor and removes all associated routing information.

Step 10

timers keepalive hold-time

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# timers 12000 200

Set the timers for the BGP neighbor.

Step 11

update-source type interface-id

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source gigabitEthernet 0/1/5/0

Allows iBGP sessions to use the primary IP address from a specific interface as the local address when forming an iBGP session with a neighbor.

Step 12

address-family vpnv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family vpvn4 unicast

Enters VPN neighbor address family configuration mode.

Step 13

route-policy route-policy-name in

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pe-pe-vpn-in in

Specifies a routing policy for an inbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes.

Step 14

route-policy route-policy-name out

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pe-pe-vpn-out out

Specifies a routing policy for an outbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes.

Step 15

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring Route Reflector to Hold Routes That Have a Defined Set of RT Communities

A provider edge (PE) needs to hold the routes that match the import route targets (RTs) of the VPNs configured on it. The PE router can discard all other VPNv4 routes. But, a route reflector (RR) must retain all VPNv4 routes, because it might peer with PE routers and different PEs might require different RT-tagged VPNv4 (making RRs non-scalable). You can configure an RR to only hold routes that have a defined set of RT communities. Also, a number of the RRs can be configured to service a different set of VPNs (thereby achieving some scalability). A PE is then made to peer with all RRs that service the VRFs configured on the PE. When a new VRF is configured with an RT for which the PE does not already hold routes, the PE issues route refreshes to the RRs and retrieves the relevant VPN routes.


Note


Note that this process can be more efficient if the PE-RR session supports extended community outbound route filter (ORF).


Perform this task to configure a reflector to retain routes tagged with specific RTs.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family vpnv4 unicast
  4. retain route-target { all | route-policy route-policy-name }
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family vpnv4 unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpvn4 unicast

Enters VPN address family configuration mode.

Step 4

retain route-target { all | route-policy route-policy-name }

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# retain route-target route-policy rr_ext-comm

Configures a reflector to retain routes tagged with particular RTs. Use the route-policy-name argument for the policy name that lists the extended communities that a path should have in order for the RR to retain that path.

Note

 

The all keyword is not required, because this is the default behavior of a route reflector.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring BGP as a PE-CE Protocol

Perform this task to configure BGP on the PE and establish PE-CE communication using BGP. This task can be performed in both VRF and non-VRF configuration.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. vrf vrf-name
  4. bgp router-id ip-address
  5. label mode per-ce
  6. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  7. network { ip-address / prefix-length | ip-address mask }
  8. aggregate-address address / mask-length
  9. exit
  10. neighbor ip-address
  11. remote-as as-number
  12. password { clear | encrypted } password
  13. ebgp-multihop [ ttl-value ]
  14. Do one of the following:
    • address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
    • address-family {ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} | ipv6 unicast}
  15. site-of-origin [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ]
  16. as-override
  17. allowas-in [ as-occurrence-number ]
  18. route-policy route-policy-name in
  19. route-policy route-policy-name out
  20. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

vrf vrf-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_pe_2

Enables BGP routing for a particular VRF on the PE router.

Step 4

bgp router-id ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# bgp router-id 172.16.9.9

Configures a fixed router ID for a BGP-speaking router.

Step 5

label mode per-ce

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# label mode per-ce
  • Configures the per-CE label mode to avoid an extra lookup on the PE router and conserve label space (per-prefix is the default label mode). In this mode, the PE router allocates one label for every immediate next-hop (in most cases, this would be a CE router). This label is directly mapped to the next hop, so there is no VRF route lookup performed during data forwarding. However, the number of labels allocated would be one for each CE rather than one for each VRF. Because BGP knows all the next hops, it assigns a label for each next hop (not for each PE-CE interface). When the outgoing interface is a multiaccess interface and the media access control (MAC) address of the neighbor is not known, Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) is triggered during packet forwarding.

  • The per-vrf keyword configures the same label to be used for all the routes advertised from a unique VRF.

Step 6

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 7

network { ip-address / prefix-length | ip-address mask }

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# network 172.16.5.5/24
               

Originates a network prefix in the address family table in the VRF context.

Step 8

aggregate-address address / mask-length

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# aggregate-address 10.0.0.0/24

Configures aggregation in the VRF address family context to summarize routing information to reduce the state maintained in the core. This summarization introduces some inefficiency in the PE edge, because an additional lookup is required to determine the ultimate next hop for a packet. When configured, a summary prefix is advertised instead of a set of component prefixes, which are more specifics of the aggregate. The PE advertises only one label for the aggregate. Because component prefixes could have different next hops to CEs, an additional lookup has to be performed during data forwarding.

Step 9

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# exit

Exits the current configuration mode.

Step 10

neighbor ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# neighbor 10.0.0.0

Configures a CE neighbor. The ip-address argument must be a private address.

Step 11

remote-as as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# remote-as 2

Configures the remote AS for the CE neighbor.

Step 12

password { clear | encrypted } password

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# password encrypted 234xyz

Enable Message Digest 5 (MD5) authentication on a TCP connection between two BGP neighbors.

Step 13

ebgp-multihop [ ttl-value ]

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr)# ebgp-multihop 55

Configures the CE neighbor to accept and attempt BGP connections to external peers residing on networks that are not directly connected.

Step 14

Do one of the following:

  • address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  • address-family {ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} | ipv6 unicast}
Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 15

site-of-origin [ as-number : nn | ip-address : nn ]

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# site-of-origin 234:111

Configures the site-of-origin (SoO) extended community. Routes that are learned from this CE neighbor are tagged with the SoO extended community before being advertised to the rest of the PEs. SoO is frequently used to detect loops when as-override is configured on the PE router. If the prefix is looped back to the same site, the PE detects this and does not send the update to the CE.

Step 16

as-override

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# as-override

Configures AS override on the PE router. This causes the PE router to replace the CE’s ASN with its own (PE) ASN.

Note

 

This loss of information could lead to routing loops; to avoid loops caused by as-override, use it in conjunction with site-of-origin.

Step 17

allowas-in [ as-occurrence-number ]

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# allowas-in 5

Allows an AS path with the PE autonomous system number (ASN) a specified number of times.

Hub and spoke VPN networks need the looping back of routing information to the HUB PE through the HUB CE. When this happens, due to the presence of the PE ASN, the looped-back information is dropped by the HUB PE. To avoid this, use the allowas-in command to allow prefixes even if they have the PEs ASN up to the specified number of times.

Step 18

route-policy route-policy-name in

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy pe_ce_in_policy in

Specifies a routing policy for an inbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes.

Step 19

route-policy route-policy-name out

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-nbr-af)# route-policy pe_ce_out_policy out

Specifies a routing policy for an outbound route. The policy can be used to filter routes or modify route attributes.

Step 20

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Redistribution of IGPs to BGP

Perform this task to configure redistribution of a protocol into the VRF address family.

Even if Interior Gateway Protocols (IGPs) are used as the PE-CE protocol, the import logic happens through BGP. Therefore, all IGP routes have to be imported into the BGP VRF table.


Note


Starting with Cisco IOS XR 7.4.1, redistribution of ISIS routes is supported on the VRF address family.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. vrf vrf-name
  4. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  5. Do one of the following:
    • redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
    • redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  6. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

vrf vrf-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf_a

Enables BGP routing for a particular VRF on the PE router.

Step 4

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 5

Do one of the following:

  • redistribute connected [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute eigrp process-id [ match { external | internal }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute isis process-id [ level { 1 | 1-inter-area | 2 }] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute ospf process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute ospfv3 process-id [ match { external [ 1 | 2 ] | internal | nssa-external [ 1 | 2 ]}] [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute rip [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
  • redistribute static [ metric metric-value ] [ route-policy route-policy-name ]
Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# redistribute eigrp 23 

Configures redistribution of a protocol into the VRF address family context.

The redistribute command is used if BGP is not used between the PE-CE routers. If BGP is used between PE-CE routers, the IGP that is used has to be redistributed into BGP to establish VPN connectivity with other PE sites. Redistribution is also required for inter-table import and export.

Step 6

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring Keychains for BGP

Keychains provide secure authentication by supporting different MAC authentication algorithms and provide graceful key rollover. Perform this task to configure keychains for BGP. This task is optional.


Note


If a keychain is configured for a neighbor group or a session group, a neighbor using the group inherits the keychain. Values of commands configured specifically for a neighbor override inherited values.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. keychain name
  6. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 2002

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system number to it.

Step 5

keychain name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# keychain kych_a

Configures keychain-based authentication.

Step 6

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Disabling a BGP Neighbor

Perform this task to administratively shut down a neighbor session without removing the configuration.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. shutdown
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 127

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

shutdown

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# shutdown

Disables all active sessions for the specified neighbor.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Neighbor Capability Suppression

A BGP speaker can learn about BGP extensions that are supported by a peer by using the capabilities negotiation feature. Capabilities negotiation allows BGP to use only the set of features supported by both BGP peers on a link. The neighbor capability suppression feature will turn off neighbor capabilities negotiation during Open message exchange. This is required for interoperability with very old customer premises equipment devices that do not understand Capabilities option.

Configuration:

Command introduced in neighbor, session-group and neighbor-group modes.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. capability suppress all
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 4

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 172.168.40.24

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

capability suppress all

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# capability suppress all

Turn off neighbor capabilities.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

BGP Dynamic Neighbors

Earlier IOS-XR supported explicitly configured or static neighbor configuration. BGP dynamic neighbor support allows BGP peering to a group of remote neighbors that are defined by a range of IP addresses. Each range can be configured as a subnet IP address.

In larger BGP networks, implementing BGP dynamic neighbors can reduce the amount and complexity of CLI configuration and save CPU and memory usage. Both IPv4 and IPv6 peering are supported. Both IPv4 and IPv6 peering are supported.


Note


The maximum number of remote neighbors for a single BGP dynamic neighbor subnet range is 4096. This is equivalent to a /20 subnet. You can configure multiple dynamic neighbor subnet ranges.


Configuring BGP Dynamic Neighbors using Address Range

The existing neighbor command is extended to accept a prefix instead of an address.

In the following task, Router B is configured as a remote BGP peer. After a subnet range is configured, a TCP session is initiated by Router B which has an IP address in the subnet range and a new BGP neighbor is dynamically established.

After the initial configuration of subnet ranges and activation of the peer neighbor, dynamic BGP neighbor creation does not require any further CLI configuration on the Router A.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor address prefix
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. update-source type interface-id
  6. address-family ipv4 unicast
  7. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters the global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100 

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor address prefix

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.0/16

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the BGP dynamic neighbor within the subnet range.

Note

 

All commands currently supported under a static neighbor, including address-family and inheritance using neighbor-group, session-group and af-group, will be supported for dynamic neighbor ranges with the exception of the following commands:

  • session-open-mode

  • local address

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 1

Creates a neighbor and assigns a remote autonomous system (AS) number to it.

Step 5

update-source type interface-id

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update-source TenGige 
0/0/05

Allows sessions to use the primary IP address from a specific interface as the local address when forming a session with a neighbor.

The type and interface-id arguments specify the type and ID number of the interface. Use the CLI help (?) to see a list of all the possible interface types and their ID numbers.

Step 6

address-family ipv4 unicast

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast 

Specifies the IPv4 unicast address family unicast and enters address family configuration mode.

Step 7

Use the commit or end command.

commit - Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end - Prompts user to take one of these actions:

  • Yes - Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No - Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel - Remains in the configuration mode, without committing the configuration changes.

Remote AS

In the following task, Router B and Router C are configured as a remote BGP peers. Both Router B and Router C are in different autonomous systems.

A list is created with the autonomous system of the remote routers and the list is then configured under neighbor mode using remote-as-list command.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. as-list name
  4. neighbor address prefix
  5. remote-as-list name
  6. address-family ipv4 unicast
  7. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters the global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 10 

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

as-list name

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# as-list LIST-1
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-as-list)#200
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-as-list)#300
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-as-list)#end

Specifies a list of remote autonomous systems under BGP mode.

Note

 
The autonomous system numbers configured under as-list must be different from the router autonomous system number.

Step 4

neighbor address prefix

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.0/16

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the BGP dynamic neighbor within the subnet range.

Step 5

remote-as-list name

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as-list LIST-1

Applies the configured as-list to the neighbor range.

Note

 
The remote-as and remote-as-list commands cannot be configured under a given mode at the same time.

Note

 
This command is applicable only to dynamic neighbor ranges and will be accepted under the following modes – neighbor, neighbor-group and session-group.

Step 6

address-family ipv4 unicast

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast 
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# 

Specifies the IPv4 address family unicast and enters address family configuration mode.

Step 7

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Maximum-peers and Idle-watch timeout

In the below task, maximum-peers and idle-watch timeout commands are configured for a remote BGP peer.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor address prefix
  4. maximum-peers number
  5. idle-watch-time number
  6. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters the global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 10 

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor address prefix

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.0/16

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the BGP dynamic neighbor within the subnet range.

Step 4

maximum-peers number

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# maximum-peers 16

This is used to configure an upper limit on the number of dynamic neighbor instances allowed under a range.

Range for the maximum number of peers is 1 to 4095.

Step 5

idle-watch-time number

Example:
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# idle-watch-time 120

Configures the time to wait before deleting an idle TCP instance.

Step 6

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Inbound Soft Reset

Perform this task to trigger an inbound soft reset of the specified address families for the specified group or neighbors. The group is specified by the * , ip-address , as-number , or external keywords and arguments.

Resetting neighbors is useful if you change the inbound policy for the neighbors or any other configuration that affects the sending or receiving of routing updates. If an inbound soft reset is triggered, BGP sends a REFRESH request to the neighbor if the neighbor has advertised the ROUTE_REFRESH capability. To determine whether the neighbor has advertised the ROUTE_REFRESH capability, use the show bgp neighbors command.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. show bgp neighbors
  2. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } soft  [ in [ prefix-filter ] | out ]

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

show bgp neighbors

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors

Verifies that received route refresh capability from the neighbor is enabled.

Step 2

clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } soft  [ in [ prefix-filter ] | out ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast 10.0.0.1 soft in

Soft resets a BGP neighbor.

  • The * keyword resets all BGP neighbors.

  • The ip-address argument specifies the address of the neighbor to be reset.

  • The as-number argument specifies that all neighbors that match the autonomous system number be reset.

  • The external keyword specifies that all external neighbors are reset.

Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Outbound Soft Reset

Perform this task to trigger an outbound soft reset of the specified address families for the specified group or neighbors. The group is specified by the * , ip-address , as-number , or external keywords and arguments.

Resetting neighbors is useful if you change the outbound policy for the neighbors or any other configuration that affects the sending or receiving of routing updates.

If an outbound soft reset is triggered, BGP resends all routes for the address family to the given neighbors.

To determine whether the neighbor has advertised the ROUTE_REFRESH capability, use the show bgp neighbors command.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. show bgp neighbors
  2. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } clear bgp { ipv4 | ipv6} { unicast | labeled-unicast } soft  [ in [ prefix-filter ] | ]

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

show bgp neighbors

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors

Verifies that received route refresh capability from the neighbor is enabled.

Step 2

clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } clear bgp { ipv4 | ipv6} { unicast | labeled-unicast } soft  [ in [ prefix-filter ] | ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast 10.0.0.2 soft out

Soft resets a BGP neighbor.

  • The * keyword resets all BGP neighbors.

  • The ip-address argument specifies the address of the neighbor to be reset.

  • The as-number argument specifies that all neighbors that match the autonomous system number be reset.

  • The external keyword specifies that all external neighbors are reset.

Resetting Neighbors Using BGP Hard Reset

Perform this task to reset neighbors using a hard reset. A hard reset removes the TCP connection to the neighbor, removes all routes received from the neighbor from the BGP table, and then re-establishes the session with the neighbor. If the graceful keyword is specified, the routes from the neighbor are not removed from the BGP table immediately, but are marked as stale. After the session is re-established, any stale route that has not been received again from the neighbor is removed.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } | { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } [ graceful ] soft  [ in [ prefix-filter ] | out ] clear bgp { ipv4 | ipv6} { unicast | labeled-unicast }

DETAILED STEPS

Command or Action Purpose

clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } | { * | ip-address | as as-number | external } [ graceful ] soft  [ in [ prefix-filter ] | out ] clear bgp { ipv4 | ipv6} { unicast | labeled-unicast }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 unicast 10.0.0.3 graceful soft out

Clears a BGP neighbor.

  • The * keyword resets all BGP neighbors.

  • The ip-address argument specifies the address of the neighbor to be reset.

  • The as-number argument specifies that all neighbors that match the autonomous system number be reset.

  • The external keyword specifies that all external neighbors are reset.

The graceful keyword specifies a graceful restart.

Clearing Caches, Tables, and Databases

Perform this task to remove all contents of a particular cache, table, or database. The clear bgp command resets the sessions of the specified group of neighbors (hard reset); it removes the TCP connection to the neighbor, removes all routes received from the neighbor from the BGP table, and then re-establishes the session with the neighbor. Clearing a cache, table, or database can become necessary when the contents of the particular structure have become, or are suspected to be, invalid.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } ip-address
  2. clear bgp external
  3. clear bgp *

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

clear bgp { ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 unicast | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } { ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast } ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp ipv4 172.20.1.1

Clears a specified neighbor.

Step 2

clear bgp external

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp external

Clears all external peers.

Step 3

clear bgp *

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# clear bgp *

Clears all BGP neighbors.

Displaying System and Network Statistics

Perform this task to display specific statistics, such as the contents of BGP routing tables, caches, and databases. Information provided can be used to determine resource usage and solve network problems. You can also display information about node reachability and discover the routing path that the packets of your device are taking through the network.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. show bgp cidr-only
  2. show bgp community community-list [ exact-match ]
  3. show bgp regexp regular-expression
  4. show bgp
  5. show bgp neighbors ip-address [ advertised-routes | dampened-routes | flap-statistics | performance-statistics | received prefix-filter | routes ]
  6. show bgp paths
  7. show bgp neighbor-group group-name configuration
  8. show bgp summary

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

show bgp cidr-only

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp cidr-only

Displays routes with nonnatural network masks (classless interdomain routing [CIDR]) routes.

Step 2

show bgp community community-list [ exact-match ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp community 1081:5 exact-match

Displays routes that match the specified BGP community.

Step 3

show bgp regexp regular-expression

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp regexp "^3 "

Displays routes that match the specified autonomous system path regular expression.

Step 4

show bgp

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp

Displays entries in the BGP routing table.

Step 5

show bgp neighbors ip-address [ advertised-routes | dampened-routes | flap-statistics | performance-statistics | received prefix-filter | routes ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbors 10.0.101.1

Displays information about the BGP connection to the specified neighbor.

  • The advertised-routes keyword displays all routes the router advertised to the neighbor.

  • The dampened-routes keyword displays the dampened routes that are learned from the neighbor.

  • The flap-statistics keyword displays flap statistics of the routes learned from the neighbor.

  • The performance-statistics keyword displays performance statistics relating to work done by the BGP process for this neighbor.

  • The received prefix-filter keyword and argument display the received prefix list filter.

  • The routes keyword displays routes learned from the neighbor.

Step 6

show bgp paths

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp paths

Displays all BGP paths in the database.

Step 7

show bgp neighbor-group group-name configuration

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp neighbor-group group_1 configuration

Displays the effective configuration for a specified neighbor group, including any configuration inherited by this neighbor group.

Step 8

show bgp summary

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp summary

Displays the status of all BGP connections.

Displaying BGP Process Information

Perform this task to display specific BGP process information.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. show bgp process
  2. show bgp ipv4 unicast summary
  3. show bgp vpnv4 unicast summary
  4. show bgp vrf ( vrf-name | all }
  5. show bgp process detail
  6. show bgp summary
  7. show placement program bgp
  8. show placement program brib

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

show bgp process

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp process

Displays status and summary information for the BGP process. The output shows various global and address family-specific BGP configurations. A summary of the number of neighbors, update messages, and notification messages sent and received by the process is also displayed.

Step 2

show bgp ipv4 unicast summary

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp ipv4 unicast summary

Displays a summary of the neighbors for the IPv4 unicast address family.

Step 3

show bgp vpnv4 unicast summary

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vpnv4 unicast summary

Displays a summary of the neighbors for the VPNv4 unicast address family.

Step 4

show bgp vrf ( vrf-name | all }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp vrf vrf_A

Displays BGP VPN virtual routing and forwarding (VRF) information.

Step 5

show bgp process detail

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp processes detail

Displays detailed process information including the memory used by each of various internal structure types.

Step 6

show bgp summary

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp summary

Displays the status of all BGP connections.

Step 7

show placement program bgp

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show placement program bgp

Displays BGP program information.

  • If a program is shown as having ‘rejected locations’ (for example, locations where program cannot be placed), the locations in question can be viewed using the show placement program bgp command.

  • If a program has been placed but not started, the amount of elapsed time since the program was placed is displayed in the Waiting to start column.

Step 8

show placement program brib

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show placement program brib

Displays bRIB program information.

  • If a program is shown as having ‘rejected locations’ (for example, locations where program cannot be placed), the locations in question can be viewed using the show placement program bgp command.

  • If a program has been placed but not started, the amount of elapsed time since the program was placed is displayed in the Waiting to start column.

Monitoring BGP Update Groups

This task displays information related to the processing of BGP update groups.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 { unicast | all } | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 unicast ] update-group [ neighbor ip-address | process-id.index [ summary | performance-statistics ]]

DETAILED STEPS

Command or Action Purpose

show bgp [ ipv4 { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | ipv6 { unicast | all } | all { unicast | multicast | all | tunnel } | vpnv4 unicast | vrf { vrf-name | all } [ ipv4 unicast ] update-group [ neighbor ip-address | process-id.index [ summary | performance-statistics ]]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# show bgp update-group 0.0

Displays information about BGP update groups.

  • The ip-address argument displays the update groups to which that neighbor belongs.

  • The process-id.index argument selects a particular update group to display and is specified as follows: process ID (dot) index. Process ID range is from 0 to 254. Index range is from 0 to 4294967295.

  • The summary keyword displays summary information for neighbors in a particular update group.

  • If no argument is specified, this command displays information for all update groups (for the specified address family).

  • The performance-statistics keyword displays performance statistics for an update group.

Configuring BGP Nonstop Routing

BGP Nonstop Routing (BGP NSR) is enabled by default. The no nsr disable command can also be used to turn BGP NSR back on if it has been disabled.

Disable BGP Nonstop Routing

Perform this task to disable BGP Nonstop Routing (NSR):

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. nsr disable
  4. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the BGP AS number, and enters the BGP configuration mode, for configuring BGP routing processes.

Step 3

nsr disable

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# nsr disable

Disables BGP Nonstop routing.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Re-enable BGP Nonstop Routing

If BGP Nonstop Routing (NSR) is disabled, use the following steps to turn BGP NSR back on using the following steps:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. no nsr disable
  4. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the BGP AS number, and enters the BGP configuration mode, for configuring BGP routing processes.

Step 3

no nsr disable

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# nsr disable

Enables BGP Nonstop routing.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Installing Primary Backup Path for Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC)

Perform the following tasks to install a backup path into the forwarding table and provide prefix independent convergence (PIC) in case of a PE-CE link failure:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. Do one of the following
    • address-family {vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }
    • vrf vrf-name {ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast }
  4. additional-paths selection route-policy route-policy-name
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

Do one of the following

  • address-family {vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }
  • vrf vrf-name {ipv4 unicast | ipv6 unicast }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast

Specifies the address family or VRF address family and enters the address family or VRF address family configuration submode.

Step 4

additional-paths selection route-policy route-policy-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# additional-paths selection route-policy ap1
Configures additional paths selection mode for a prefix.

Note

 

Use the additional-paths selection command with an appropriate route-policy to calculate backup paths and to enable Prefix Independent Convergence (PIC) functionality.

The route-policy configuration is a pre-requisite for configuring the additional-paths selection mode for a prefix . This is an example route-policy configuration to use with additional-selection command:
route-policy ap1
    set path-selection backup 1 install
  end-policy

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Retaining Allocated Local Label for Primary Path

Perform the following tasks to retain the previously allocated local label for the primary path on the primary PE for some configurable time after reconvergence:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }
  4. retain local-label minutes
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast

Specifies the address family and enters the address family configuration submode.

Step 4

retain local-label minutes

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# retain local-label 10

Retains the previously allocated local label for the primary path on the primary PE for 10 minutes after reconvergence.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring BGP Additional Paths

Perform these tasks to configure BGP Additional Paths capability:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. route-policy route-policy-name
  3. if conditional-expression then action-statement else
  4. pass endif
  5. end-policy
  6. router bgp as-number
  7. as-league peers as-number
  8. address-family {ipv4 {unicast | multicast } | ipv6 {unicast | multicast | l2vpn vpls-vpws | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }
  9. additional-paths receive
  10. additional-paths send
  11. additional-paths selection route-policy route-policy-name
  12. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

route-policy route-policy-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router (config)#route-policy add_path_policy

Defines the route policy and enters route-policy configuration mode.

Step 3

if conditional-expression then action-statement else

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router (config-rpl)#if community matches-any (*) then
    set path-selection all advertise
  else

Decides the actions and dispositions for the given route.

Step 4

pass endif

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-else)#pass
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl-else)#endif

Passes the route for processing and ends the if statement.

Step 5

end-policy

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#end-policy

Ends the route policy definition of the route policy and exits route-policy configuration mode.

Step 6

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 7

as-league peers as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#as-league peers
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-as-league-peers)# 6200

Configures a group of peer autonomous systems (AS) that will be used under common administration or a trusted relationship.

Step 8

address-family {ipv4 {unicast | multicast } | ipv6 {unicast | multicast | l2vpn vpls-vpws | vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies the address family and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 9

additional-paths receive

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#additional-paths receive

Configures receive capability of multiple paths for a prefix to the capable peers.

Step 10

additional-paths send

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#additional-paths send

Configures send capability of multiple paths for a prefix to the capable peers .

Step 11

additional-paths selection route-policy route-policy-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#additional-paths selection route-policy add_path_policy

Configures additional paths selection capability for a prefix.

Step 12

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring iBGP Multipath Load Sharing

Perform this task to configure the iBGP Multipath Load Sharing:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family {ipv4 |ipv6 } {unicast |multicast }
  4. maximum-paths ibgp number
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family {ipv4 |ipv6 } {unicast |multicast }

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 multicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 4

maximum-paths ibgp number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths ibgp 30

Configures the maximum number of iBGP paths for load sharing.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Originating Prefixes with AiGP

Perform this task to configure origination of routes with the AiGP metric:

Before you begin

Origination of routes with the accumulated interior gateway protocol (AiGP) metric is controlled by configuration. AiGP attributes are attached to redistributed routes that satisfy following conditions:

  • The protocol redistributing the route is enabled for AiGP.

  • The route is an interior gateway protocol (iGP) route redistributed into border gateway protocol (BGP). The value assigned to the AiGP attribute is the value of iGP next hop to the route or as set by a route-policy.

  • The route is a static route redistributed into BGP. The value assigned is the value of next hop to the route or as set by a route-policy.

  • The route is imported into BGP through network statement. The value assigned is the value of next hop to the route or as set by a route-policy.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. route-policy aigp_policy
  3. set aigp-metric igp-cost
  4. exit
  5. router bgp as-number
  6. address-family {ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  7. redistribute ospf osp route-policy plcy_name metric value
  8. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

route-policy aigp_policy

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy aip_policy

Enters route-policy configuration mode and sets the route-policy

Step 3

set aigp-metric igp-cost

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set aigp-metric igp-cost

Sets the internal routing protocol cost as the aigp metric.

Step 4

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# exit

Exits route-policy configuration mode.

Step 5

router bgp as-number

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the BGP AS number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 6

address-family {ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either the IPv4 or IPv6 address family and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 7

redistribute ospf osp route-policy plcy_name metric value

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)#redistribute ospf osp route-policy aigp_policy metric 1

Allows the redistribution of AiBGP metric into OSPF.

Step 8

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring BGP Accept Own

Perform this task to configure BGP Accept Own:

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. update-source type interface-path-id
  6. address-family {vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }
  7. accept-own [inheritance-disable ]

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:

Router(config)#router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:

Router(config-bgp)#neighbor 10.1.2.3

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:

Router(config-bgp-nbr)#remote-as 100

Assigns a remote autonomous system number to the neighbor.

Step 5

update-source type interface-path-id

Example:

Router(config-bgp-nbr)#update-source Loopback0

Allows sessions to use the primary IP address from a specific interface as the local address when forming a session with a neighbor.

Step 6

address-family {vpnv4 unicast | vpnv6 unicast }

Example:

Router(config-bgp-nbr)#address-family vpnv6 unicast

Specifies the address family as VPNv4 or VPNv6 and enters neighbor address family configuration mode.

Step 7

accept-own [inheritance-disable ]

Example:

Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)#accept-own

Enables handling of self-originated VPN routes containing Accept_Own community.

Use the inheritance-disable keyword to disable the "accept own" configuration and to prevent inheritance of "acceptown" from a parent configuration.

Configuring BGP Permanent Network

Configuring BGP Permanent Network

Perform this task to configure BGP permanent network. You must configure at least one route-policy to identify the set of prefixes (networks) for which the permanent network (path) is to be configured.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. prefix-set prefix-set-name
  3. exit
  4. route-policy route-policy-name
  5. end-policy
  6. router bgp as-number
  7. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  8. permanent-network route-policy route-policy-name
  9. Use the commit or end command.
  10. show bgp {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast prefix-set

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

prefix-set prefix-set-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# prefix-set PERMANENT-NETWORK-IPv4
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# 1.1.1.1/32,
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# 2.2.2.2/32,
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# 3.3.3.3/32
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# end-set

Enters prefix set configuration mode and defines a prefix set for contiguous and non-contiguous set of bits.

Step 3

exit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# exit

Exits prefix set configuration mode and enters global configuration mode.

Step 4

route-policy route-policy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy POLICY-PERMANENT-NETWORK-IPv4
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if destination in PERMANENT-NETWORK-IPv4 then
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# pass
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# endif
 

Creates a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode, where you can define the route policy.

Step 5

end-policy

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

Ends the definition of a route policy and exits route policy configuration mode.

Step 6

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode.

Step 7

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 8

permanent-network route-policy route-policy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# permanent-network route-policy POLICY-PERMANENT-NETWORK-IPv4

Configures the permanent network (path) for the set of prefixes as defined in the route-policy.

Step 9

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 10

show bgp {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast prefix-set

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp ipv4 unicast 

(Optional) Displays whether the prefix-set is a permanent network in BGP.

How to Advertise Permanent Network

Perform this task to identify the peers to whom the permanent paths must be advertised.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  6. advertise permanent-network
  7. Use the commit or end command.
  8. show bgp {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast neighbor ip-address

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.255.255.254

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 4713

Assigns the neighbor a remote autonomous system number.

Step 5

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 6

advertise permanent-network

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# advertise permanent-network

Specifies the peers to whom the permanent network (path) is advertised.

Step 7

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 8

show bgp {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp ipv4 unicast neighbor 10.255.255.254

(Optional) Displays whether the neighbor is capable of receiving BGP permanent networks.

Enabling BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing

Perform this task to enable unequal cost recursive load balancing for external BGP (eBGP), interior BGP (iBGP), and eiBGP and to enable BGP to carry link bandwidth attribute of the demilitarized zone (DMZ) link.

When the PE router includes the link bandwidth extended community in its updates to the remote PE through the Multiprotocol Interior BGP (MP-iBGP) session (either IPv4 or VPNv4), the remote PE automatically does load balancing if the maximum-paths command is enabled.

Unequal cost recursive load balancing happens across maximum eight paths only.


Note


Enabling BGP unequal cost recursive load balancing feature is not supported on CPP based cards.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  4. maximum-paths { ebgp | ibgp | eibgp } maximum [ unequal-cost ]
  5. exit
  6. neighbor ip-address
  7. dmz-link-bandwidth
  8. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 120

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

To see a list of all the possible keywords and arguments for this command, use the CLI help (?).

Step 4

maximum-paths { ebgp | ibgp | eibgp } maximum [ unequal-cost ]

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# maximum-paths ebgp 3

Configures the maximum number of parallel routes that BGP installs in the routing table.

Note

 
  • Valid values for maximum-paths are 8 for ASR 9000 Ethernet Line Card and 32 for ASR 9000 Enhanced Ethernet Line Card.

  • The ASR 9000 Ethernet Line Card limits the number of routes to be installed to 8 in the forwarding hardware even though the maximum-path value configured is more than 8.

  • ebgp maximum : Consider only eBGP paths for multipath.

  • ibgp maximum [ unequal-cost ]: Consider load balancing between iBGP learned paths.

  • eibgp maximum : Consider both eBGP and iBGP learned paths for load balancing. eiBGP load balancing always does unequal-cost load balancing.

When eiBGP is applied, eBGP or iBGP load balancing cannot be configured; however, eBGP and iBGP load balancing can coexist.

Step 5

exit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# exit

Exits the current configuration mode.

Step 6

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.0

Configures a CE neighbor. The ip-address argument must be a private address.

Step 7

dmz-link-bandwidth

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# dmz-link-bandwidth

Originates a demilitarized-zone (DMZ) link-bandwidth extended community for the link to an eBGP/iBGP neighbor.

Step 8

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Configuring VRF Dynamic Route Leaking

Perform these steps to import routes from default-VRF to non-default VRF or to import routes from non-default VRF to default VRF.

Before you begin

A route-policy is mandatory for configuring dynamic route leaking. Use the route-policy route-policy-name command in global configuration mode to configure a route-policy.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. vrf vrf_name
  3. address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast
  4. Use one of these options:
    • import from default-vrf route-policy route-policy-name [ advertise-as-vpn]
    • export to default-vrf route-policy route-policy-name
  5. Use the commit or end command.

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

vrf vrf_name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE51_ASR-9010(config)#vrf vrf_1

Enters VRF configuration mode.

Step 3

address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf)#address-family ipv6 unicast

Enters VRF address-family configuration mode.

Step 4

Use one of these options:

  • import from default-vrf route-policy route-policy-name [ advertise-as-vpn]
  • export to default-vrf route-policy route-policy-name

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)#import from default-vrf route-policy rpl_dynamic_route_import

or

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-vrf-af)#export to default-vrf route-policy rpl_dynamic_route_export
Imports routes from default-VRF to non-default VRF or from non-default VRF to default-VRF.
  • import from default-vrf —configures import from default-VRF to non-default-VRF.

    If the advertise-as-vpn option is configured, the paths imported from the default-VRF to the non-default-VRF are advertised to the PEs as well as to the CEs. If the advertise-as-vpn option is not configured, the paths imported from the default-VRF to the non-default-VRF are not advertised to the PE. However, the paths are still advertised to the CEs.

  • export to default-vrf —configures import from non-default-VRF to default VRF. The paths imported from the default-VRF are advertised to other PEs.

Step 5

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

What to do next

These show bgp command output displays information from the dynamic route leaking configuration:

  • Use the show bgp prefix command to display the source-RD and the source-VRF for imported paths, including the cases when IPv4 or IPv6 unicast prefixes have imported paths.

  • Use the show bgp imported-routes command to display IPv4 unicast and IPv6 unicast address-families under the default-VRF.

Enabling Selective VRF Download

To enable selective VRF download, configure the svd platform enable command followed by router reload.

Note


Selective VRF download is disabled by default.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. admin
  2. configure
  3. svd platform enable
  4. Use the commit or end command.
  5. show svd state
  6. admin
  7. reload location all
  8. exit
  9. show svd role

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

admin

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin 

Enters administration EXEC mode.

Step 2

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#configure

Enters Administrative configuration mode.

Step 3

svd platform enable

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin-config)#svd platform enable

Enables selective VRF download.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 5

show svd state

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show svd state
Selective VRF Download (SVD) Feature State:
SVD Configuration State        Enabled
SVD Operational State          Enabled

Displays Selective VRF download feature state information.

Step 6

admin

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#admin

Enters administrator mode.

Step 7

reload location all

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#reload loc all
Tue Feb 12 07:51:25.279 UTC

Preparing system for backup. This may take a few minutes especially for large
configurations.
        Status report: node0_RSP0_CPU0: START TO BACKUP
        Status report: node0_RSP0_CPU0: BACKUP HAS COMPLETED SUCCESSFULLY
[Done]
Proceed with reload? [confirm]RP/0/RSP0/CPU0::This node received reload

Reloads the chassis.

Step 8

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#exit

Exits administrator mode and enters EXEC mode.

Step 9

show svd role

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show svd role
Tue Feb 12 07:50:26.908 UTC

Codes: (C) : user Configured role
Node Name       IPv4 Role                 IPv6 Role
--------------------------------------------------------------------
0/RSP0/CPU0     Standard                  Standard
0/0/CPU0        Customer Facing           Not Interested
0/1/CPU0        Customer Facing           Not Interested

Verifies if selective VRF download is active by confirming that svd roles are "customer facing" for the line cards that have VRF interfaces on them.

What to do next

After enabling SVD using the svd platform enable command, do not use the selective-vrf-download disable to turn off SVD.

Disabling Selective VRF Download

Selective VRF Download is disabled by default. However, if the SVD is enabled, perform these tasks to disable the functionality.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. admin
  2. configure
  3. no svd platform enable
  4. Use the commit or end command.
  5. show svd state
  6. admin
  7. reload location all
  8. exit
  9. show svd role

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

admin

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# admin 

Enters administration EXEC mode.

Step 2

configure

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#configure

Enters Administrative configuration mode.

Step 3

no svd platform enable

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:PE51_ASR-9010(admin-config)#no svd platform enable

Disables Selective VRF Download.

Step 4

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 5

show svd state

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show svd state
Selective VRF Download (SVD) Feature State:
SVD Configuration State        Unsupported
SVD Operational State          Unsupported

Displays Selective VRF download feature state information.

Step 6

admin

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#admin

Enters administrator mode.

Step 7

reload location all

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#reload loc all
Tue Feb 12 07:51:25.279 UTC

Preparing system for backup. This may take a few minutes especially for large
configurations.
        Status report: node0_RSP0_CPU0: START TO BACKUP
        Status report: node0_RSP0_CPU0: BACKUP HAS COMPLETED SUCCESSFULLY
[Done]
Proceed with reload? [confirm]RP/0/RSP0/CPU0::This node received reload

Reloads the chassis.

Step 8

exit

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(admin)#exit

Exits administrator mode and enters EXEC mode.

Step 9

show svd role

Example:

RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router#show svd role

Codes: (C) : user Configured role
Node Name       IPv4 Role                 IPv6 Role
--------------------------------------------------------------------
0/RSP0/CPU0     Standard                  Standard
0/0/CPU0        Standard                  Standard
0/1/CPU0        Standard                  Standard

Verifies if selective VRF download is inactive by confirming that svd roles are "standard" for the line cards that have VRF interfaces on them.

Configuring Resilient Per-CE Label Mode

Configuring Resilient Per-CE Label Mode Under VRF Address Family

Perform this task to configure resilient per-ce label mode under VRF address family.


Note


Resilient per-CE 6PE label allocation is not supported on CRS-1 and CRS-3 routers, but supported only on ASR 9000 routers.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgpas-number
  3. vrfvrf-instance
  4. address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast
  5. label mode per-ce
  6. Do one of the following:
    • end
    • commit

DETAILED STEPS


Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgpas-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 666
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)#

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode, allowing you to configure the BGP routing process.

Step 3

vrfvrf-instance

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf-pe
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)#

Configures a VRF instance.

Step 4

address-family {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)#

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 5

label mode per-ce

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# label mode per-ce
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)#

Configures resilient per-ce label mode.

Step 6

Do one of the following:

  • end
  • commit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# end

or


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# commit

Saves configuration changes.

  • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes:

    
      Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]:
    • Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode.

    • Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes.

    • Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes.

  • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session.


Configuring Resilient Per-CE Label Mode Using a Route-Policy

Perform this task to configure resilient per-ce label mode using a route-policy.


Note


Resilient per-CE 6PE label allocation is not supported on CRS-1 and CRS-3 routers, but supported only on ASR 9000 routers.


SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. route-policypolicy-name
  3. set label mode per-ce
  4. Do one of the following:
    • end
    • commit

DETAILED STEPS


Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)#

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

route-policypolicy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy route1
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#

Creates a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode.

Step 3

set label mode per-ce

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set label mode per-ce
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#

Configures resilient per-ce label mode.

Step 4

Do one of the following:

  • end
  • commit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end

or


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# commit

Saves configuration changes.

  • When you issue the end command, the system prompts you to commit changes:

    
      Uncommitted changes found, commit them before exiting(yes/no/cancel)?[cancel]:
    • Entering yes saves configuration changes to the running configuration file, exits the configuration session, and returns the router to EXEC mode.

    • Entering no exits the configuration session and returns the router to EXEC mode without committing the configuration changes.

    • Entering cancel leaves the router in the current configuration session without exiting or committing the configuration changes.

  • Use the commit command to save the configuration changes to the running configuration file and remain within the configuration session.


Configuring Inter-AS Option B Per Next-Hop Label Allocation

In an Inter-AS Option B network, ASBR peers are connected by one or more interfaces that are enabled to receive MPLS traffic. ASBR allocates labels on a per-prefix basis. For each prefix received, the ASBR allocates a label. This behavior results in faster consumption of the label space in the ASBR.

In the following topology, both provider edge (PE) devices are configured using the per-VRF label allocation. PE1 and PE2 are advertising routes for networks (N) with labels (L) to ASBR1. PE1 sends [N1, L1] and [N2, L1] to ASBR1. PE2 sends [N3, L2] and [N4, L2] to ASBR1. Per-prefix label allocation mode is enabled on ASBR1 by default, so it allocates a unique label for each network and advertises [N1, L3], [N2, L4], [N3, L5] and [N4, L6] to ASBR2. The PEs (PE1 and PE2) allocated 2 labels, and ASBR1 allocated 4 labels.

The Inter-AS Option B Per Next-Hop Label Allocation feature introduces a new per next-hop label allocation method for Inter-AS Option-B networks. This allocation method allows the same ASBR label to be allocated for multiple prefixes.

In the following topology, both provider edge (PE) devices are configured using the per-VRF label allocation. PE1 and PE2 are advertising routes for networks (N) with labels (L) to ASBR1. PE1 sends [N1, L1] and [N2, L1] to ASBR1. PE2 sends [N3, L2] and [N4, L2] to ASBR1. With Per Next-Hop Label Allocation, ASBR1 allocates a label per PE next hop and received label. ASBR1 sends [N1, L3], [N2, L3], [N3, L4] and [N4, L4] to ASBR2. The PEs (PE1 and PE2) allocated 2 labels, and ASBR1 allocated 2 labels. The Inter-AS Option B Per Next-Hop Label Allocation feature uses two fewer labels than the current implementation.


Note


It is recommended not to configure the label allocation mode in the route reflector with next-hop-self. For the eBGP backup path, the label mode falls back to per-prefix label mode, though the configured mode is per-nexthop-received-label.


Configuration

The following configuration shows how to enable Inter-AS Option B Per Next-Hop Label Allocation.

RP/0/0/CPU0:ASBR1(config)# router bgp 100
RP/0/0/CPU0:ASBR1(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv4 unicast
RP/0/0/CPU0:ASBR1(config-bgp-af)# label mode per-nexthop-received-label
RP/0/0/CPU0:ASBR1(config-bgp-af)# exit
RP/0/0/CPU0:ASBR1(config-bgp)# address-family vpnv6 unicast
RP/0/0/CPU0:ASBR1(config-bgp-af)# label mode per-nexthop-received-label

Running Configuration

Validate the configuration.


router bgp 100
 bgp router-id 2.2.2.2
 address-family vpnv4 unicast
  label mode per-nexthop-received-label
  retain route-target all
 !
 address-family vpnv6 unicast
  label mode per-nexthop-received-label
  retain route-target all
 !

Configuring BGP Large Communities

BGP communities provide a way to group destinations and apply routing decisions such as acceptance, rejection, preference, or redistribution on a group of destinations using community attributes. BGP community attributes are variable length attributes consisting of a set of one or more 4-byte values which are split into two parts of 16 bits. The higher-order 16 bits represents the AS number and the lower order bits represents a locally defined value assigned by the operator of the AS.

Since the adoption of 4-byte ASNs (RFC6793), the BGP communities attribute can no longer accommodate the 4 byte ASNs as you need more than 4 bytes to encode the 4-byte ASN and an AS specific value that you want to tag with the route. Although BGP extended community permits a 4-byte AS to be encoded as the global administrator field, the local administrator field has only 2-byte of available space. So, 6-byte extended community attribute is also unsuitable. To overcome this limitation, you can configure a 12-byte BGP large community which is an optional attribute that provides the most significant 4-byte value to encode autonomous system number as the global administrator and the remaining two 4-byte assigned numbers to encode the local values.

Similar to BGP communities, routers can apply BGP large communities to BGP routes by using route policy languages (RPL) and other routers can then perform actions based on the community that is attached to the route. The policy language provides sets as a container for groups of values for matching purposes.

When large communities are specified in other commands, they are specified as three non negative decimal integers separated by colons. For example, 1:2:3. Each integer is stored in 32 bits. The possible range for each integer is 0 to 4294967295.

In route-policy statements, each integer in the BGP large community can be replaced by any of the following expressions :

  • [x..y] — This expression specifies a range between x and y, inclusive.

  • * —This expression stands for any number.

  • peeras — This expression is replaced by the AS number of the neigbhor from which the community is received or to which the community is sent, as appropriate.

  • not-peeras —This expression matches any number other than the peeras.

  • private-as — This expression specifies any number in the private ASN range: [64512..65534] and [4200000000..4294967294].

These expressions can be also used in policy-match statements.

IOS regular expression (ios-regex) and DFA style regular expression (dfa-regex) can be used in any of the large-community policy match and delete statements. For example, the IOS regular expression ios-regex '^5:.*:7$' is equivalent to the expression 5:*:7.

The send-community-ebgp command is extended to include BGP large communities. This command is required for the BGP speaker to send large communities to ebgp neighbors.

For more information about BGP communities, extended communities, and route policy language, see the following link: https://www.cisco.com/c/en/us/td/docs/routers/asr9000/software/asr9k-r6-2/routing/configuration/guide/b-routing-cg-asr9000-62x/b-routing-cg-asr9000-62x_chapter_01011.html

Restrictions and Guidelines

The following restrictions and guidelines apply for BGP large communities:

  • All functionalities of the BGP community attribute is available for the BGP large-community attribute.

  • The send-community-ebgp command is required for the BGP speaker to send large communities to ebgp neighbors.

  • There are no well-known large-communities.

  • The peeras expression cannot be used in a large-community-set.

  • The peeras expression can only be used in large-community match or delete statements that appear in route policies that are applied at the neighbor-in or neighbor-out attach points.

  • The not-peeras expression cannot be used in a large-community-set or in policy set statements.

Configuration Example: Large Community Set

A large-community set defines a set of large communities. Named large-community sets are used in route-policy match and set statements.

This example shows how to create a named large-community set.

RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# large-community-set catbert
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-largecomm)#  1: 2: 3,
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-largecomm)#  peeras:2:3
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-largecomm)# end-set 

Configuration Example: Set Large Community

The following example shows how to set the BGP large community attribute in a route, using the set large-community {large-community-set-name | inline-large-community-set | parameter } [additive ] command. You can specify a named large-community-set or an inline set. The additive keyword retains the large communities already present in the route and adds the new set of large communities. However the additive keyword does not result in duplicate entries.

If a particular large community is attached to a route and you specify the same large community again with the additive keyword in the set statement, then the specified large community is not added again. The merging operation removes duplicate entries. This also applies to the peeras keyword.

The peeras expression in the example is replaced by the AS number of the neighbor from which the BGP large community is received or to which the community is sent, as appropriate.

RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy mordac 
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set large-community (1:2:3, peeras:2:3)
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-set
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# large-community-set catbert
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-largecomm)#  1: 2: 3,
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-largecomm)#  peeras:2:3
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-largecomm)# end-set
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy wally
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set large-community catbert additive 
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-set

In this example, if the route-policy mordac is applied to a neighbor, the ASN of which is 1, then the large community (1:2:3) is set only once.


Note


You should configure the send-community-ebgp command to send large communities to ebgp neighbors.


Configuration Example: Large Community Matches-any

The following example shows how to configure a route policy to match any element of a large -community set. This is a boolean condition and returns true if any of the large communities in the route match any of the large communities in the match condition.

RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy elbonia
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if large-community matches-any (1:2:3, 4:5:*) then
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#   set local-preference 94
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#  endif
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

Configuration Example: Large Community Matches-every

The following example shows how to configure a route policy where every match specification in the statement must be matched by at least one large community in the route.

RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy bob
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if large-community matches-every (*:*:3, 4:5:*) then
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#   set local-preference 94
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#  endif
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

In this example, routes with these sets of large communities return TRUE:

  • (1:1:3, 4:5:10)

  • (4:5:3) —This single large community matches both specifications.

  • (1:1:3, 4:5:10, 7:6:5)

Routes with the following set of large communities return FALSE:

(1:1:3, 5:5:10)—The specification (4:5:*) is not matched.

Configuration Example: Large Community Matches-within

The following example shows how to configure a route policy to match within a large community set. This is similar to the large-community matches-any command but every large community in the route must match at least one match specification. Note that if the route has no large communities, then it matches.

RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy bob
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if large-community matches-within (*:*:3, 4:5:*) then
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#   set local-preference 103
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#  endif
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

For example, routes with these sets of large communities return TRUE:

  • (1:1:3, 4:5:10)

  • (4:5:3)

  • (1:2:3, 6:6:3, 9:4:3)

Routes with this set of large communities return FALSE:

(1:1:3, 4:5:10, 7:6:5) —The large community (7:6:5) does not match

Configuration Example: Community Matches-within

The following example shows how to configure a route policy to match within the elements of a community set. This command is similar to the community matches-any command, but every community in the route must match at least one match specification. If the route has no communities, then it matches.

RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy bob
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if community matches-within (*:3, 5:*)  then
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#   set local-preference 94
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#  endif
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

For example, routes with these sets of communities return TRUE:

  • (1:3, 5:10)

  • (5:3)

  • (2:3, 6:3, 4:3)

Routes with this set of communities return FALSE:

(1:3, 5:10, 6:5) —The community (6:5) does not match.

Configuration Example: Large Community Is-empty

The following example shows using the large-community is-empty clause to filter routes that do not have the large-community attribute set.

RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy lrg_comm_rp4
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if large-community is-empty then
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#   set local-preference 104
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)#  endif
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

Configuration Example: Attribute Filter Group

The following example shows how to configure and apply the attribute-filter group with large-community attributes for a BGP neighbor. The filter specifies the BGP path attributes and an action to take when BGP update message is received. If an update message is received from the BGP neighbor that contains any of the specified attributes, then the specified action is taken. In this example, the attribute filter named dogbert is created and applied to the BGP neighbor 10.0.1.101. It specifies the large community attribute and the action of discard. That means, if the large community BGP path attribute is received in a BGP UPDATE message from the neighbor 10.0.1.101 then the attribute will be discarded before further processing of the message.


RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# attribute-filter group dogbert
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-attrfg)# attribute LARGE-COMMUNITY discard
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-attrfg)# neighbor 10.0.1.101
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 6461
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# update in filtering
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-nbr-upd-filter)# attribute-filter group dogbert

Configuration Example: Deleting Large Community

The following example shows how to delete specified BGP large-communities from a route policy using the delete large-community command.


RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy lrg_comm_rp2
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# delete large-community in (ios-regex '^100000:’)  
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# delete large-community all
RP/0/RP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# delete large-community not in (peeras:*:*, 41289:*:*)

Verification

This example displays the routes with large-communities given in the show bgp large-community list-of-large-communities [exact-match ] command. If the optional keyword exact-match is used, then the listed routes will contain only the specified large communities. Otherwise, the displayed routes may contain additional large communities.

RP/0/0/CPU0:R1# show bgp large-community 1:2:3 5:6:7
Thu Mar 23 14:40:33.597 PDT
BGP router identifier 4.4.4.4, local AS number 3
BGP generic scan interval 60 secs
Non-stop routing is enabled
BGP table state: Active
Table ID: 0xe0000000   RD version: 66
BGP main routing table version 66
BGP NSR Initial initsync version 3 (Reached)
BGP NSR/ISSU Sync-Group versions 66/0
BGP scan interval 60 secs

Status codes: s suppressed, d damped, h history, * valid, > best
              i - internal, r RIB-failure, S stale, N Nexthop-discard
Origin codes: i - IGP, e - EGP, ? - incomplete
   Network            Next Hop            Metric LocPrf Weight Path
* 10.0.0.3/32         10.10.10.3               0     94      0 ?
* 10.0.0.5/32         10.11.11.5               0             0 5 ?

This example displays the large community attached to a network using the show bgp ip-address/ prefix-length command.

RP/0/0/CPU0:R4# show bgp 10.3.3.3/32
Thu Mar 23 14:36:15.301 PDT
BGP routing table entry for 10.3.3.3/32
Versions:
  Process           bRIB/RIB  SendTblVer
  Speaker                 42          42
Last Modified: Mar 22 20:04:46.000 for 18:31:30
Paths: (1 available, best #1)
  Advertised to peers (in unique update groups):
    10.11.11.5
  Path #1: Received by speaker 0
  Advertised to peers (in unique update groups):
    10.11.11.5
  Local
    10.10.10.3 from 10.10.10.3 (10.3.3.3)
      Origin incomplete, metric 0, localpref 94, valid, internal, best, group-best
      Received Path ID 0, Local Path ID 0, version 42
      Community: 258:259 260:261 262:263 264:265
      Large Community: 1:2:3 5:6:7 4123456789:4123456780:4123456788

EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking on the DCI for Internet Connectivity

The EVPN Default VRF Route Leaking feature leak routes between the Default-VRF and Data Center-VRF on the DCI to provide Internet access to data center hosts.

This feature is enabled by:

  • Leaking routes from Default-VRF to Data Center-VRF

  • Leaking routes to Default-VRF from Data Center-VRF

Configuration Examples for Implementing BGP

This section provides the following configuration examples:

Enabling BGP: Example

The following shows how to enable BGP.


  prefix-set static
     2020::/64,
     2012::/64,
     10.10.0.0/16,
     10.2.0.0/24
  end-set
  
  route-policy pass-all
    pass
  end-policy
  route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v4
    set next-hop 10.0.0.1  
  end-policy
  
  route-policy set_next_hop_static_v4
    if (destination in static) then
      set next-hop 10.1.0.1
    else
      drop
    endif
  end-policy
  
  route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v6
    set next-hop 2003::121
  end-policy
  
  route-policy set_next_hop_static_v6
    if (destination in static) then
       set next-hop 2011::121
    else
       drop
    endif
  end-policy
  
  router bgp 65000
    bgp fast-external-fallover disable
    bgp confederation peers
      65001
      65002
    bgp confederation identifier 1
    bgp router-id 192.0.2.1
    address-family ipv4 unicast
      aggregate-address 10.2.0.0/24 route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v4
      aggregate-address 10.3.0.0/24 
      redistribute static route-policy set_next_hop_static_v4
    address-family ipv4 multicast
      aggregate-address 10.2.0.0/24 route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v4
      aggregate-address 10.3.0.0/24
      redistribute static route-policy set_next_hop_static_v4
    address-family ipv6 unicast
      aggregate-address 2012::/64 route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v6
      aggregate-address 2013::/64
      redistribute static route-policy set_next_hop_static_v6
    address-family ipv6 multicast
      aggregate-address 2012::/64 route-policy set_next_hop_agg_v6
      aggregate-address 2013::/64
      redistribute static route-policy set_next_hop_static_v6
    neighbor 10.0.101.60
      remote-as 65000
      address-family ipv4 unicast
      address-family ipv4 multicast
    neighbor 10.0.101.61
      remote-as 65000 
      address-family ipv4 unicast
      address-family ipv4 multicast
    neighbor 10.0.101.62
      remote-as 3
      address-family ipv4 unicast
        route-policy pass-all in
        route-policy pass-all out
      address-family ipv4 multicast
        route-policy pass-all in
        route-policy pass-all out
    neighbor 10.0.101.64
      remote-as 5
      update-source Loopback0
      address-family ipv4 unicast
        route-policy pass-all in
        route-policy pass-all out
      address-family ipv4 multicast
        route-policy pass-all in
        route-policy pass-all out
  

Displaying BGP Update Groups: Example

The following is sample output from the show bgp update-group command run in EXEC configuration mode:


  
 show bgp update-group
  
  Update group for IPv4 Unicast, index 0.1:
    Attributes:
      Outbound Route map:rm
      Minimum advertisement interval:30
    Messages formatted:2, replicated:2
    Neighbors in this update group:
      10.0.101.92
  
  Update group for IPv4 Unicast, index 0.2:
    Attributes:
      Minimum advertisement interval:30
    Messages formatted:2, replicated:2
    Neighbors in this update group:
      10.0.101.91
  

BGP Neighbor Configuration: Example

The following example shows how BGP neighbors on an autonomous system are configured to share information. In the example, a BGP router is assigned to autonomous system 109, and two networks are listed as originating in the autonomous system. Then the addresses of three remote routers (and their autonomous systems) are listed. The router being configured shares information about networks 172 .16 .0.0 and 192.168 .7.0 with the neighbor routers. The first router listed is in a different autonomous system; the second neighbor and remote-as commands specify an internal neighbor (with the same autonomous system number) at address 172 .26 .234.2; and the third neighbor and remote-as commands specify a neighbor on a different autonomous system.


  route-policy pass-all 
   pass
  end-policy
  router bgp 109
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    network 172.16.0.0 255.255.0.0
    network 192.168.7.0 255.255.0.0
    neighbor 172.16.200.1 
     remote-as 167
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    route-policy pass-all in
    route-policy pass-out out
    neighbor 172.26.234.2 
     remote-as 109
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 172.26.64.19 
     remote-as 99
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    route-policy pass-all in
    route-policy pass-all out
  

BGP Confederation: Example

The following is a sample configuration that shows several peers in a confederation. The confederation consists of three internal autonomous systems with autonomous system numbers 6001, 6002, and 6003. To the BGP speakers outside the confederation, the confederation looks like a normal autonomous system with autonomous system number 666 (specified using the bgp confederation identifier command).

In a BGP speaker in autonomous system 6001, the bgp confederation peers command marks the peers from autonomous systems 6002 and 6003 as special eBGP peers. Hence, peers 171.16 .232.55 and 171.16 .232.56 get the local preference, next hop, and MED unmodified in the updates. The router at 171 .19 .69.1 is a normal eBGP speaker, and the updates received by it from this peer are just like a normal eBGP update from a peer in autonomous system 666.


  router bgp 6001
   bgp confederation identifier 666
   bgp confederation peers 
    6002
    6003
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.16.232.55 
    remote-as 6002
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.16.232.56 
    remote-as 6003
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.19.69.1 
    remote-as 777
  
  

In a BGP speaker in autonomous system 6002, the peers from autonomous systems 6001 and 6003 are configured as special eBGP peers. Peer 171 .17 .70.1 is a normal iBGP peer, and peer 199.99.99.2 is a normal eBGP peer from autonomous system 700.


  router bgp 6002
   bgp confederation identifier 666
   bgp confederation peers 
    6001
    6003
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.17.70.1 
     remote-as 6002
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.19.232.57 
     remote-as 6001
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.19.232.56 
     remote-as 6003
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.19.99.2 
     remote-as 700
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    route-policy pass-all in
    route-policy pass-all out
  
  

In a BGP speaker in autonomous system 6003, the peers from autonomous systems 6001 and 6002 are configured as special eBGP peers. Peer 192 .168 .200.200 is a normal eBGP peer from autonomous system 701.


  router bgp 6003
   bgp confederation identifier 666
   bgp confederation peers
    6001
    6002
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.19.232.57 
     remote-as 6001
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 171.19.232.55 
     remote-as 6002
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 192.168.200.200 
     remote-as 701
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    route-policy pass-all in
    route-policy pass-all out
  
  

The following is a part of the configuration from the BGP speaker 192 .168 .200.205 from autonomous system 701 in the same example. Neighbor 171.16 .232.56 is configured as a normal eBGP speaker from autonomous system 666. The internal division of the autonomous system into multiple autonomous systems is not known to the peers external to the confederation.


  router bgp 701
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 172.16.232.56 
     remote-as 666
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    route-policy pass-all in
    route-policy pass-all out
     exit
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 192.168.200.205 
     remote-as 701
  

BGP Route Reflector: Example

The following example shows how to use an address family to configure internal BGP peer 10.1.1.1 as a route reflector client for both unicast and multicast prefixes:


  router bgp 140
   address-family ipv4 unicast
    neighbor 10.1.1.1
     remote-as 140
     address-family ipv4 unicast
      route-reflector-client
      exit
     address-family ipv4 multicast
      route-reflector-client
  
  

BGP Nonstop Routing Configuration: Example

The following example shows how to enable BGP NSR:


 configure
 router bgp 120
 nsr
 end

The following example shows how to disable BGP NSR:


 configure
 router bgp 120
 no nsr
 end

Primary Backup Path Installation: Example

The following example shows how to enable installation of primary backup path:


  router bgp 120
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  additional-paths receive
  additional-paths send
  additional-paths selection route-policy bgp_add_path
 !
!
end
  

Allocated Local Label Retention: Example

The following example shows how to retain the previously allocated local label for the primary path on the primary PE for 10 minutes after reconvergence:


  router bgp 100
  address-family l2vpn vpls-vpws
    retain local-label 10
  end
  

iBGP Multipath Loadsharing Configuration: Example

The following is a sample configuration where 30 paths are used for loadsharing:


router bgp 100
 address-family ipv4 multicast
  maximum-paths ibgp 30
 !
!
end

Discard Extra Paths Configuration: Example

The following example shows how to configure discard extra paths feature for the IPv4 address family:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 10
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.0.0.1
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# maximum-prefix 1000 discard-extra-paths
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# commit

Displaying Discard Extra Paths Information: Example

The following screen output shows details about the discard extra paths option:


RP/0/0/CPU0:ios# show bgp neighbor 10.0.0.1 

BGP neighbor is 10.0.0.1
Remote AS 10, local AS 10, internal link
Remote router ID 0.0.0.0
BGP state = Idle (No best local address found)
Last read 00:00:00, Last read before reset 00:00:00
Hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
Configured hold time: 180, keepalive: 60, min acceptable hold time: 3
Last write 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
Second last write 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
Last write before reset 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
Second last write before reset 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
Last write pulse rcvd not set last full not set pulse count 0
Last write pulse rcvd before reset 00:00:00
Socket not armed for io, not armed for read, not armed for write
Last write thread event before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
Last KA expiry before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
Last KA error before reset 00:00:00, KA not sent 00:00:00
Last KA start before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
Precedence: internet
Multi-protocol capability not received
Received 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
Sent 0 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
Minimum time between advertisement runs is 0 secs

For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
BGP neighbor version 0
Update group: 0.1 Filter-group: 0.0 No Refresh request being processed
Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0
0 accepted prefixes, 0 are bestpaths
Cumulative no. of prefixes denied: 0. 
Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0
Maximum prefixes allowed 10 (discard-extra-paths) <<<<<<<<<<<<<<<<<<<<<
Threshold for warning message 75%, restart interval 0 min
AIGP is enabled
An EoR was not received during read-only mode
Last ack version 1, Last synced ack version 0
Outstanding version objects: current 0, max 0
Additional-paths operation: None
Send Multicast Attributes

Connections established 0; dropped 0
Local host: 0.0.0.0, Local port: 0, IF Handle: 0x00000000
Foreign host: 10.0.0.1, Foreign port: 0
Last reset 00:00:00

Advertising IPv4 NLRI with IPv6 Next Hops in MP-BGP Networks

Many multiprotocol network deployments today have topologies of devices configured with one type of address family interspersed with devices configured with a different type of address family. An IPv4 core network can be surrounded by IPv6 devices, and vice versa. Such deployments require the use of multiprotocol BGP (MP-BGP) that allow the advertisement of IPv4 NLRI across IPv6 next hops. Hence, when MP-BGP is used to advertise the corresponding reachability information in such heterogenous networks, the BGP router (speaker) advertises the NLRI of a given address family through a next hop of a different address family.

There are several reasons for these heterogenous deployments. A primary reason is the lack of availability of IPv4 addresses to be used on the interfaces of BGP speakers. A second reason is the intent to move to a pure IPv6 deployment, but in phases. Hence, by configuring the ipv4 forwarding-enable command on interfaces, the type of address family used does not impact the flow of traffic in the network.


Note


Some BGP peer nodes will not establish a BGP session if the neighbor does not support the Extended Next-hop Encoding capabilities (RFC 5549). Use the capability suppress extended-nexthop-encoding command to suppress the advertisement of this capability.

This section describes the configuration required to enable IPv4 NLRI advertisement across an IPv6 next hop.

Configuration

Use the following configuration for advertising IPv4 NLRI through IPv6 netxhops.

In the following example, the eBGP peer is configured on the GigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 interface, and the iBGP peer is configured on the GigabitEthernet0/0/0/2 interface of the router being configured.

/* Configure the required GigE interfaces with an IPv6 address
 and the ipv4 forwarding-enable command */
Router(config)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0
Router(config-if)# ipv6 address 2000::2/64
Router(config-if)# ipv4 forwarding-enable 
Router(config-if)# no shut
Router(config-if)# commit
Tue Mar  6 10:11:17.910 IST
Router:Mar  6 10:11:17.968 : ifmgr[403]: %PKT_INFRA-LINK-3-UPDOWN : Interface GigabitEthernet0/0/0/0, changed state to Down 
Router:Mar  6 10:11:17.983 : ifmgr[403]: %PKT_INFRA-LINK-3-UPDOWN : Interface GigabitEthernet0/0/0/0, changed state to Up 
Router(config-if)# exit

Router(config)# interface GigabitEthernet 0/0/0/2
Router(config-if)# ipv6 address 3000::2/64
Router(config-if)# ipv4 forwarding-enable 
Router(config-if)# no shut
Router(config-if)# commit
Tue Mar  6 10:12:15.948 IST
RP/0/0/CPU0:Mar  6 10:12:15.978 : ifmgr[403]: %PKT_INFRA-LINK-3-UPDOWN : Interface GigabitEthernet0/0/0/2, changed state to Down 
RP/0/0/CPU0:Mar  6 10:12:15.994 : ifmgr[403]: %PKT_INFRA-LINK-3-UPDOWN : Interface GigabitEthernet0/0/0/2, changed state to Up 
Router(config-if)# exit

/* Create a route policy to set an IPv6 nexthop for IPv4 routes */
Router(config)# route-policy 5549
Router(config-rpl)# if destination in 5549-pfx then set next-hop 20:20::20:200 endif 
Router(config-rpl)# end-policy 
Router(config)# prefix-set 5549-pfx
Router(config-pfx)# 3.3.3.3/32, 100.1.1.0/24 end-set 
Router(config)# commit
Tue Mar  6 10:26:31.749 IST

/* Configure an iBGP peer through the GigabitEthernet0/0/0/2 interface */
Router(config)# router bgp 100
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-af)# exit             
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 multicast 
Router(config-bgp-af)# exit
Router(config-bgp)# neighbor 3000::1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 100
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# next-hop-self 
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all out
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit
Tue Mar  6 10:16:07.134 IST
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# exit
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# exit
Router(config-bgp)# exit

/* Configure an eBGP peer through the GigabitEthernet 0/0/0/0 interface 
and use the route policy for setting an IPv6 nexthop for IPv4 routes */
Router(config)# router bgp 100
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-af)# exit
Router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 multicast 
Router(config-bgp-af)# exit
Router(config-bgp)# neighbor 2000::1
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 200
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy pass-all in
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# route-policy 5549 out
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# commit
Tue Mar  6 10:21:19.434 IST
Router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# exit
Router(config-bgp-nbr)# exit
Router(config-bgp)# exit

/* Before proceeding to feature verification, 
confirm your configuration by using the show run command from the Executive mode */

Verification

Use the following show commands to verify the advertisement of IPv4 NLRI through IPv6 nexthops.

/* Verify BGP neighbor configuration and the advertisement of nexthops */
Router# show bgp neighbor 
BGP neighbor is 10:10::10:10
 Remote AS 100, local AS 100, internal link
 Remote router ID 10.10.10.10
 Cluster ID 30.30.30.30
  BGP state = Established, up for 11:42:17
  NSR State: NSR Ready
  Last read 00:00:10, Last read before reset 00:00:00
  Hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
  Configured hold time: 180, keepalive: 60, min acceptable hold time: 3
  Last write 00:00:09, attempted 19, written 19
  Second last write 00:01:09, attempted 19, written 19
  Last write before reset 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
  Second last write before reset 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
  Last write pulse rcvd  Jun 12 11:57:40.005 last full Jun 12 03:38:09.496 pulse count 1766
  Last write pulse rcvd before reset 00:00:00
  Socket not armed for io, armed for read, armed for write
  Last write thread event before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
  Last KA expiry before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
  Last KA error before reset 00:00:00, KA not sent 00:00:00
  Last KA start before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
  Precedence: internet
  Non-stop routing is enabled
  Multi-protocol capability received
  Neighbor capabilities:
    Route refresh: advertised (old + new) and received (old + new)
    4-byte AS: advertised and received
Address family IPv4 Unicast: advertised and received
    Received 866 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
Sent 1021 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
  Minimum time between advertisement runs is 0 secs
  Inbound message logging enabled, 3 messages buffered
  Outbound message logging enabled, 3 messages buffered
 
 For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
  BGP neighbor version 120021
  Update group: 0.2 Filter-group: 0.2  No Refresh request being processed
  Route-Reflector Client
    Extended Nexthop Encoding: advertised and received
  Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0
  11 accepted prefixes, 11 are bestpaths
  Exact no. of prefixes denied : 0.
  Cumulative no. of prefixes denied: 0. 
  Prefix advertised 60006, suppressed 0, withdrawn 60000
  Maximum prefixes allowed 1048576
  Threshold for warning message 75%, restart interval 0 min
  AIGP is enabled
  An EoR was not received during read-only mode
  Last ack version 120021, Last synced ack version 120021
  Outstanding version objects: current 0, max 3
  Additional-paths operation: None
  Send Multicast Attributes
  Advertise routes with local-label via Unicast SAFI
 
  Connections established 1; dropped 0
  Local host: 30:30::30:30, Local port: 51453, IF Handle: 0x00000000
  Foreign host: 10:10::10:10, Foreign port: 179
  Last reset 00:00:00

/* Verify BGP nexthop encoding and the n
Router# show bgp ipv4 unicast update-group 
Mon Jun 12 11:47:31.543 UTC

Update group for IPv4 Unicast, index 0.2:
  Attributes:
    Neighbor sessions are IPv6
    Internal
    Common admin
    First neighbor AS: 100
    Send communities
    Send GSHUT community if originated
    Send extended communities
    Route Reflector Client
    4-byte AS capable
    Advertise routes with local-label via Unicast SAFI
    Send AIGP
    Send multicast attributes
    Extended Nexthop Encoding
    Minimum advertisement interval: 0 secs
  Update group desynchronized: 0
  Sub-groups merged: 5
  Number of refresh subgroups: 0
  Messages formatted: 156, replicated: 228
  All neighbors are assigned to sub-group(s)
    Neighbors in sub-group: 0.2, Filter-Groups num:1 
     Neighbors in filter-group: 0.2(RT num: 0)
      10:10::10:10
      20:20::20:20

Router# show bgp 3.3.3.3/32
Mon Jun 12 11:57:59.451 UTC
BGP routing table entry for 3.3.3.3/32
Versions:
  Process           bRIB/RIB  SendTblVer
  Speaker                 21          21
Last Modified: Jun 12 00:15:45.314 for 11:42:14
Paths: (1 available, best #1)
  Advertised to update-groups (with more than one peer):
    0.2 
  Path #1: Received by speaker 0
  Advertised to update-groups (with more than one peer):
    0.2 
  3000, (Received from a RR-client)
    20:20::20:20 (metric 1) from 20:20::20:20 (20.20.20.20)
      Origin incomplete, metric 0, localpref 100, valid, internal, best, group-best
      Received Path ID 0, Local Path ID 0, version 21


Router# show bgp ipv4 unicast nexthops
...
    …….. Snippet ….. 
 
Gateway Address Family: IPv6 Unicast
Table ID: 0xe0800000
Nexthop Count: 2
Critical Trigger Delay: 3000msec
Non-critical Trigger Delay: 10000msec
 
Nexthop Version: 3, RIB version: 1
EPE Table Version: 1, EPE Label version: 1
EPE Downloaded Version: 1, EPE Standby Version: 1
 
Status codes: R/UR Reachable/Unreachable
              C/NC Connected/Not-connected
              L/NL Local/Non-local
              PR   Pending Registration
              I    Invalid (Policy drop)
Next Hop        Status          Metric     Tbl-ID   Notf   LastRIBEvent      RefCount
10:10::10:10    [R][NC][NL]          1e0800000   1/0    11:42:43 (Cri)       11/14
20:20::20:20    [R][NC][NL]          1e0800000   1/0    11:42:43 (Cri)        8/11


Router# show bgp ipv4 unicast nexthops 10:10::10:10
Nexthop: 10:10::10:10
  VRF: Default
  Nexthop ID: 0x6000001, Version: 0x2
  Nexthop Flags: 0x00000080
  Nexthop Handle: 0x7f53e85b136c
 
  RIB Related Information:
  Firsthop interface handle 0x00000140
    Gateway TBL Id: 0xe0800000    Gateway Flags: 0x00000080
    Gateway Handle: 0x7f540d2e8f00
    Gateway: reachable, non-Connected route, prefix length 128
    Resolving Route: 10:10::10:10/128 (ospf 100)
    Paths: 0
    RIB Nexhop ID: 0x0
    Status: [Reachable][Not Connected][Not Local]
    Metric: 1
    Registration: Asynchronous, Completed: 2d21h
    Events: Critical (1)/Non-critical (0)
    Last Received: 11:42:55 (Critical)
    Last gw update: (Crit-notif) 11:42:55(rib)
    Reference Count: 11
 
  Prefix Related Information
    Active Tables: [IPv4 Unicast]
    Metrices: [0x1]
    Reference Counts: [11]
  Interface Handle: 0x0

Router# show route 3.3.3.3/32
Mon Jun 12 12:32:13.503 UTC
 
Routing entry for 3.3.3.3/32
  Known via "bgp 100", distance 200, metric 0
  Tag 3000, type internal
  Installed Jun 12 00:15:45.626 for 12:16:28
  Routing Descriptor Blocks
    20:20::20:20, from 20:20::20:20
      Route metric is 0
  No advertising protos. 


Router# show route 3.3.3.3/32 detail
Mon Jun 12 12:32:16.447 UTC
 
Routing entry for 3.3.3.3/32
  Known via "bgp 100", distance 200, metric 0
  Tag 3000, type internal
  Installed Jun 12 00:15:45.628 for 12:16:30
  Routing Descriptor Blocks
    20:20::20:20, from 20:20::20:20
      Route metric is 0
      Label: None
      Tunnel ID: None
      Binding Label: None
      Extended communities count: 0
      NHID:0x0(Ref:0)
  Route version is 0x1 (1)
  No local label
  IP Precedence: Not Set
  QoS Group ID: Not Set
  Flow-tag: Not Set
  Fwd-class: Not Set
  Route Priority: RIB_PRIORITY_RECURSIVE (12) SVD Type RIB_SVD_TYPE_LOCAL
  Download Priority 4, Download Version 24
  No advertising protos. 

Router# show cef 3.3.3.3/32 
Mon Jun 12 12:32:22.627 UTC
3.3.3.3/32, version 24, internal 0x5000001 0x0 (ptr 0x8e0b76b8) [1], 0x0 (0x0), 0x0 (0x0)
 Updated Jun 12 00:15:45.631 
 local adjacency fe80::f83b:74ff:fe65:f004
 Prefix Len 32, traffic index 0, precedence n/a, priority 4
   via 20:20::20:20/128, 2 dependencies, recursive [flags 0x6000]
    path-idx 0 NHID 0x0 [0x8e352034 0x0]
    next hop VRF - 'default', table - 0xe0800000
    next hop 20:20::20:20/128 via 20:20::20:20/128


Router# show cef 3.3.3.3/32 detail
Mon Jun 12 12:32:25.415 UTC
3.3.3.3/32, version 24, internal 0x5000001 0x0 (ptr 0x8e0b76b8) [1], 0x0 (0x0), 0x0 (0x0)
 Updated Jun 12 00:15:45.632 
 local adjacency fe80::f83b:74ff:fe65:f004
 Prefix Len 32, traffic index 0, precedence n/a, priority 4
  gateway array (0x8eec3170) reference count 6, flags 0x2010, source rib (7), 0 backups
                [1 type 3 flags 0x48501 (0x8e191998) ext 0x0 (0x0)]
  LW-LDI[type=0, refc=0, ptr=0x0, sh-ldi=0x0]
  gateway array update type-time 1 Jun 12 00:15:45.632
 LDI Update time Jun 12 00:15:45.632
   via 20:20::20:20/128, 2 dependencies, recursive [flags 0x6000]
    path-idx 0 NHID 0x0 [0x8e352034 0x0]
    next hop VRF - 'default', table - 0xe0800000
    next hop 20:20::20:20/128 via 20:20::20:20/128
 
 
    Load distribution: 0 1 (refcount 1)
 
    Hash  OK  Interface                 Address
    0     Y   FortyGigE0/0/0/0          fe80::f83b:74ff:fe65:f004
    1     Y   FortyGigE0/0/0/25         fe80::f83b:74ff:fe65:f08c

You have successfully configured and verified the advertisement of IPv4 NLRI through IPv6 nexthops.

Configure Per Neighbor TCP MSS: Examples

These examples show how to configure per neighbor TCP MSS, disable per neighbor TCP MSS, and unconfigure TCP MSS.

Topology Scenario

This figure shows a basic scenario for per neighbor TCP MSS configuration.



R1 Configuration:


router bgp 1
  bgp router-id 10.0.0.1
  address-family ipv4 unicast
  !
  neighbor-group n1
    tcp mss 100
    address-family ipv4 unicast
  !
 !
  neighbor 10.0.0.2
    remote-as 1
    use neighbor-group n1
    address-family ipv4 unicast 
  !
 !
!

R2 Configuration:


router bgp 1
  bgp router-id 10.0.0.2
  address-family ipv4 unicast
  !
  neighbor 10.0.0.1
    remote-as 1
    address-family ipv4 unicast
  !
 !
!

Configure Per Neighbor TCP MSS: Example

The following example shows how to configure per neighbor TCP MSS under neighbor group:


router bgp 1
bgp router-id 10.0.0.1
address-family ipv4 unicast
!
neighbor-group n1
tcp mss 500
address-family ipv4 unicast
!
!
neighbor 10.0.0.2
remote-as 1
use neighbor-group n1
address-family ipv4 unicast
!
!
!
!
end

Disable Per Neighbor TCP MSS: Example

The following example shows how to configure TCP MSS under neighbor group and configure inheritance disable under one of the neighbors inheriting the TCP MSS value:


router bgp 1
bgp router-id 10.0.0.1
address-family ipv4 unicast
!
neighbor-group n1
tcp mss 500
address-family ipv4 unicast
!
!
neighbor 10.0.0.2
remote-as 1
use neighbor-group n1
tcp mss inheritance-disable
address-family ipv4 unicast
!
!
!
!
end

Unconfigure TCP MSS: Example

The following example shows how to unconfigure TCP MSS:


RP/0/0/CPU0:ios(config)#router bgp 1
RP/0/0/CPU0:ios(config-bgp)#neighbor-group n1 
RP/0/0/CPU0:ios(config-bgp-nbrgrp)#no tcp mss 500 
RP/0/0/CPU0:ios(config-bgp-nbrgrp)#commit

Verify Per Neighbor TCP MSS: Examples

The following example shows how to verify the per neighbor TCP MSS feature on a router:


RP/0/0/CPU0:ios#show bgp neighbor 10.0.0.2

BGP neighbor is 10.0.0.2
Remote AS 1, local AS 1, internal link
Remote router ID 10.0.0.2
BGP state = Established, up for 00:09:17
Last read 00:00:16, Last read before reset 00:00:00
Hold time is 180, keepalive interval is 60 seconds
Configured hold time: 180, keepalive: 60, min acceptable hold time: 3
Last write 00:00:16, attempted 19, written 19
Second last write 00:01:16, attempted 19, written 19
Last write before reset 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
Second last write before reset 00:00:00, attempted 0, written 0
Last write pulse rcvd Dec 7 11:58:42.411 last full not set pulse count 23
Last write pulse rcvd before reset 00:00:00
Socket not armed for io, armed for read, armed for write
Last write thread event before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
Last KA expiry before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
Last KA error before reset 00:00:00, KA not sent 00:00:00
Last KA start before reset 00:00:00, second last 00:00:00
Precedence: internet
Multi-protocol capability received
Neighbor capabilities:
Route refresh: advertised (old + new) and received (old + new)
Graceful Restart (GR Awareness): advertised and received
4-byte AS: advertised and received
Address family IPv4 Unicast: advertised and received
Received 12 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
Sent 12 messages, 0 notifications, 0 in queue
Minimum time between advertisement runs is 0 secs
TCP Maximum Segment Size 500 

For Address Family: IPv4 Unicast
BGP neighbor version 4
Update group: 0.2 Filter-group: 0.1 No Refresh request being processed
Route refresh request: received 0, sent 0
0 accepted prefixes, 0 are bestpaths
Cumulative no. of prefixes denied: 0. 
Prefix advertised 0, suppressed 0, withdrawn 0
Maximum prefixes allowed 1048576
Threshold for warning message 75%, restart interval 0 min
AIGP is enabled
An EoR was received during read-only mode
Last ack version 4, Last synced ack version 0
Outstanding version objects: current 0, max 0
Additional-paths operation: None
Send Multicast Attributes

The following example shows how to verify the TCP MSS configuration:


RP/0/0/CPU0:ios#show bgp neighbor 10.0.0.2 configuration 

neighbor 10.0.0.2
remote-as 1 []
tcp-mss 400 [n:n1]
address-family IPv4 Unicast []

The following example shows how to display TCP connection endpoints information:


RP/0/0/CPU0:ios#show tcp brief

  PCB      VRF-ID     Recv-Q Send-Q Local Address          Foreign Address         State
0x08789b28 0x60000000      0      0  :::179                  :::0                   LISTEN
0x08786160 0x00000000      0      0  :::179                  :::0                   LISTEN
0xecb0c9f8 0x60000000      0      0  10.0.0.1:12404          10.0.0.2:179           ESTAB
0x0878b168 0x60000000      0      0  11.0.0.1:179            11.0.0.2:61177         ESTAB
0xecb0c6b8 0x60000000      0      0  0.0.0.0:179             0.0.0.0:0              LISTEN
0x08781590 0x00000000      0      0  0.0.0.0:179             0.0.0.0:0              LISTEN

The following example shows how to display TCP connection information for a specific PCB value:


RP/0/0/CPU0:ios#show tcp pcb 0xecb0c9f8

Connection state is ESTAB, I/O status: 0, socket status: 0
Established at Sun Dec 7 11:49:39 2014

PCB 0xecb0c9f8, SO 0xecb01b68, TCPCB 0xecb01d78, vrfid 0x60000000, 
Pak Prio: Medium, TOS: 192, TTL: 255, Hash index: 1322
Local host: 10.0.0.1, Local port: 12404 (Local App PID: 19840)
Foreign host: 10.0.0.2, Foreign port: 179

Current send queue size in bytes: 0 (max 24576)
Current receive queue size in bytes: 0 (max 32768) mis-ordered: 0 bytes
Current receive queue size in packets: 0 (max 0)

Timer Starts Wakeups Next(msec)
Retrans 17 2 0
SendWnd 0 0 0
TimeWait 0 0 0
AckHold 13 5 0
KeepAlive 1 0 0
PmtuAger 0 0 0
GiveUp 0 0 0
Throttle 0 0 0

iss: 1728179225 snduna: 1728179536 sndnxt: 1728179536
sndmax: 1728179536 sndwnd: 32517 sndcwnd: 1000 
irs: 2055835995 rcvnxt: 2055836306 rcvwnd: 32536 rcvadv: 2055868842

SRTT: 206 ms, RTTO: 300 ms, RTV: 59 ms, KRTT: 0 ms
minRTT: 10 ms, maxRTT: 230 ms

ACK hold time: 200 ms, Keepalive time: 0 sec, SYN waittime: 30 sec
Giveup time: 0 ms, Retransmission retries: 0, Retransmit forever: FALSE
Connect retries remaining: 30, connect retry interval: 30 secs

State flags: none
Feature flags: Win Scale, Nagle
Request flags: Win Scale

Datagrams (in bytes): MSS 500, peer MSS 1460, min MSS 500, max MSS 1460

Window scales: rcv 0, snd 0, request rcv 0, request snd 0
Timestamp option: recent 0, recent age 0, last ACK sent 0
Sack blocks {start, end}: none
Sack holes {start, end, dups, rxmit}: none

Socket options: SO_REUSEADDR, SO_REUSEPORT, SO_NBIO
Socket states: SS_ISCONNECTED, SS_PRIV
Socket receive buffer states: SB_DEL_WAKEUP
Socket send buffer states: SB_DEL_WAKEUP
Socket receive buffer: Low/High watermark 1/32768 
Socket send buffer : Low/High watermark 2048/24576, Notify threshold 0 

PDU information:
#PDU's in buffer: 0
FIB Lookup Cache: IFH: 0x200 PD ctx: size: 0 data: 
Num Labels: 0 Label Stack:

Originating Prefixes With AiGP: Example

The following is a sample configuration for originating prefixes with the AiGP metric attribute:


route-policy aigp-policy
  set aigp-metric 4
  set aigp-metric igp-cost
end-policy
!
router bgp 100
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  network 10.2.3.4/24 route-policy aigp-policy
  redistribute ospf osp1 metric 4 route-policy aigp-policy
 !
!
end

BGP Accept Own Configuration: Example

This example shows how to configure BGP Accept Own on a PE router.
router bgp 100
 neighbor 45.1.1.1
   remote-as 100
   update-source Loopback0
   address-family vpnv4 unicast
    route-policy pass-all in
    accept-own
    route-policy drop_111.x.x.x out
   !
   address-family vpnv6 unicast
    route-policy pass-all in
    accept-own
    route-policy drop_111.x.x.x out
   !
  !
This example shows an InterAS-RR configuration for BGP Accept Own.
router bgp 100
 neighbor 45.1.1.1
  remote-as 100
  update-source Loopback0
  address-family vpnv4 unicast
   route-policy rt_stitch1 in
   route-reflector-client
   route-policy add_bgp_ao out
  !
  address-family vpnv6 unicast
   route-policy rt_stitch1 in
   route-reflector-client
   route-policy add_bgp_ao out
  !
 !
extcommunity-set rt cs_100:1
  100:1
end-set
!
extcommunity-set rt cs_1001:1
  1001:1
end-set
!
route-policy rt_stitch1
  if extcommunity rt matches-any cs_100:1 then
    set extcommunity rt cs_1000:1 additive
 endif
end-policy
!
route-policy add_bgp_ao
  set community (accept-own) additive
end-policy
!

Configuring BGP Permanent Network

Configuring BGP Permanent Network

Perform this task to configure BGP permanent network. You must configure at least one route-policy to identify the set of prefixes (networks) for which the permanent network (path) is to be configured.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. prefix-set prefix-set-name
  3. exit
  4. route-policy route-policy-name
  5. end-policy
  6. router bgp as-number
  7. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  8. permanent-network route-policy route-policy-name
  9. Use the commit or end command.
  10. show bgp {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast prefix-set

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

prefix-set prefix-set-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# prefix-set PERMANENT-NETWORK-IPv4
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# 1.1.1.1/32,
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# 2.2.2.2/32,
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# 3.3.3.3/32
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# end-set

Enters prefix set configuration mode and defines a prefix set for contiguous and non-contiguous set of bits.

Step 3

exit

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-pfx)# exit

Exits prefix set configuration mode and enters global configuration mode.

Step 4

route-policy route-policy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy POLICY-PERMANENT-NETWORK-IPv4
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# if destination in PERMANENT-NETWORK-IPv4 then
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# pass
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# endif
 

Creates a route policy and enters route policy configuration mode, where you can define the route policy.

Step 5

end-policy

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end-policy

Ends the definition of a route policy and exits route policy configuration mode.

Step 6

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode.

Step 7

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 8

permanent-network route-policy route-policy-name

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-af)# permanent-network route-policy POLICY-PERMANENT-NETWORK-IPv4

Configures the permanent network (path) for the set of prefixes as defined in the route-policy.

Step 9

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 10

show bgp {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast prefix-set

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp ipv4 unicast 

(Optional) Displays whether the prefix-set is a permanent network in BGP.

How to Advertise Permanent Network

Perform this task to identify the peers to whom the permanent paths must be advertised.

SUMMARY STEPS

  1. configure
  2. router bgp as-number
  3. neighbor ip-address
  4. remote-as as-number
  5. address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast
  6. advertise permanent-network
  7. Use the commit or end command.
  8. show bgp {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast neighbor ip-address

DETAILED STEPS

  Command or Action Purpose

Step 1

configure

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure

Enters global configuration mode.

Step 2

router bgp as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 100

Specifies the autonomous system number and enters the BGP configuration mode.

Step 3

neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# neighbor 10.255.255.254

Places the router in neighbor configuration mode for BGP routing and configures the neighbor IP address as a BGP peer.

Step 4

remote-as as-number

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# remote-as 4713

Assigns the neighbor a remote autonomous system number.

Step 5

address-family { ipv4 | ipv6 } unicast

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr)# address-family ipv4 unicast

Specifies either an IPv4 or IPv6 address family unicast and enters address family configuration submode.

Step 6

advertise permanent-network

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-nbr-af)# advertise permanent-network

Specifies the peers to whom the permanent network (path) is advertised.

Step 7

Use the commit or end command.

commit —Saves the configuration changes and remains within the configuration session.

end —Prompts user to take one of these actions:
  • Yes — Saves configuration changes and exits the configuration session.

  • No —Exits the configuration session without committing the configuration changes.

  • Cancel —Remains in the configuration session, without committing the configuration changes.

Step 8

show bgp {ipv4 | ipv6} unicast neighbor ip-address

Example:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:routershow bgp ipv4 unicast neighbor 10.255.255.254

(Optional) Displays whether the neighbor is capable of receiving BGP permanent networks.

BGP Unequal Cost Recursive Load Balancing: Example

This is a sample configuration for unequal cost recursive load balancing:



interface Loopback0
 ipv4 address 20.20.20.20 255.255.255.255
!
interface MgmtEth0/RSP0/CPU0/0
 ipv4 address 8.43.0.10 255.255.255.0
!
interface TenGigE0/3/0/0
 bandwidth 8000000 
 ipv4 address 11.11.11.11 255.255.255.0
 ipv6 address 11:11:0:1::11/64
!
interface TenGigE0/3/0/1
 bandwidth 7000000
 ipv4 address 11.11.12.11 255.255.255.0
 ipv6 address 11:11:0:2::11/64
!
interface TenGigE0/3/0/2
 bandwidth 6000000
 ipv4 address 11.11.13.11 255.255.255.0
 ipv6 address 11:11:0:3::11/64
!
interface TenGigE0/3/0/3
 bandwidth 5000000
 ipv4 address 11.11.14.11 255.255.255.0
 ipv6 address 11:11:0:4::11/64
!
interface TenGigE0/3/0/4
 bandwidth 4000000
 ipv4 address 11.11.15.11 255.255.255.0
 ipv6 address 11:11:0:5::11/64
!
interface TenGigE0/3/0/5
 bandwidth 3000000
 ipv4 address 11.11.16.11 255.255.255.0
 ipv6 address 11:11:0:6::11/64
!
interface TenGigE0/3/0/6
 bandwidth 2000000
 ipv4 address 11.11.17.11 255.255.255.0
 ipv6 address 11:11:0:7::11/64
!
interface TenGigE0/3/0/7
 bandwidth 1000000
 ipv4 address 11.11.18.11 255.255.255.0
 ipv6 address 11:11:0:8::11/64
!
interface TenGigE0/4/0/0
 description CONNECTED TO IXIA 1/3
 transceiver permit pid all
!
interface TenGigE0/4/0/2
 ipv4 address 9.9.9.9 255.255.0.0
 ipv6 address 9:9::9/64
 ipv6 enable
!
route-policy pass-all
  pass
end-policy
!
router static
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  202.153.144.0/24 8.43.0.1
 !
!
router bgp 100
 bgp router-id 20.20.20.20
 address-family ipv4 unicast
  maximum-paths eibgp 8
  redistribute connected
 !
 neighbor 11.11.11.12
  remote-as 200
  dmz-link-bandwidth    
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy pass-all in
   route-policy pass-all out
  !
 !
 neighbor 11.11.12.12
  remote-as 200
  dmz-link-bandwidth
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy pass-all in
   route-policy pass-all out
  !
 !
 neighbor 11.11.13.12
  remote-as 200
  dmz-link-bandwidth
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy pass-all in
   route-policy pass-all out
  !
 !
 neighbor 11.11.14.12
  remote-as 200
  dmz-link-bandwidth
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy pass-all in
   route-policy pass-all out
  !
 !
 neighbor 11.11.15.12
  remote-as 200
  dmz-link-bandwidth
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy pass-all in
   route-policy pass-all out
  !
 !
 neighbor 11.11.16.12
  remote-as 200
  dmz-link-bandwidth
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy pass-all in
   route-policy pass-all out
  !
 !
 neighbor 11.11.17.12
  remote-as 200
  dmz-link-bandwidth
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy pass-all in
   route-policy pass-all out
  !
 !
 neighbor 11.11.18.12
  remote-as 200
  dmz-link-bandwidth
  address-family ipv4 unicast
   route-policy pass-all in
   route-policy pass-all out
  !
 !
!
end

VRF Dynamic Route Leaking Configuration: Example

These examples show how to configure VRF dynamic route leaking:

Import Routes from default-VRF to non-default-VRF


vrf vrf_1
 address-family ipv6 unicast
  import from default-vrf route-policy rpl_dynamic_route_import
 !
end

Import Routes from non-default-VRF to default-VRF


vrf vrf_1
 address-family ipv6 unicast
    export to default-vrf route-policy rpl_dynamic_route_export
 !
end

Resilient Per-CE Label Mode Configuration: Example

Configuring Resilient Per-CE Label Mode Under VRF Address Family: Example

This example shows how to configure resilient per-ce label mode under VRF address family:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# router bgp 666
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp)# vrf vrf-pe
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf)# address-family ipv4 unicast
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# label mode per-ce
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-bgp-vrf-af)# end

Configuring Resilient Per-CE Label Mode Using a Route-Policy: Example

This example shows how to configure resilient per-ce label mode using a route-policy:


RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router# configure
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config)# route-policy route1
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# set label mode per-ce
RP/0/RSP0/CPU0:router(config-rpl)# end

Flow-tag propagation


Note


BGP Flow-Tag is supported on Cisco ASR 9000 2nd, 3rd, and 4th Generation Line Cards. For more information on Cisco ASR 9000 Line Cards, see the Cisco ASR 9000 Series Aggregation Services Router Ethernet Line Card Installation Guide.

The flow-tag propagation feature enables you to establish a co-relation between route-policies and user-policies. Flow-tag propagation using BGP allows user-side traffic-steering based on routing attributes such as, AS number, prefix lists, community strings and extended communities. Flow-tag is a logical numeric identifier that is distributed through RIB as one of the routing attribute of FIB entry in the FIB lookup table. A flow-tag is instantiated using the 'set' operation from RPL and is referenced in the C3PL PBR policy, where it is associated with actions (policy-rules) against the flow-tag value.

You can use flow-tag propagation to:

  • Classify traffic based on destination IP addresses (using the Community number) or based on prefixes (using Community number or AS number).

  • Select a TE-group that matches the cost of the path to reach a service-edge based on customer site service level agreements (SLA).

  • Apply traffic policy (TE-group selection) for specific customers based on SLA with its clients.

  • Divert traffic to application or cache server.

Restrictions for Flow-Tag Propagation

Some restrictions are placed with regard to using Quality-of-service Policy Propagation Using Border Gateway Protocol (QPPB) and flow-tag feature together. These include:

  • A route-policy can have either 'set qos-group' or 'set flow-tag,' but not both for a prefix-set.
  • Route policy for qos-group and route policy flow-tag cannot have overlapping routes. The QPPB and flow tag features can coexist (on same as well as on different interfaces) as long as the route policy used by them do not have any overlapping route.
  • Mixing usage of qos-group and flow-tag in route-policy and policy-map is not recommended.

Where to Go Next

For detailed information about BGP commands, see Routing Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers

Additional References

The following sections provide references related to implementing BGP.

Related Documents

Related Topic

Document Title

BGP commands: complete command syntax, command modes, command history, defaults, usage guidelines, and examples

Routing Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers

Cisco Express Forwarding (CEF) commands: complete command syntax, command modes, command history, defaults, usage guidelines, and examples

IP Addresses and Services Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers

MPLS VPN configuration information.

MPLS Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers

Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD)

Interface and Hardware Component Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers and Interface and Hardware Component Command Reference for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers

Task ID information.

Configuring AAA Services on Cisco ASR 9000 Series Router module of System Security Configuration Guide for Cisco ASR 9000 Series Routers

Standards

Standards

Title

draft-bonica-tcp-auth-05.txt

Authentication for TCP-based Routing and Management Protocols, by R. Bonica, B. Weis, S. Viswanathan, A. Lange, O. Wheeler

draft-ietf-idr-bgp4-26.txt

A Border Gateway Protocol 4, by Y. Rekhter, T.Li, S. Hares

draft-ietf-idr-bgp4-mib-15.txt

Definitions of Managed Objects for the Fourth Version of Border Gateway Protocol (BGP-4), by J. Hass and S. Hares

draft-ietf-idr-cease-subcode-05.txt

Subcodes for BGP Cease Notification Message, by Enke Chen, V. Gillet

draft-ietf-idr-avoid-transition-00.txt

Avoid BGP Best Path Transitions from One External to Another, by Enke Chen, Srihari Sangli

draft-ietf-idr-as4bytes-12.txt

BGP Support for Four-octet AS Number Space, by Quaizar Vohra, Enke Chen

MIBs

MIBs

MIBs Link

To locate and download MIBs using Cisco IOS XR software, use the Cisco MIB Locator found at the following URL and choose a platform under the Cisco Access Products menu: https://mibs.cloudapps.cisco.com/ITDIT/MIBS/servlet/index

RFCs

RFCs

Title

RFC 1700

Assigned Numbers

RFC 1997

BGP Communities Attribute

RFC 2385

Protection of BGP Sessions via the TCP MD5 Signature Option

RFC 2439

BGP Route Flap Damping

RFC 2545

Use of BGP-4 Multiprotocol Extensions for IPv6 Inter-Domain Routing

RFC 2796

BGP Route Reflection - An Alternative to Full Mesh IBGP

RFC 2858

Multiprotocol Extensions for BGP-4

RFC 2918

Route Refresh Capability for BGP-4

RFC 3065

Autonomous System Confederations for BGP

RFC 3392

Capabilities Advertisement with BGP-4

RFC 4271

A Border Gateway Protocol 4 (BGP-4)

RFC 4364

BGP/MPLS IP Virtual Private Networks (VPNs)

RFC 4724

Graceful Restart Mechanism for BGP

Technical Assistance

Description

Link

The Cisco Technical Support website contains thousands of pages of searchable technical content, including links to products, technologies, solutions, technical tips, and tools. Registered Cisco.com users can log in from this page to access even more content.

http://www.cisco.com/techsupport